Login| Sign Up| Help| Contact|

Patent Searching and Data


Title:
VIRTUAL AND AUGMENTED REALITY SYSTEMS AND METHODS
Document Type and Number:
WIPO Patent Application WO/2015/081313
Kind Code:
A9
Abstract:
Configurations are disclosed for presenting virtual reality and augmented reality experiences to users. The system may comprise an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner, a light modulator configured to transmit light associated with the one or more frames of image data, a substrate to direct image information to a user's eye, wherein the substrate houses a plurality of reflectors, a first reflector of the plurality of reflectors to reflect transmitted light associated with a first frame of image data at a first angle to the user's eye, and a second reflector to reflect transmitted light associated with a second frame of the image data at a second angle to the user's eye.

Inventors:
SCHOWENGERDT BRIAN (US)
Application Number:
PCT/US2014/067791
Publication Date:
September 09, 2016
Filing Date:
November 27, 2014
Export Citation:
Click for automatic bibliography generation   Help
Assignee:
MAGIC LEAP INC (US)
International Classes:
H04J14/00
Attorney, Agent or Firm:
MEI, Peter C. (LLP2160 Lundy Ave., Suite 23, San Jose California, US)
Download PDF:
Claims:
CLAIMS

What is claimed is:

1. A system for displaying virtual content, comprising:

a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner; and

an array of reflectors to receive the one or more light patterns and variably direct light toward an exit pupil.

2. A system for displaying virtual content, the system comprising:

an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time- sequential manner;

a light modulator configured to transmit light associated with the one or more frames of image data;

a substrate to direct image information to a user's eye, wherein the substrate houses a plurality of reflectors;

a first reflector of the plurality of reflectors to reflect transmitted light associated with a first frame of image data at a first angle to the user's eye; and

a second reflector to reflect transmitted light associated with a second frame of the image data at a second angle to the user's eye.

3. The system of claim 1 or 2, wherein an angle of reflection of the plurality of reflectors is variable.

4. The system of claim 1 or 2, wherein the reflectors are switchable.

5. The system of claim 1 or 2 , wherein the plurality of reflectors are electro-optically active.

6. The system of claim 2, wherein a refractive index of the plurality of reflectors is varied to match a refractive index of the substrate.

7. The system of claim 1 or 2, further comprising:

a high-frequency gating layer configurable to be placed in between the substrate and the user's eye, the high-frequency gating layer having an aperture that is controllably movable.

8. The system of claim 7, wherein the aperture of the high-frequency gating layer is moved in a manner such that image data is selectively transmitted only through the light that is reflected through the aperture, and wherein one or more reflectors of the transmissive beamsplitter substrate are blocked by the high-frequency gating layer.

9. The system of claim 7, wherein the aperture is an LCD aperture.

10. The system of claim 7, wherein the aperture is a MEMs array.

11. The system of claim 2, wherein the first angle is the same as the second angle.

12. The system of claim 2 , wherein the first angle is different than the second angle.

13. The system of claim 2, further comprising a first lens to steer a set of light rays through a nodal point and to the user's eye, wherein the first lens is configurable to be placed on the substrate and in front of the first reflector such that the set of light rays exiting the reflector pass through the first lens before reaching the user's eye.

14. The system of claim 13, further comprising a second lens to compensate for the first lens, the second lens configurable to be placed on the substrate and on a side opposite to the side on which the first lens is placed, thereby resulting in zero magnification.

15. The system of claim 2, wherein the first reflector of the plurality of reflectors is a curved reflective surface to collect a set of light rays associated with the image data into a single output point before being delivered to the user's eye.

16. The system of claim 15, wherein the curved reflector is a parabolic reflector.

17. The system of claim 15, wherein the curved reflector is an elliptical reflector.

18. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising:

providing one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner;

reflecting the one or more light patterns associated with the one or more frames of image data via a transmissive beamsplitter to an exit pupil, the transmissive beamsplitter having a plurality of reflectors to variably direct light toward the exit pupil.

19. The method of claim 18, wherein an angle of reflection of the plurality of reflectors is variable.

20. The method of claim 18, wherein the reflectors are switchable.

21. The method of claim 18 , wherein the plurality of reflectors are electro-optically active.

22. The method of claim 18, wherein a refractive index of the plurality of reflectors is varied to match a refractive index of the substrate.

23. The method of claim 18, further comprising:

placing a high-frequency gating layer in between the transmissive beamsplitter and the user's eye, the high-frequency gating layer having an aperture that is controllably movable.

24. The method of claim 23, wherein the aperture of the high-frequency gating layer is moved in a manner such that image data is selectively transmitted only through the light that is reflected through the aperture, and wherein one or more reflectors of the transmissive beamsplitter substrate are blocked by the high-frequency gating layer.

25. The method of claim 23, wherein the aperture is an LCD aperture.

26. The method of claim 23, wherein the aperture is a MEMs array.

27. The method m of claim 18, further comprising steering, through a first lens, a set of light rays exiting the transmissive beamsplitter through a nodal point and to the user's eye, wherein the first lens is configurable to be placed in between the transmissive beamsplitter and the user's eye.

28. The method of claim 27, further comprising

compensating an effect of the first lens through a second, the second lens configurable to be placed on the substrate and on a side opposite to the side on which the first lens is placed, the compensation lens resulting in zero magnification of light from an outside environment.

29. The method of claim 18, wherein a reflector of the plurality of reflectors is a curved reflective surface to collect a set of light rays associated with the image data into a single output point before being delivered to the user's eye.

30. The method of claim 29, wherein the curved reflector is a parabolic reflector.

31. The method of claim 29, wherein the curved reflector is an elliptical reflector.

32. The method of claim 18, wherein the plurality of reflectors of the transmissive beamsplitter substrate relay a wavefront to the user's eye.

33. The method of claim 32, wherein the wavefront is a collimated wavefront.

34. The method of claim 32, wherein the wavefront is a curved wavefront.

35. The method of claim 33, wherein the collimated wavefront is perceived as coming from an infinite depth plane by the user.

36. The method of claim 34, wherein the curved wavefront is perceived as coming from a particular depth plane.

37. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner; and

an array of reflectors to receive the one or more light patterns, the array of reflectors oriented at a particular angle; and

a plurality of optical elements coupled to the array of reflectors to variably direct the light patterns toward an exit pupil.

38. The system of claim 37, wherein the array of reflectors are separate from the optical elements.

39. The system of claim 38, wherein the array of reflectors comprise flat mirrors.

40. The system of claim 38, wherein the optical elements are lenslets coupled to the array of reflectors.

41. The system of claim 37, wherein one or more reflectors of the array of reflectors are curved.

42. The system of claim 37, wherein the optical elements are integrated into the array of reflectors.

43. The system of claim 42, wherein the reflectors are parabolic reflectors.

44. The system of claim 42, wherein the reflectors are elliptical reflectors.

45. The system of claim 42, wherein the plurality of optical elements expand an exit pupil.

46. The system of claim 37, further comprising a first lens to steer a set of light rays through a nodal point and to the user's eye, wherein the first lens is configurable to be placed on the substrate and between the first reflector and the eye such that the set of light rays exiting the reflector pass through the first lens before reaching the user's eye.

47. The system of claim 46, further comprising a second lens to compensate for an optical power of the first lens, the second lens configurable to be placed on the substrate and on a side opposite to the side on which the first lens is placed, such that a user can view a substantially undistorted view of the outside world through the lens stack.

48. The system of claim 37, wherein the plurality of reflectors comprise wavelength- selective reflectors.

49. The system of claim 37, wherein the plurality of reflectors comprise half-silvered mirrors.

50. The system of claim 37, wherein the plurality of optical elements comprise refractive lenses.

51. The system of claim 37, wherein the plurality of optical elements comprise diffractive lenses.

52. The system of claim 41 , wherein the curved reflectors comprise wave-length selective notch filters.

53. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

providing one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner;

reflecting the one or more light patterns associated with the one or more frames of image data via a transmissive beamsplitter to an exit pupil, the transmissive beamsplitter having a plurality of reflectors to variably direct light toward the exit pupil; and

expanding an exit pupil through a plurality of optical elements coupled to the plurality of reflectors of the transmissive beamsplitter.

54. The method of claim 53, wherein the array of reflectors are separate from the optical elements.

55. The method of claim 53, wherein the array of reflectors comprise flat mirrors.

56. The method of claim 53, wherein the optical elements are lenslets coupled to the array of reflectors.

57. The method of claim 53, wherein one or more reflectors of the array of reflectors are curved.

58. The method of claim 53, wherein the optical elements are integrated into the array of reflectors.

59. The method of claim 58, wherein the reflectors are parabolic reflectors.

60. The method of claim 58, wherein the reflectors are elliptical reflectors.

61. The method of claim 53, further comprising a first lens to steer a set of light rays through a nodal point and to the user's eye, wherein the first lens is configurable to be placed on the substrate and between the first reflector and the eye such that the set of light rays exiting the reflector pass through the first lens before reaching the user's eye.

62. The method of claim 61 , further comprising a second lens to compensate for an optical power of the first lens, the second lens configurable to be placed on the substrate and on a side opposite to the side on which the first lens is placed, such that a user can view a substantially undistorted view of the outside world through the lens stack.

63. The method of claim 53, wherein the plurality of reflectors comprise wavelength- selective reflectors.

64. The method of claim 53, wherein the plurality of reflectors comprise half-silvered mirrors.

65. The method of claim 53, wherein the plurality of optical elements comprise refractive lenses.

66. The method of claim 53, wherein the plurality of optical elements comprise diffractive lenses.

67. The method of claim 57, wherein the curved reflectors comprise wave-length selective notch filters.

68. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner; and

a waveguide to receive the one or more light patterns at a first focus level; and a variable focus element (VFE) coupled to the waveguide to place at least some of the light patterns at a second focus level.

69. The system of claim 68, wherein the VFE does not substantially change image magnification while adjusting focus level.

70. The system of claim 68, wherein the VFE does change image magnification while adjusting focus level.

71. The system of claim 68, further comprising a second VFE that adjusts a wavefront of light from an outside world such that the user's view of the outside world is substantially undistorted as the first VFE varies the focus of the light patterns.

72. The system of claim 68, wherein a plurality of frames are presented to the user at a high frequency such that the user perceives the frames as part of a single coherent scene, wherein the VFE varies the focus from a first frame to a second frame.

73. The system of claim 68, wherein the light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus in a line-by-line manner.

74. The system of claim 68, wherein the light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus in a pixel-by-pixel manner.

75. The system of claim 68, wherein the VFE is a diffractive lens.

76. The system of claim 68, wherein the VFE is a refractive lens.

77. The system of claim 68, wherein the VFE is a reflective mirror.

78. The system of claim 77, wherein the reflective mirror is opaque.

79. The system of claim 77, wherein the reflective mirror is partially reflective.

80. The system of claim 68, further comprising an accommodation module to track an accommodation of a user's eyes, and wherein the VFE varies the focus of the light patterns based at least in part on the accommodation of the user's eyes.

81. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner;

a waveguide to receive the one or more light patterns and direct the light patterns to a first focus; and

a variable focus element (VFE) coupled to the waveguide to direct at least some of the light patterns to a second focus, wherein the VFE is integrated into the waveguide.

82. The system of claim 81 , wherein the VFE is telecentric.

83. The system of claim 81 , wherein the VFE is non-telecentric.

84. The system of claim 81 , further comprising a compensating lens such that the user's view of the outside world is undistorted.

85. The system of claim 81 , wherein a plurality of frames are presented to the user at a high frequency such that the user perceives the frames as part of a single coherent scene, wherein the VFE varies the focus from a first frame to a second frame.

86. The system of claim 81 , wherein the light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus in a line-by-line manner.

87. The system of claim 81 , wherein the light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus in a pixel-by-pixel manner.

88. The system of claim 81 , wherein the VFE is a diffractive lens.

89. The system of claim 81 , wherein the VFE is a refractive lens.

90. The system of claim 81 , wherein the VFE is a reflective mirror.

91. The system of claim 90, wherein the reflective mirror is opaque.

92. The system of claim 90, wherein the reflective mirror is partially reflective.

93. The system of claim 81 , further comprising an accommodation module to track an accommodation of a user's eyes, and wherein the VFE varies the focus of the light patterns based at least in part on the accommodation of the user's eyes.

94. A system for displaying virtual content to a user comprising;

a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner;

a waveguide to receive the one or more light patterns and direct the light patterns to a first focus; and

a variable focus element (VFE) coupled to the waveguide to direct at least some of the light patterns to a second focus, wherein the VFE is separate from the waveguide.

95. The system of claim 94, wherein the VFE is telecentric.

96. The system of claim 94, wherein the VFE is non-telecentric.

97. The system of claim 94, further comprising a compensating lens such that the user's view of the outside world is undistorted.

98. The system of claim 94, wherein a plurality of frames are presented to the user at a high frequency such that the user perceives the frames as part of a single coherent scene, wherein the VFE varies the focus from a first frame to a second frame.

99. The system of claim 94, wherein the light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus in a line-by-line manner.

100. The system of claim 94, wherein the light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus in a pixel-by-pixel manner.

101. The system of claim 94, wherein the VFE is a diffractive lens.

102. The system of claim 94, wherein the VFE is a refractive lens.

103. The system of claim 94, wherein the VFE is a reflective mirror.

104. The system of claim 103, wherein the reflective mirror is opaque.

105. The system of claim 103, wherein the reflective mirror is partially reflective.

106. The system of claim 94, further comprising an accommodation module to track an accommodation of a user's eyes, and wherein the VFE varies the focus of the light patterns based at least in part on the accommodation of the user's eyes.

107. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

providing one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data; converging the one or more light patterns associated with the one or more frames of image data to a first focus through a waveguide; and

modifying, through a variable focus element (VFE), the first focus of the light to produce a wavefront at a second focus.

108. The method of claim 107, wherein the VFE is separate from the waveguide.

109. The method of claim 107, wherein the VFE is integrated into the waveguide.

110. The method of claim 107, wherein the one or more frames of image data are provided in a time-sequential manner.

11 1. The method of claim 1 10, wherein the VFE modifies the focus of the one or more frames of image data on a frame-by-frame basis.

112. The method of claim 1 10, wherein the VFE modifies the focus of the one or more frames of image data on a pixel-by-pixel basis.

113. The method of claim 107, wherein the VFE modifies the first focus to produce a wavefront at a third focus, wherein the second focus is different than the third focus.

114. The method of claim 107, wherein the wavefront at the second focus is perceived by the user as coming from a particular depth plane.

115. The method of claim 107, wherein the VFE is telecentric.

116. The method of claim 107 wherein the VFE is non-telecentric.

117. The method of claim 107, further comprising a compensating lens such that the user's view of the outside world is undistorted.

118. The method of claim 107, wherein a plurality of frames are presented to the user at a high frequency such that the user perceives the frames as part of a single coherent scene, wherein the VFE varies the focus from a first frame to a second frame.

119. The method of claim 107, wherein the light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus in a line-by-line manner.

120. The method of claim 107, wherein the VFE is a diffractive lens.

121. The method of claim 107, wherein the VFE is a refractive lens.

122. The method of claim 107, wherein the VFE is a reflective mirror.

123. The method of claim 107, wherein the reflective mirror is opaque.

123. The method of claim 107, wherein the reflective mirror is partially reflective.

124. The method of claim 107, further comprising an accommodation module to track an accommodation of a user's eyes, and wherein the VFE varies the focus of the light patterns based at least in part on the accommodation of the user's eyes.

125. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising: a plurality of waveguides to receive light rays associated with image data and to transmit the light rays toward the user's eyes, wherein the plurality of waveguides are stacked in a direction facing the user's eye; and

a first lens coupled to a first waveguide of the plurality of waveguides to modify light rays transmitted from the first waveguide, thereby delivering light rays having a first wavefront curvature; and

a second lens coupled to a second waveguide of the plurality of waveguides to modify light rays transmitted from the second waveguide, thereby delivering light rays having a second wavefront curvature, wherein the first lens coupled to the first waveguide and the second lens coupled to the second waveguide are stacked horizontally in a direction facing the user's eye.

126. The system of claim 125, wherein the first wavefront curvature is different from the second wavefront curvature.

127. The system of claim 125, further comprising a third waveguide of the plurality of waveguides to deliver collimated light to the user's eye, such that the user perceives the image data as coming from an optical infinity plane.

128. The system of claim 125, wherein the waveguide is configured to transmit collimated light to the lens.

129. The system of claim 125, further comprising a compensating lens layer to compensate for an aggregate power of the lenses stacked in the direction facing the user's eyes, wherein the compensating lens layer is stacked farthest from the user's eye.

130. The system of claim 125, wherein the waveguide comprises a plurality of reflectors configurable to reflect the light rays injected into the waveguide toward the user's eye.

131. The system of claim 125, wherein the waveguide is electro-active.

132. The system of claim 125, wherein the waveguide is switchable.

133. The system of claim 125, wherein the light rays having the first wavefront curvature and the light rays having the second wavefront curvature are delivered simultaneously.

134. The system of claim 125, wherein the light rays having the first wavefront curvature and the light rays having the second wavefront curvature are delivered sequentially.

135. The system of claim 133, wherein the second wavefront curvature corresponds to a margin of the first wavefront curvature, thereby providing a focal range in which the user can accommodate.

136. The method of claim 125, further comprising an accommodation module to track an accommodation of a user's eyes, and wherein the VFE varies the focus of the light patterns based at least in part on the accommodation of the user's eyes.

137. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data; and

a plurality of waveguides to receive the one or more light patterns and to direct light toward an exit pupil, wherein the plurality of waveguides are stacked along a z-axis; and

at least one optical element to modify a focus of the light transmitted by the plurality of waveguides.

138. The system of claim 137, wherein a waveguide of the plurality of waveguides comprises a waveguide to distribute the projected light across the length of the waveguide, and a an optical element to modify the light in a manner such that a wavefront curvature is created, wherein the created wavefront curvature corresponds to a focal plane when viewed by the user.

139. The system of claim 137, wherein a waveguide of the plurality of waveguides comprises a diffractive optical element (DOE)

140. The system of claim 137, wherein the DOE is switchable between an on and off state.

141. The system of claim 137, wherein the at least one optical element comprises a refractive lens.

142. The system of claim 137, wherein the at least one optical element comprises a Fresnel zone plate.

143. The system of claim 137, wherein a waveguide of the plurality of waveguides comprises a waveguide element.

144. The system of claim 143, wherein the waveguide is switchable between an on and off state.

145. The system of claim 137, wherein the waveguide is a static.

146. The system of claim 137, wherein the first frame of image data and second frame of image data are delivered to the user's eye simultaneously.

147. The system of claim 137, wherein the first frame of image data and second frame of image data are delivered to the user's eye sequentially.

148. The system of claim 137, further comprising a plurality of angled reflectors to deliver light to the user's eye, wherein the first waveguide component and the second waveguide component direct light to the one or more angled reflectors.

149. The system of claim 137, further comprising a beam distribution waveguide optic, the beam distribution waveguide coupled to the waveguide assembly, wherein the beam distribution waveguide optic is configurable to spread the projected light across the waveguide assembly, such that a light ray injected into the beam distributed waveguide optic is cloned and injected into waveguide components of the waveguide assembly.

150. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time- sequential manner;

a light modulator to project light associated with the one or more frames of image data; a waveguide assembly to receiving the projected light and deliver the light towards the user's eye, wherein the waveguide assembly comprises at least a first waveguide component configurable to modify light associated with a first frame of the image data such the light is perceived as coming from a first focal plane, and a second waveguide component configurable to modify light associated with a second frame of the image data such that the light is perceived as coming from a second focal plane, and wherein the first waveguide component and second waveguide component are stacked along a z-axis in front of the user's eye.

151. The system of claim 150, wherein a waveguide component of the waveguide assembly comprises a waveguide to distribute the projected light across the length of the waveguide, and a lens to modify the light in a manner such that a wavefront curvature is created, wherein the created wavefront curvature corresponds to a focal plane when viewed by the user.

152. The system of claim 150, wherein a waveguide component of the waveguide assembly comprises a diffractive optical element (DOE)

153. The system of claim 150, wherein the DOE is switchable between an on and off state.

154. The system of claim 150, wherein a waveguide component of the waveguide assembly comprises a refractive lens.

155. The system of claim 150, wherein a waveguide component of the waveguide assembly comprises a Fresnel zone plate.

156. The system of claim 150, wherein a waveguide component of the waveguide assembly comprises a substrate guided optics (SGO) element.

157. The system of claim 150, wherein the waveguide is switchable between an on and off state.

158. The system of claim 150, wherein the waveguide is a static.

159. The system of claim 150, wherein the first frame of image data and second frame of image data are delivered to the user's eye simultaneously.

160. The system of claim 150, wherein the first frame of image data and second frame of image data are delivered to the user's eye sequentially.

161. The system of claim 150, further comprising a plurality of angled reflectors to deliver light to the user's eye, wherein the first waveguide component and the second waveguide component direct light to the one or more angled reflectors.

162. The system of claim 150, further comprising a beam distribution waveguide optic, the beam distribution waveguide coupled to the waveguide assembly, wherein the beam distribution waveguide optic is configurable to spread the projected light across the waveguide assembly, such that a light ray injected into the beam distributed waveguide optic is cloned and injected into waveguide components of the waveguide assembly.

163. The system of claim 150, wherein a waveguide component of the waveguide assembly comprises a reflector configurable to reflect the projected light at a desired angle toward the user's eye.

164. The system of claim 150, wherein the first waveguide component comprises a first reflector configured to reflect the projected light at a first angle, and wherein the second waveguide component comprises a second reflector to reflect the projected light at a second angle.

165. The system of claim 150, wherein the first reflector is staggered in relation to the second reflector, thereby expanding a field of view of the image as viewed by the user.

166. The system of claim 150, wherein the reflectors of the waveguide components are positioned in a manner to form a continuous curved reflection surface across the waveguide assembly.

167. The system of claim 166, wherein the continuous curved reflection surface comprises a parabolic curve.

168. The system of claim 166, wherein the continuous curved reflection surface comprises an elliptical curve.

169. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising:

delivering, through a first waveguide, light rays associated with a first frame of image data to the user, the light rays having a first wavefront curvature; and

delivering, through a second waveguide, light rays associated with a second frame of image data to the user, the light rays having a second wavefront curvature, wherein the first waveguide and second waveguide are stacked along a z axis facing the user's eyes.

170. The method of claim 169, wherein the first wavefront curvature and the second wavefront curvature are delivered simultaneously.

171. The method of claim 169, wherein the first wavefront curvature and the second wavefront curvature are delivered sequentially.

172. The method of claim 169, wherein the first and second wavefront curvatures are perceived as a first and second depth plane by the user.

173. The method of claim 169, wherein the first and second waveguides are coupled to one or more optical elements.

174. The method of claim 172, further comprising compensating for an effect of the one or more optical elements through a compensation lens.

175. The method of claim 169 further comprising

determining an accommodation of the user's eyes; and

delivering light rays through at least one of the first and second waveguides based at least in part on the determined accommodation.

175. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising:

determining an accommodation of the user's eyes;

delivering, through a first waveguide of a stack of waveguides, light rays having a first wavefront curvature based at least in part on the determined accommodation, wherein the first wavefront curvature corresponds to a focal distance of the determined accommodation; and delivering, through a second waveguide of the stack of waveguides, light rays having a second wavefront curvature, the second wavefront curvature associated with a predetermined margin of the focal distance of the determined accommodation.

176. The method of claim 175, wherein the margin is a positive margin.

177. The method of claim 175, wherein the margin is a negative margin.

178. The method of claim 175, wherein the second waveguide increases a focal range in which the user can accommodate.

179. The method of claim 175, wherein the first waveguide is coupled to a variable focus element (VFE), wherein the VFE varies a focus at which the waveguide focuses the light rays.

180. The method of claim 179, wherein the focus is varied based at least in part on the determined accommodation of the users' eyes.

182. The method of claim 175, wherein the first wavefront curvature and the second wavefront curvature are delivered simultaneously.

183. The method of claim 175, wherein the first and second wavefront curvatures are perceived as a first and second depth plane by the user.

184. The method of claim 175, wherein the waveguide is a diffractive optical element

(DOE).

185. The method of claim 175, wherein the waveguide is a substrate guided optic

(SGO).

186. The method of claim 175, wherein the first and second waveguides are switchable.

187. The method of claim 175, wherein the waveguide comprises one or more switchable elements.

189. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, the system comprising:

an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time- sequential manner;

a display assembly to project light rays associated with the one or more frames of image data, the display assembly comprises a first display element corresponding to a first frame-rate and a first bit depth, and a second display element corresponding to a second frame-rate and a second bit depth; and

a variable focus element (VFE) configurable to vary a focus of the projected light and transmit the light to the user's eye.

190. The system of claim 189, wherein the first frame-rate is higher than the second frame-rate, and the first bit depth is lower than the second bit depth.

191. The system of claim 189, wherein the first display element is a DLP projection system.

192. The system of claim 189, wherein the second display element is a liquid crystal display (LCD).

193. The system of claim 189, wherein the first display element projects light to a subset of the second display element such that a periphery of the LCD has constant illumination.

194. The system of claim 193, wherein only light transmitted from the first display element is focused through the VFE.

195. The system of claim 189, wherein the VFE is optically conjugate to an exit pupil, such that a focus of the projected light is varied without affecting a magnification of the image data.

196. The system of claim 189, wherein the first display element is a DLP, and the second display element is an LCD, and wherein the DLP is of low resolution, and wherein the LCD is of high resolution.

197. The system of claim 189, wherein an intensity of backlight is varied over time to equalize a brightness of sub-images projected by the first display element, thereby increase a frame rate of the first display element.

198. The system of claim 189, wherein the VFE is configurable to vary the focus of the projected light on a frame-by-frame basis.

199. The system of claim 189, further comprising software to compensate for optical magnification associated with an operation of the VFE.

200. The system of claim 189, wherein the image-generating source produces slices of a particular image that when projected together or sequentially produces a three- dimensional volume of an object.

201. The system of claim 189, wherein the DLP is operated in a binary mode.

202. The system of claim 189, wherein the DLP is operated in a grayscale mode.

203. The system of claim 189, wherein the VFE varies the projected light such that a first frame is perceived as coming from a first focal plane, and a second frame is perceived as coming from a second focal plane, wherein the first focal plane is different from the second focal plane.

204. The system of claim 189, wherein a focal distance associated with the focal plane is fixed.

205. The system of claim 189, wherein a focal distance associated with the focal plane is variable.

206. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising:

providing one or more image slices, wherein a first and second image slice of the one or more image slices represents a three-dimensional volume;

projecting light associated with the first image slice through a spatial light modulator; focusing, through a variable focus element (VFE), the first image slice to a first focus; delivering the first image slice having the first focus to the user;

providing light associated with the second image slice;

focusing, through the VFE, the second image slice to a second focus, wherein the first focus is different from the second focus; and

delivering the second image slice having the second focus to the user.

207. The method of claim 206, further comprising determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the VFE focuses the projected light based at least in part on the determined accommodation.

208. The method of claim 206, wherein the image slices are provided in a frame- sequential fashion.

209. The method of claim 206, wherein the first image slice and the second image slice are delivered simultaneously.

210. The method of claim 206, wherein the first image slice and the second image slice are delivered sequentially.

21 1. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising: combining a first display element with a second display element, the first display element corresponding to a high frame rate and a low bit depth, and the second display element corresponding to a low frame rate and a high bit depth, such that the combined display elements correspond to a high frame rate and high bit depth; and

projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data through the combined display elements; and

switching a focus of the projected light, through a variable focus element (VFE), on a frame-by-frame basis, such that a first image slice is projected at a first focus, and a second image slice is projected at a second focus.

212. The method of claim 21 1 , wherein the first display element is a DLP.

213. The method of claim 21 1 , wherein the second display element is an LCD.

214. The method of claim 21 1 , wherein the first display element selectively illuminates portions of the second display element.

215. The method of claim 21 1 , wherein the VFE is a deformable membrane mirror.

216. The method of claim 21 1 , wherein the VFE is optically conjugate to an exit pupil.

217. The method of claim 21 1 , wherein the VFE is not optically conjugate to an exit pupil.

218. The method of claim 21 1 , wherein the first and second image slice represent a three dimensional virtual object.

219. The method of claim 212, wherein the DLP operates in a binary mode.

220. The method of claim 212, wherein the DLP operates in a grayscale mode.

221. The method of claim 220, wherein the grayscale imparts a perception to the user's brain that something resides adjacent two depth planes.

222. The method of claim 21 1 , wherein the display elements are combined for image modulation.

223. The method of claim 21 1 , wherein the display elements are combined to create a high dynamic range display.

224. The method of claim 21 1 , wherein the VFE switches focuses between a predetermined number of fixed depth planes.

225. The method of claim 21 1 , further comprises determining an accommodation of a user's eyes, wherein the VFE switches focus based at least in part on the determined accommodation.

226. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a plurality of lightguides to receive coherent light associated with one or more frames of image data and to produce an aggregate wavefront; a phase modulator coupled to one or more lightguides of the plurality of light guides to induce a phase delay in the light projected by the one or more lightguides; and

a processor to control the phase modulator in a manner such that the aggregate wavefront produced by the plurality of lightguides is varied.

227. The system of claim 226, wherein a wavefront produced a lightguide of the plurality of light guides is a spherical wavefront.

228. The system of claim 227, wherein the spherical wavefronts produced by at least two lightguides constructively interfere with each other.

229. The system of claim 227, wherein the spherical wavefronts produced by the at least two lightguides destructively interfere with each other.

230. The system of claim 226, wherein the aggregate wavefront is an approximately planar wavefront.

231. The system of claim 230, wherein the planar wavefront corresponds to an optical infinity depth plane.

232. The system of claim 226, wherein the aggregate wavefront is spherical.

233. The system of claim 232, wherein the spherical wavefront corresponds to a depth plane closer than optical infinity.

235. The system of claim 232, wherein an inverse Fourier transform of a desired beam is injected into the multicore fibers, such that a desired aggregate wavefront is produced.

236. A system of displaying virtual content to a user, the system comprising:

an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data;

a multicore assembly comprising a plurality of multicore fibers to project light associated with the one or more frames of image data, a multicore fiber of the plurality of multicore fibers emitting light in a wavefront, such that the multicore assembly produces an aggregate wavefront of the projected light; and

a phase modulator to induce phase delays between the multicore fibers in a manner such that the aggregate wavefront emitted by the multicore assembly is varied, thereby varying a focal distance at which the user perceives the one or more frames of image data.

237. The system of claim 236, wherein an inverse Fourier transform of a desired beam is injected into the multicore fibers, such that a desired aggregate wavefront is produced.

238. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

emitting light through a multicore fiber, the multicore fiber comprising a plurality of single core fibers, wherein the singlecore fibers emit a spherical wavefront;

providing an aggregate wavefront from light emitted from the plurality of single core fibers; and inducing a phase delay between the singlecore fibers of the multicore fiber such the aggregate wavefront produced by the multicore fiber is varied based at least in part on the induced phase delay.

239. The method of claim 238, wherein the aggregate wavefront is a planar wavefront.

240. The method of claim 239, wherein the planar wavefront corresponds to optical infinity.

241. The method of claim 238, wherein the aggregate wavefront is spherical.

242. The method of claim 241 , wherein the spherical wavefront corresponds to a depth plane closer than optical infinity.

243. The method of claim 238, further comprising injecting an inverse Fourier transform of a desired wavefront into the multicore fiber such that the aggregate wavefront corresponds to the desired wavefront.

245. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, the system comprising:

an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data;

a multicore assembly comprising a plurality of multicore fibers to project light associated with the one or more frames of image data;

an image injector to input images into the multicore assembly, wherein the input injector is further configurable to input an inverse Fourier transform of a desired wavefront into the multicore assembly such that the multicore assembly outputs the Fourier transform by producing light associated with the image data in the desired wavefront, thereby allowing the user to perceive the image data at a desired focal distance.

246. The system of claim 245, wherein the desired wavefront is associated with a hologram.

247. The system of claim 245, wherein the inverse Fourier transform is input to modulate a focus of the one or more light beams.

248. The system of claim 245, wherein a multicore fiber of the plurality of multicore fibers is a multi-mode fiber.

249. The system of claim 245, wherein the multicore fiber of the plurality of multicore fibers is configured to propagate light along a plurality of paths along the fiber.

250. The system of claim 245, wherein the multicore fiber is a single core fiber.

251. The system of claim 245, wherein the multicore fiber is a concentric core fiber.

252. The system of claim 245, wherein the image injector is configured to input a wavelet pattern into the multicore assembly.

253. The system of claim 245, wherein the image injector is configured to input a Zernike coefficient into the multicore assembly.

254. The system of claim 245, further comprising an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of the user's eye, wherein the image injector is configured to input an inverse Fourier transform of a wavefront corresponding to the determined accommodation of the user's eyes.

255. A method of displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising:

determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the determined accommodation is associated with a focal distance corresponding to a user's current state of focus;

projecting, through a waveguide, light associated with one or more frames of image data;

varying a focus of the projected light based at least in part on the determined accommodation; and

delivering the projected light to the user's eyes.

256. The method of claim 255, wherein the accommodation is measured directly.

257. The method of claim 255, wherein the accommodation is measured indirectly.

258. The method of claim 256, wherein the accommodation is measured through an infrared autorefractor.

259. The method of claim 256, wherein the accommodation is measured through eccentric photorefraction.

260. The method of claim 257, further comprising measuring a convergence level of two eyes of the user to estimate the accommodation.

261. The method of claim 255, further comprising blurring one or more portions of the one or more frames of image data based at least in part on the determined accommodation.

262. The method of claim 255, wherein the focus is varied between fixed depth planes.

263. The method of claim 255, further comprising a compensating lens to compensate for an optical effect of the waveguide, such that an outside environment is perceived at zero magnification.

264. A method of displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising:

determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the determined

accommodation is associated with a focal distance corresponding to a user's current state of focus;

projecting, through a diffractive optics element (DOE), light associated with one or more frames of image data;

varying a focus of the projected light based at least in part on the determined accommodation; and

delivering the projected light to the user's eyes.

265. The method of claim 264, wherein the accommodation is measured directly.

266. The method of claim 264, wherein the accommodation is measured indirectly.

267. The method of claim 265, wherein the accommodation is measured through an infrared autorefractor.

268. The method of claim 265, wherein the accommodation is measured through eccentric photorefraction.

269. The method of claim 266, further comprising measuring a convergence level of two eyes of the user to estimate the accommodation.

270. The method of claim 264, further comprising blurring one or more portions of the one or more frames of image data based at least in part on the determined accommodation.

271. The method of claim 264, wherein the focus is varied between fixed depth planes.

272. The method of claim 264, further comprising a compensating lens to compensate for an optical effect of the DOE, such that an outside environment is perceived at zero magnification.

273 A method of displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising:

determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the determined

accommodation is associated with a focal distance corresponding to a user's current state of focus;

projecting, through a freeform optic, light associated with one or more frames of image data;

varying a focus of the projected light based at least in part on the determined accommodation; and

delivering the projected light to the user's eyes.

274. The method of claim 273, wherein the accommodation is measured directly.

275. The method of claim 273, wherein the accommodation is measured indirectly.

275. The method of claim 274, wherein the accommodation is measured through an infrared autorefractor.

276. The method of claim 274, wherein the accommodation is measured through eccentric photorefraction.

277. The method of claim 275, further comprising measuring a convergence level of two eyes of the user to estimate the accommodation.

278. The method of claim 273, further comprising blurring one or more portions of the one or more frames of image data based at least in part on the determined accommodation.

279. The method of claim 273, wherein the focus is varied between fixed depth planes.

280. The method of claim 273, further comprising a compensating lens to compensate for an optical effect of the freeform optic, such that an outside environment is perceived at zero magnification.

281. A method of displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising:

determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the determined

accommodation is associated with a focal distance corresponding to a user's current state of focus;

projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data;

varying a focus of the projected light based at least in part on the determined accommodation; and

delivering the projected light to the user's eyes, such that the light is perceived by the user as coming from the focal distance corresponding to the user's current state of focus.

282. The method of claim 281 , wherein the light is delivered to the user through a substrate guided optics assembly.

283. The method of claim 281 , wherein the light is delivered to the user through a freeform optical element.

284. The method of claim 281 , wherein the light is delivered to the user through a diffractive optical element (DOE).

285. The method of claim 281 , wherein the light is projected through a stack of waveguides, a first of the stack of waveguide configured to output light at a particular wavefront, a second waveguide to output a positive margin wavefront relative to the particular wavefront, a third waveguide to output a negative margin wavefront relative to the particular wavefront.

286. The method of claim 281 , further comprising blurring a portion of the one or more frames of image data in a manner such that the portion is out of focus when the projected light is delivered to the user's eyes.

287. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time- sequential manner;

a light generator to provide light associated with the one or more frames of image data; an accommodation tracking module to track an accommodation of the user's eye; and a waveguide assembly to vary a focus of the light associated with the one or more frames of image data, wherein different frames of image data are focused differently based at least in part on the tracked accommodation.

288. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of the user's eyes; an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time- sequential manner;

a light generator to project light associated with the one or more frames of image data; a plurality of waveguides to receive light rays associated with image data and to transmit the light rays toward the user's eyes, wherein the plurality of waveguides are stacked in a direction facing the user's eye; and

a variable focus element (VFE) to vary a focus of the transmitted light based at least in part on the determined accommodation of the user's eyes.

289. The system of claim 288, wherein a waveguide of the plurality of waveguides is a waveguide element, wherein the focus of a first frame of image data transmitted from a first waveguide of the plurality of waveguides is different from the focus of a second frame of image data transmitted from a second waveguide of the plurality of waveguides.

290. The system of claim 288, wherein the first frame is a first layer of a 3D scene, and a second frame is a second layer of the 3D scene.

291. The system of claim 288, further comprising a blurring module to blur a portion of the one or more frames of image data in a manner such that the portion is out of focus when viewed by the user.

292. The system of claim 288, wherein the VFE is common to the plurality of waveguides.

293. The system of claim 288, wherein the VFE is associated with a waveguide of the plurality of waveguides.

294. The system of claim 288, wherein the VFE is coupled to a waveguide of the plurality of waveguides, such that the VFE is interleaved between two waveguides of the plurality of waveguides.

295. The system of claim 288, wherein the VFE is embedded into a waveguide of the plurality of waveguides.

296 The system of claim 288, wherein the VFE is a diffractive optical element.

297. The system of claim 288, wherein the VFE is a refractive element.

298. The system of claim 288, wherein the VFE is a reflective element.

299. The system of claim 288, wherein the waveguide is electro-active.

300. The system of claim 288, wherein one or more waveguides of the plurality of waveguides is switched off.

301. The system of claim 288, wherein a waveguide of the plurality of waveguides corresponds to a fixed focal plane.

302. The system of claim 288, further comprising an exit pupil, wherein a diameter of the exit pupil is no greater than 0.5 mm.

303. The system of claim 288, wherein the light generator is a scanning fiber display.

304. The system of claim 302, further comprising an array of exit pupils.

305. The system of claim 302, further comprising a plurality of light generators, a light generator coupled to an exit pupil.

306. The system of claim288 further comprising an exit pupil expander.

307. The system of claim 302, wherein the exit pupil is switchable based at least in part on the determined accommodation of the user's eyes.

308. A system comprising;

an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of a user's eyes; a fiber scanning display to scan a plurality of light beams associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein a light beam of the plurality of light beams is movable;

a blur software to render a simulated dioptric blur in the one or more frames of image data based at least in part on the determined accommodation of the user's eyes.

309. The system of claim 308, wherein the diameter of light beams is no greater than

2 mm.

310. The system of claim 308, wherein the diameter of light beams is no greater than 0.5 mm.

31 1. The system of claim 308, wherein a scanned light beam is duplicated to create a plurality of exit pupils.

312. The system of claim 308, wherein the scanned light beam is duplicated to create a larger eye box.

313. The system of claim 31 1 , wherein the exit pupils are switchable.

314. A method for displaying virtual content, comprising:

determining an accommodation of a user's eyes;

scanning a plurality of light beams associated with one or more frames of image data, through a fiber scanning display, wherein a diameter of the light beam is no greater than 0.5 mm, such that the frames of image data appear in focus when viewed by the user; and

blurring, using blur software, one or more portions of the frame based at least in part on the determined accommodation of the user's eyes.

315. The method of claim 314, wherein a plurality of exit pupils are created.

316. The method of claim 314, wherein the light beam is generated by a singlecore fiber.

317. The method of claim 314, wherein the light beam is duplicated to create a plurality of exit pupils.

318. The method of claim 317, wherein the exit pupils are switchable.

319. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising: determining a position of the user's pupil relative to a bundle of light projectors, wherein the bundle of light projectors corresponds to a sub-image of an image to be presented to the user; and

driving, based on the determined position of the user's pupil, light corresponding to the sub-image into a portion of the user's pupil.

320. The method of claim 319, further comprising driving light corresponding to another sub-image of the image to be presented to another portion of the user's pupil through another bundle of light projectors.

321. The method of claim 319, further comprising mapping one or more bundles of light projectors of the fiber scanning display with one or more portions of the user's pupil.

322. The method of claim 321 , wherein the mapping is a 1 :1 mapping.

323. The method of claim 319, wherein a diameter of the light is no greater than 0.5 mm.

324. The method of claim 319, wherein the bundle of light projectors produces an aggregate wavefront.

325. The method of claim 319, wherein beamlets produced by the light projectors form a discretized aggregate wavefront.

326. The method of claim 325, wherein when the beamlets approach the user's eye in parallel, the eye deflects the beamlets to converge upon a same spot on the retina.

327. The method of claim 319, wherein the user's eye receives a superset of beamlets, the beamlets corresponding to a plurality of angles at which they interest the pupil.

328. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a light source to provide light associated with one or more frames of image data; and a light display assembly to receive the light associated with the one or more frames of image data, wherein the light display assembly corresponds to multiple exit pupils spaced together, and wherein the multiple exit pupils transmit light into a pupil of the user.

329. The system of claim 328, wherein the multiple exit pupils are arranged in a hexagonal lattice.

330. The system of claim 328, wherein the multiple exit pupils are arranged in a square lattice.

331. The system of claim 328, wherein the multiple exit pupils are arranged in a two- dimensional array.

332. The system of claim 328, wherein the multiple exit pupils are arranged in a three- dimensional array.

333. The system of claim 328, wherein the multiple exit pupils are arranged in a time- varying array.

334. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising:

grouping a plurality of light projectors to form an exit pupil;

driving a first light pattern, through a first exit pupil, into a first portion of the user's pupil; and

driving a second light pattern, through a second exit pupil, into a second portion of the user's pupil, wherein the first light pattern and second light pattern corresponds to sub-images of an image to be presented to the user, and wherein the first light pattern is different than the second light pattern.

335. The method of claim 334, wherein the plurality of light projectors is arranged in a hexagonal lattice.

336. The method of claim 334, wherein the plurality of light projectors is arranged in a square lattice.

337. The method of claim 334, wherein the plurality of light projectors is arranged in a two-dimensional array.

338. The method of claim 334, wherein the plurality of light projectors is arranged in a three-dimensional array.

339. The method of claim 334, wherein the plurality of light projectors is arranged in a time-varying array.

340. The method of claim 334, wherein the first portion of the user's pupil only receives light from the first exit pupil, and wherein the second portion of the user's pupil only receives light from the second exit pupil.

341. The method of claim 334, further comprising creating a discretized aggregate wavefront.

342. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

determining a location of a pupil of the user relative to a light display assembly; and calculating a focus at which to direct light to the pupil based at least in part on a limited eye box around the determined location of the pupil.

343. The method of claim 342, wherein a diameter of light is no greater than 0.5 mm.

344. The method of claim 342, further comprising creating a discretized aggregate wavefront.

345. The method of claim 344, further comprising aggregating a plurality of discrete neighboring collimated light beams based at least in part on a center of a radius of curvature of a desired aggregate wavefront.

346. The method of claim 344, further comprising determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the focus is calculated based at least in part on the determined accommodation.

347. The method of claim 346, selecting an angular trajectory of light of a plurality of beamlets to create an out-of focus light beam.

348. The method of claim 342, wherein a plurality of beamlets represent a pixel of image data to the presented to the user.

349. The method of claim 348, wherein the beamlets hit the eye at a plurality of incident angles.

350. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, the system comprising:

an image generating source to provide one or more portions of an image to be presented to the user; and

a plurality of microprojectors to project light associated with the one or more portions of the image, the microprojectors positioned in a manner facing the user's pupil, and wherein a microprojector of the plurality of microprojectors is configured to project a set of light rays representing a portion of the sub-image, the set of light rays projected to a portion of the user's pupil.

351. The system of claim 350, wherein a first portion of the user's pupil receives light rays from a plurality of microprojectors.

352. The system of claim 350, further comprising a reflective surface to reflect the light from the plurality of microprojectors to one or more portions of the user's pupil.

353. The system of claim 350, wherein the reflective surface is positioned in a manner such that the user is able to view the real world through the reflective surface.

354. The system of claim 350, wherein a diameter of light is no greater than 0.5 mm.

355. The system of claim 350, further comprising creating a discretized aggregate wavefront.

356. The system of claim 350, further comprising aggregating a plurality of discrete neighboring collimated light beams based at least in part on a center of a radius of curvature of a desired aggregate wavefront.

357. The system of claim 350, further comprising determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the focus is calculated based at least in part on the determined accommodation.

358. The system of claim 350, selecting an angular trajectory of light of a plurality of beamlets to create an out-of focus light beam.

359. The system of claim 350, wherein a plurality of beamlets represent a pixel of image data to the presented to the user.

360. The system of claim 351 , wherein the beamlets hit the eye at a plurality of incident angles.

361. A system comprising: a processor to determine a location of a user's pupil; and

an array of spatial light modulators (SLMs) to project light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the array of SLMs are positioned based at least in part on the determined location of the user's pupil, and wherein the array of SLMs generate a lightfield when viewed by the user.

362. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, the system comprising:

an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data;

a first spatial light modulator (SLM) configured to selectively transmit light rays associated with the one or more frames of image data;

a second SLM positioned in relation to the first SLM, the second SLM also configured to selectively transmit light rays associated with the one or more frames of image data; and a processor to control the first and second SLMs in a manner such that a lightfield is created when the transmitted light rays are viewed by the user.

363. The system of claim 361 or 362, further comprising an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of the user's eyes.

364. The system of claim 361 or 362, wherein the SLM is an LCD.

365. The system of claim 361 or 362, wherein the LCD is attenuated.

366. The system of claim 361 or 362, wherein the LCD rotates a polarization of the transmitted light.

367. The system of claim 361 or 362, wherein the SLM is a DMD.

368. The system of claim 362, wherein the DMD is coupled to one or more lenses.

369. The system of claim 361 or 362, wherein the SLM is a MEMs array.

370. The system of claim 369, wherein the MEMs array comprises an array of sliding MEMs shutters.

371. The system of claim 369, wherein the MEMs array is a Pixtronics ® MEMs array.

372. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a plurality of optical fibers to project light associated with one or more frames of image data to be presented to the user, wherein an optical fiber core of the plurality of optical fiber cores is coupled to a lens, the lens configured to alter a diameter of the light beam projected by the scanning fiber, wherein the lens comprises a gradient refractive index.

373. The system of claim 372, wherein the lens is a GRIN lens.

374. The system of claim 372, wherein the lens collimates the light beams.

375. The system of claim 372, further comprising an actuator coupled to the optical fiber core of the plurality of optical fiber cores to scan the fiber.

376. The system of claim 375, wherein the actuator is a piezo-electric actuator.

377. The system of claim 372, wherein an end of the optical fiber core is polished at an angle to create a lensing effect.

378. The system of claim 372, wherein an end of the optical fiber core is melted to create a lensing effect.

379. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light is projected through a plurality of optical fiber cores;

modifying the light projected through the plurality of optical fiber cores through a lens, wherein the lens is coupled to a tip of the plurality of optical fiber cores; and

delivering the modified light to the user.

380. The method of claim 379, wherein the lens is a GRIN lens.

381. The method of claim 379, wherein the lens comprises a gradient refractive index.

382. The method of claim 379, wherein the lens collimates light beams projected by the optical fiber cores.

383. The method of claim 379, wherein the lens is coupled to a plurality of optical fiber cores.

384. The method of claim 379, wherein the lens is coupled to a single optical fiber core.

385. The method of claim 379, wherein one or more optical fiber cores include a polished end to create a lensing effect.

386. The method of claim 367, wherein one or more optical fiber cores are melted to create a lensing effect.

387. A system for displaying virtual content, comprising:

a multicore assembly comprising a plurality of fibers to multiplex light associated with one or more frames of image data; and

a waveguide to receive the light patterns, and transmit the light patterns such that a first viewing zone only receives light associated with a first portion of an image, and a second viewing zone only receives light associated with a second portion of the image, wherein the first and second viewing zone is no greater than 0.5 mm.

388. The system of claim 387, further comprising blurring software to blur out one or more portions of the frames of image data.

389. The system of claim 387, further comprising an accommodation module to determine an accommodation of the user's eyes.

390. The system of claim 387, wherein the waveguide projects light to a user's eye directly without an intermediate viewing optic.

391. A system comprising: a multicore assembly comprising a plurality of fibers to multiplex light associated with one or more frames of image data;

a waveguide to receive the light patterns, and transmit the light patterns such that a first viewing zone only receives light associated with a first portion of an image, and a second viewing zone only receives light associated with a second portion of the image, wherein the first and second viewing zone is no greater than 0.5 mm; and

an optical assembly coupled to the waveguide to modify the transmitted light beams to the first and second viewing zones.

392. The system of claim 391 , wherein the plurality of fibers project light into a single waveguide array.

393. The system of claim 391 wherein the multicore assembly is scanned.

394. The system of claim 391 , wherein a time-varying light field is generated.

395. The system of claim 391 , wherein the optical assembly is a DOE element.

396. The system of claim 391 , wherein the optical assembly is an LC layer.

397. A method comprising:

projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data through a multicore assembly, the multicore assembly comprising a plurality of optical fiber cores; and

delivering the projected light, through a waveguide, such that a first portion of the user's pupil receives light associated with a first portion of an image, and a second portion of the user's pupil receives light associated with a second portion of the image.

398. The method of claim 397, wherein a diameter of the first and second portions is no greater than 0.5 mm.

399. The method of claim 397, wherein the plurality of optical fiber cores project light into a single waveguide array.

400. The method of claim 397, wherein the multicore assembly is scanned.

401. The method of claim 397, wherein the waveguide comprises a plurality of reflectors.

402. The method of claim 401 , wherein an angle of the reflectors is variable.

403. The method of claim 397, further comprising a set of optics to modify light being delivered to the first and second viewing zones.

404. The method of claim 403, wherein the set of optics is a DOE element.

405. The method of claim 403, wherein the set of optics is a freeform optic.

406. The method of claim 403, wherein the set of optics is an LC layer.

407. A system comprising: an array of microprojectors to project light associated with one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user, wherein the array of microprojectors is positioned relative to a location of the user's pupil, and wherein the light is projected into the user's pupil.

408. The fiber scanning display of claim 407, wherein the first and second light beams are superimposed.

409. The fiber scanning display of claim 407, wherein the first and second light beam are deflected based at least in part on the critical angle of the polished bundled fiber.

410. The fiber scanning display of claim 407, wherein the polished bundled fibers is used to increase a resolution of the display.

41 1. The fiber scanning display of claim 407, wherein the polished bundled fibers is used to create a lightfield.

412. A system comprising:

an array of microprojectors to project light associated with one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user, wherein the array of microprojectors is positioned relative to a location of the user's pupil, and wherein the light is projected into the user's pupil; and

an optical element coupled to the array of microprojectors to modify the light projected into the user's pupil.

413. A system comprising:

a plurality of multicore fibers to transmit light beams, the plurality of beams coupled together; and

a coupling element to bundle the plurality of multicore fibers together, wherein the bundle of multicore fibers is polished at a critical angle relative to a longitudinal axis of the fiber such that a first light beam transmitted from a first fiber of the bundled fibers has a first path length, and a second light beam transmitted from a second fiber of the bundled fibers has a second path length, and wherein the first path length is different from the second path length such that the first light beam is out of phase relative to the second light beam.

414. The system of claim 412 or 413, wherein the first and second light beams are superimposed.

415. The system of claim 412 or 413, wherein the first and second light beam are deflected based at least in part on the critical angle of the polished bundled fiber.

416. The system of claim 412 or 413, wherein the polished bundled fibers is used to increase a resolution of the display.

417. The system of claim 412 or 413, wherein the polished bundled fibers is used to create a lightfield.

418. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data; a plurality of optical fiber cores to transmit light beams associated with the one or more frames of image data; and

an optical element coupled to the plurality of optical fiber cores to receive collimated light from the optical fiber cores and deliver the light beams to the user's eye, wherein the light beams are delivered at a plurality of angles to the user's eye such that a first light beam is delivered to a portion of a user's eye at a first angle, and a second light beam is delivered to the same portion of the user's eye at a second angle, wherein the first angle is different from the second angle.

419. The system of claim 418, wherein the optical element is a waveguide.

420. The system of claim 418, further comprising a phase modulator to modulate the transmission of light through the optical fiber cores.

421. A method comprising:

providing one or more frames of image data;

transmitting light beams associated with the one or more frames of image data through a plurality of optical fiber cores; and

delivering the light beams to the user's eyes at a plurality of angles.

422. The method of claim 421 , further comprising modulating a phase delay of the plurality of optical fiber cores.

423. The method of claim 421 , further comprising coupling an optical element to the plurality of optical fiber cores.

424. The method of claim 423, wherein the optical element is a waveguide.

425. The method of claim 423, wherein the optical element is a freeform optic.

426. The method of claim 423, wherein the optical element is a DOE.

427. The method of claim 423, wherein the optical element is an SGO.

428. A virtual reality display system comprising:

a plurality of optical fiber cores to generate light beams associated with one or more images to be presented to a user; and

a plurality of phase modulators coupled to the plurality of optical fiber cores to modulate the light beams, wherein the plurality of phase modulators modulate the light in a manner that affects a wavefront generated as a result of the plurality of light beams.

429. The virtual reality display system of claim 428, wherein one or more optical fiber cores are deflected, at one or more angles.

430. The virtual reality display system of claim 428, wherein an optical fiber of the plurality of optical fiber cores is coupled to a GRIN lens.

431. The virtual reality display system of claim 428, wherein the plurality of optical fiber cores is physically actuated to scan the optical fiber cores.

432. A method comprising:

providing one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user;

projecting, through a plurality of optical fiber cores, light associated with the one or more frames of image data; and

modulating the light, through a plurality of phase modulators, projects by the plurality of optical fiber cores in a manner that affects an aggregate wavefront produced by the plurality of optical fiber cores.

433. The method of claim 432, wherein light projected by the one or more optical fiber cores is deflected at one or more angles.

434. The method of claim 432, wherein one or more optical fiber cores is coupled to a GRIN lens.

435. The method of claim 432, further comprising scanning the optical light beams, wherein the plurality of optical fiber cores is physically actuated to scan the optical fiber cores.

436. A system for displaying virtual content, comprising;

an array of optical fiber cores to transmit light beams associated with an image to be presented to a user; and

a lens coupled to the array of the optical fiber cores to deflect a plurality of light beams output by the array of optical fiber cores through a single nodal point, wherein the lens is physically attached to the optical fiber cores such that a movement of the optical fiber core causes the lens to move, and wherein the single nodal point is scanned.

437. The system of claim 436, wherein the light beams output by the array of optical fiber cores represents a pixel of the image to be presented to the user.

438. The system of claim 436, wherein the lens is a GRIN lens.

439. The system of claim 436, where the array of optical fiber cores is used to display a lightfield.

440. The system of claim 436, wherein another set of light beams output by another array of optical fiber cores represents another pixel of the image to be presented to the user.

441. The system of claim 436, wherein multiple arrays of optical fiber cores are combined to represent a pixel of the image to be presented to the user.

442. The system of claim 436, wherein the array of optical fiber cores is configured to deliver the light beams to a predetermined portion of the user's pupil.

443. The system of claim 436, wherein the output light beams are diverging.

444. The system of claim 436, wherein the output light beams are converging.

445. The system of claim 436, wherein a numerical aperture of the output light beams is increased relative to the light beams transmitted by the individual optical fiber cores.

446. The system of claim 445, wherein the increased numerical aperture allows for higher resolution.

447. The system of claim 436, wherein the array of optical fiber cores is beveled in a manner such that a path length of a first light beam traveling through a first optical fiber is different than a second light beam traveling through a second optical fiber, thereby allowing for a plurality of focal lengths of the light beams delivered to the user's eye.

448. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, the system comprising:

an array of optical fiber cores to project light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein one or more optical fiber cores of the array of optical fiber cores is polished at an angle such that the projected light is deflected, and wherein the polished angle causes path length differences between a first and second optical fiber cores of the array of optical fiber cores relative to an optical element; and

a light scanner to receive the deflected light beams and to scan them in at least one axis.

449. A system to provide at least one of a virtual or an augmented reality experience to a user, the system comprising:

a frame;

an array of micro-projectors carried by the frame and positionable in front of at least one eye of the user when the frame is worn by the user; and

a local controller communicatively coupled to the array of micro-projectors to provide image information to the micro-projectors, the local controller comprising at least one processor, and at least one nontransitory processor readable media communicatively coupled to the at least one processor, the at least one nontransitory processor readable media which stores at last one of processor-executable instructions or data, which when executed by the at least one processor causes the at least one processor to at least one of process, cache, and store data and provide the image information to the micro-projectors to produce at least one of a virtual or an augmented reality visual experience to the user.

450. The system of claim 449, further comprising:

at least one reflector supported by the frame and positioned and oriented to direct light from the micro-projectors toward at least one eye of the user when the frame is worn by the user.

451. The system of claim 449 wherein the micro-projectors comprise respective ones of a plurality of scanning fiber displays.

452. The system of claim 449 wherein each of the scanning fiber displays has a respective collimating lens at a distal tip thereof. 453 The system of claim 449 wherein the respective collimating lens is a gradient refractive index (GRIN) lens.

454. The system of claim 449 wherein the respective collimating lens is a curved lens.

455. The system of claim 449 wherein the respective collimating lens is fused to the distal tip of the respective scanning fiber display.

456. The system of claim 449 wherein the scanning fiber displays has a respective diffractive lens at a distal tip thereof.

457. The system of claim 449 wherein each of the scanning fiber displays has a respective diffuser at a distal tip thereof.

458. The system of claim 457 wherein the diffuser is etched into the respective distal tip.

459. The system of claim 449 wherein each of the scanning fiber displays has a respective lens at a distal tip thereof, the lens which extends from the distal tip by a sufficient distance as to freely vibrate in response to a stimulus.

460. The system of claim 449 wherein each of the scanning fiber displays has a respective reflector at a distal tip thereof, the reflector which extends from the distal tip by a sufficient distance as to freely vibrate in response to a stimulus.

461. The system of claim 460 wherein scanning fiber displays each includes a respective single mode optical fiber.

462. The system of claim 460 wherein scanning fiber displays each include a respective mechanical transducer coupled to move at least a distal tip of the single mode optical fiber.

463. The system of claim 462 wherein the respective mechanical transducers are each piezoelectric actuators.

464. The system of claim 461 wherein each the single mode optical fiber cores has a distal tip, the distal tips having a hemispherical lens shape.

465. The system of claim 461 wherein each the single mode optical fiber cores has a distal tip, the distal tips having a refractive lens affixed thereto.

466. The system of claim 461 , further comprising:

a transparent holder substrate which retains the plurality of single mode optical fiber cores together.

467. The system of claim 461 wherein the transparent holder substrate has a refractive index that at least approximately matches a refractive index of a cladding of the single mode optical fiber cores.

468. The system of claim 461 wherein the transparent holder substrate retains the plurality of single mode optical fiber cores each angled toward a common spot.

469. The system of claim 461 , further comprising:

at least one mechanical transducer coupled to move the plurality of single mode optical fiber cores in unison.

470. The system of claim 449 wherein the at least one mechanical transducer vibrates the plurality of single mode optical fiber cores at a mechanical resonant frequency of the single mode optical fiber cores a portion of which are cantilevered out from the transparent holder substrate.

471. The system of claim 449 wherein the micro-projectors comprise respective ones of a plurality of planar waveguides, a portion of each of the planar waveguides which extends cantilevered from a holder substrate.

472. The system of claim 471 , further comprising:

at least one mechanical transducer coupled to move the plurality of planar waveguides in unison.

473. The system of claim 472 wherein the at least one mechanical transducer vibrates the holder substrate at a mechanical resonant frequency of the planar waveguides.

474. The system of claim 472 wherein the micro-projectors comprise respective ones of a plurality of piezoelectric actuators coupled to move respective ones of the planar waveguides with respect to the holder substrate.

475. The system of claim 472 wherein the planar waveguides each define an totally internally reflective path along a respective length of the planar waveguide, and the planar waveguides comprise respective ones of a plurality of electronically switchable diffractive optical elements (DOEs) operable to propagate light outward of the respective totally internally reflective path.

476. The system of claim 449 wherein the array of micro-projectors comprises an array of optical fiber cores, each having a distal tip and at least one bevel edge.

477. The system of claim 476 wherein the at least one bevel edge is at the distal tip, and the distal tip is a polished distal tip.

478. The system of claim 477 wherein each of the optical fiber cores has a reflective surface at the respective distal tip thereof.

479. The system of claim 478 wherein the distal tip has an output edge at the distal tip at a defined critical angle to a longitudinal axis of the respective optical fiber.

480. The system of claim 479 wherein the defined critical angle is an approximately forty-five (45) degree to the longitudinal axis of the respective optical fiber.

481. The system of claim 449, further comprising:

a focusing lens in an optical path of light exiting the distal ends of the optical fiber cores, to receive a plurality of beams of the light, the beams out of phase with one another.

482. The system of claim 449, further comprising:

at least one transducer coupled to move at least one of the optical fiber cores in an X-Y Cartesian coordinate system, to move light emitted by the at least one optical fiber in an X-Z Cartesian coordinate system.

483. The system of claim 449 wherein the at least one transducer is a first piezoelectric actuator that resonates a cantilevered portion of the optical fiber cores in a direction perpendicular to a direction at which the cantilevered portions extend.

484. The system of claim 483 wherein the optical fiber cores comprise a thin ribbon of optical fiber cores.

485. The system of claim 482 wherein the at least one transducer is a second piezoelectric actuator that moves at least the cantilevered portion of the optical fiber cores in a direction longitudinal to the direction at which the cantilevered portions extend.

486. The system of claim 485 wherein the microprojectors include at least one a single axis mirror operable to provide a slow scan along a longitudinal axis of at least one of the optical fiber cores.

487. The system of claim 449 wherein the array of optical fiber cores comprises a multicore fiber.

488. The system of claim 487 wherein the multicore fiber includes a plurality of approximately seven sparsely positioned clusters within a single conduit, each cluster comprising three optical fiber cores, each optical fiber to carry a respective one of three different colors of light.

489. The system of claim 487 wherein the multicore fiber includes a plurality of approximately nineteen sparsely positioned clusters within a single conduit, each cluster comprising three optical fiber cores, each optical fiber to carry a respective one of three different colors of light to produce a triad of overlapped spots of three different colors.

490. The system of claim 487 wherein the multicore fiber includes at least one cluster within a single conduit, the cluster comprising at least three optical fiber cores, each, each of the optical fiber cores to carry at least two different colors of light.

491. The system of claim 490 wherein the multicore fiber includes at least one cluster within a single conduit, the at least one cluster comprising four optical fiber cores, each optical fiber to carry a respective one of four different colors of light, where one of the four colors is infrared or near-infrared.

492. The system of claim 490 wherein the multicore fiber includes a plurality of cores in a tight bundle, and further comprising:

at least one transducer coupled to move the cores in a sparse spiral pattern.

493. The system of claim 476 wherein the at least one bevel edge is spaced inwardly from the distal tip.

494. The system of claim 476 wherein the at least one bevel edge is polished.

495. The system of claim 494, further comprising:

at least one transducer coupled to move at least one of the optical fiber cores in an X-Y Cartesian coordinate system, to move light emitted by the at least one optical fiber in an X-Z Cartesian coordinate system.

496. The system of claim 493, further comprising:

a focusing lens in an optical path of light exiting the bevel edges of the optical fiber cores, to receive a plurality of beams of the light, the beams out of phase with one another.

497. The system of claim 483, further comprising:

a laser;

at least one phase modulator that optically couples an output of the laser to a number of cores of the multicore fiber to achieve mutual coherence.

498. The system of claim 497, further comprising:

a lenslet array optically coupled upstream of an input end of respective ones of a number of cores of the multicore fiber; and

a prism array optically coupled between the plurality of collimation lenses and the input end of the cores of the multicore fiber to deflect light from the lenslet array to the cores of the multicore fiber.

499. The system of claim 498, further comprising:

a lenslet array optically coupled upstream of an input end of respective ones of a number of cores of the multicore fiber; and

a shared focusing lens optically coupled between the lenslet array and the input end of the cores of the multicore fiber to deflect light from the lenslet array to the cores of the multicore fiber.

500. The system of claim 476 wherein the array of micro-projectors further comprises at least one reflector, the at least one reflector operable to produce scan pattern and optically coupled to the array of optical fiber cores.

501. The system of claim 500 wherein the at least one reflector is operable to produce at least one of a raster scan pattern, a Lissajous scan pattern, or a spiral scan pattern of a multifocal beam.

502. The system of claim 476 wherein each core of the multicore fiber addresses a respective part of an image plane without overlap.

503. The system of claim 476 wherein each core of the multicore fiber addresses a respective part of an image plane with substantial overlap.

504. A system for displaying virtual content, the system comprising: an image-source to provide one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user;

a fiber scanning display, the fiber scanning display comprising a plurality of fibers to project light associated with the one or more frames of image data, wherein the plurality of fibers are scanned using an actuator; and

a processor to control the fiber scanning display in a manner such that a light field is presented to the user.

505. The system of claim 504, wherein the actuator is shared among all the fibers of the fiber scanning display.

506. The system of claim 504, wherein each fiber has its individual actuator.

507. The system of claim 505, wherein the plurality of fibers are mechanically coupled by a lattice, such that the plurality of fibers move together.

508. The system of claim 507, wherein the lattice is a graphene plane.

509. The system of claim 507, wherein the lattice is a lightweight strut.

510. A system to provide at least one of a virtual or an augmented reality experience to a user, the system comprising:

a frame;

a display system carried by the frame and positionable in front of at least one eye of the user when the frame is worn by the user; and

a local controller communicatively coupled to the display system to provide image information to the display system, the local controller comprising at least one processor, and at least one nontransitory processor readable media communicatively coupled to the at least one processor, the at least one nontransitory processor readable media which stores at last one of processor-executable instructions or data, which when executed by the at least one processor causes the at least one processor to at least one of process, cache, and store data and provide the image information to the display to produce at least one of a virtual or an augmented reality visual experience to the user.

51 1. The system of claim 510 wherein the display comprises at least one wedge- shaped waveguide, the wedge-shaped waveguide having at least two flat surfaces opposed from one another across a thickness of the first wedge-shaped waveguide and having a length along which light entering the wedge-shaped waveguide at defined angles via an entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide propagates via total internal reflection, the thickness of the wedge-shaped waveguide which varies linearly along the length of the wedge-shaped waveguide.

512. The system of claim 51 1 wherein the wedge-shaped waveguide provides a bi- modal total internal reflection.

513. The system of claim 510, further comprising:

at least two projectors optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide at respective different locations along the entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide.

514. The system of claim 510, further comprising:

a first linear array of a plurality of projectors optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide at respective different locations along the entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide.

515. The system of claim 514 wherein the projectors of the first linear array of a plurality of projectors are scanning fiber displays.

516. The system of claim 510, further comprising:

a stack of a plurality of spatial light modulators optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide along the entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide.

517. The system of claim 510, further comprising:

a multicore optical fiber optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide at one or more locations along the entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide.

518. The system of claim 510 wherein the projectors of the first linear array of projectors are optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide to inject light into the wedge- shaped waveguide at a first angle, further comprising:

a second linear array of a plurality of projectors optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide at respective different locations along the entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide, wherein the projectors of the second linear array of projectors are optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide to inject light into the wedge-shaped waveguide at a second angle, the second angle different from the first angle.

519. The system of claim 510 wherein in the entrance portion is longitude end of the wedged-shaped waveguide.

520. The system of claim 510 wherein in the entrance portion is a lateral edge of the wedged-shaped waveguide.

521. The system of claim 510 wherein in the entrance portion is a one of the flat surfaces of the wedged-shaped waveguide.

522. The system of claim 510, further comprising:

at least one optical component optically coupled to a projector, and which changes an angle of light received from the projector to optically couple the light to the wedge-shaped waveguide at angles that achieve total internal reflection of the light within the wedge-shaped waveguide.

523. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, the system comprising;

an array of microprojectors to project light beams associated with one or more frames of image data to be presented to the user, wherein the microprojector is configurable to be movable relative to one or more microprojectors of the array of the microprojectors;

a frame to house the array of microprojectors; and

a processor operatively coupled to the one or more microprojectors of the array of microprojectors to control one or more light beams transmitted from the one or more projectors in a manner such that the one or more light beams are modulated as a function of a position of the one or more microprojectors relative to the array of microprojectors, thereby enabling delivery of a lightfield image to the user.

524. The system of claim 523, wherein a microprojector of the array of microprojectors is coupled to a lens.

525. The system of claim 523, wherein the array of microprojectors is arranged in a manner based on a desired resolution of the image to be presented to the user.

526. The system of claim 523, wherein the array of microprojectors is arranged based on a desired field of view.

527. The system of claim 523, wherein the light beams of a plurality of microprojectors overlap.

528. The system of claim 523, further comprising an actuator, wherein the actuator is coupled to one or more microprojectors, and wherein the actuator is configurable to move the one or more microprojectors.

529. The system of claim 523, wherein the actuator is coupled to a plurality of microprojectors.

530. The system of claim 523, wherein the actuator is coupled to a single microprojector.

531. The system of claim 523, wherein a microprojector of the array of micropojectors is mechanically coupled to a lattice.

532. The system of claim 531 , wherein the lattice is a graphene sheet.

533. The system of claim 531 , wherein the lattice is a matrix of carbon nanotubes.

534. The system of claim 523, wherein a plurality of microprojectors are cut via a laser cutting device such that the plurality of the micropojectors are all of a same cantilevered length.

535. A contact lens to interface with a cornea of an eye of a user of a virtual or augmented reality display, the contact lens comprising:

a partially hemispherical substrate and a selective filter, wherein the selective filter is configured to selectively pass light beams to a user's eye.

536. The contact lens of claim 535 wherein the selective filter is a notch filter.

537. The contact lens of claim 535 wherein the notch filter substantially blocks wavelengths at approximately 450nm (peak blue) and substantially passes other wavelengths in a visible portion of the electromagnetic spectrum.

538. The contact lens of claim 535 wherein the notch filter substantially blocks wavelengths at approximately 530nm (green) and substantially passes other wavelengths in a visible portion of the electromagnetic spectrum.

539. The contact lens of claim 535 wherein the notch filter substantially blocks wavelengths at approximately 650nm and substantially passes other wavelengths in a visible portion of the electromagnetic spectrum.

540. The contact lens of claim 539 wherein the notch filter comprises a plurality of layers of dielectric materials carried by the substrate

541. The contact lens of claim 539 wherein the filter has a pinhole opening of less than 1.5mm diameter.

542. The contact lens of claim 541 , wherein the pinhole opening allows light beams of a plurality of wavelengths to pass through.

543. The contact lens of claim 539, wherein a size of the pinhole is varied based at least in part on a desired depth of focus of the display.

544. The contact lens of claim 539, further comprising a plurality of modes of operation.

545. The contact lens of claim 539, further comprising a multi-depth of focus display configuration of the virtual content.

546. The contact lens of claim 539, further comprising an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of the user's eye.

547. The contact lens of claim 539 wherein a depth of focus of a particular display object is varied based at least in part on the determined accommodation.

548. The contact lens of claim 539, wherein an image is relayed through a waveguide, the relayed image associated with a particular depth of focus.

549. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

providing one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user;

projecting light associated with the one or more frames of image data; and

receiving, through a partially hemispherical substrate coupled to the user's pupil, the projected light and selectively filtering out the light beams to the user's pupil.

550. The method of claim 549, wherein the light is filtered through a notch filter.

551 . The method of claim 550, wherein the notch filter substantially blocks wavelengths at approximately 450nm (peak blue) and substantially passes other wavelengths in a visible portion of the electromagnetic spectrum.

552. The method of claim 550, wherein the notch filter substantially blocks wavelengths at approximately 530nm (green) and substantially passes other wavelengths in a visible portion of the electromagnetic spectrum.

553. The method of claim 550, wherein the notch filter substantially blocks wavelengths at approximately 650nm and substantially passes other wavelengths in a visible portion of the electromagnetic spectrum.

554. The method of claim 550, wherein the notch filter comprises a plurality of layers of dielectric materials carried by the substrate.

555. The method of claim 550, wherein the filter has a pinhole opening of less than 1.5mm diameter.

556. The method of claim 555, wherein the pinhole opening allows light beams of a plurality of wavelengths to pass through.

557. The method of claim 555, wherein a size of the pinhole is varied based at least in part on a desired depth of focus of the display.

558. The method of claim 549, wherein the partially hemispherical substrate is a contact lens.

559. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a light projection system to project light associated with one or more frames of image data to a user's eyes, the light project system configured to project light corresponding to a plurality of pixels associated with the image data; and

a processor to modulate a depth of focus of the plurality of pixels displayed to the user.

560. The system of claim 559, wherein the depth of focus is modulated spatially.

561. The system of claim 559, wherein the depth of focus is modulated over time.

562. The system of claim 559, further comprising an image-generating source to provide the one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner.

563. The system of claim 559, wherein the depth of focus is modulated on a frame-to- frame basis.

564. The system of claim 559, wherein the light projection system comprises a plurality of optical fiber cores, and wherein the depth of focus is modulated across the plurality of optical fiber cores such that a portion of the optical fiber cores is associated with a first depth of focus, and another portion of the optical fiber cores is associated with a second depth of focus, wherein the first depth of focus is different from the second depth of focus. .

565. The system of claim 559, wherein a first display object of a particular frame is displayed through a first depth of focus, and a second display object of the particular frame is displayed through a second depth of focus, wherein the first depth of focus is different from the second depth of focus.

566. The system of claim 559, wherein a first pixel of a particular frame is associated with a first depth of focus, and a second pixel of the particular frame is associated with a second depth of focus, wherein the first depth of focus is different from the second depth of focus.

567. The system of claim 559, further comprising an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the depth of focus is modulated based at least in part on the determined accommodation.

568. The system of claim 567, wherein a pattern of light generation associated with the light generation system is dynamically slaved to the determined accommodation.

569. The system of claim 568, wherein the pattern is scanning pattern of a plurality of optical fiber cores.

570. The system of claim 559, further comprising a blurring module to blur one or more portions of the image data, wherein the blurring is created to smooth a transition between a first scan pattern and a second scan pattern or a first resolution scan pitch to a second resolution scan pitch.

571. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a light projection system to project light associated with one or more frames of image data to a user's eyes, the light project system configured to project light corresponding to a plurality of pixels associated with the image data;

a processor to modulate a size of the plurality of pixels displayed to the user.

572. The system of claim 571 , wherein the light projection system is a fiber scanning display.

573. The system of claim 572, wherein the projected light is displayed through a scanning pattern.

574. The system of claim 571 , wherein the processor modulates the size of a particular pixel based at least in part on a type of scanning pattern.

575. The system of claim 571 , wherein the size of the one or more pixels may be modulated based at least in part on a distance between scan lines of the scanning pattern.

576. The system of claim 571 , wherein the size of a first pixel is different from the size of a second pixel in the same frame.

577. A method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising: projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein one or more light beams of the projected light correspond to one or more pixels, wherein light is projected through a fiber scanning display; and

modulating a size of the one or more pixels displayed to the user.

578. The method of claim 577, wherein the size of a particular pixel is varied based at least in part on a scanning pattern of the fiber scanning display

579. The method of claim 578, wherein the size of the one or more pixels is modulated based at least in part on a distance between scan lines of the scanning pattern.

580. The method of claim 579, wherein the size of the one or more pixels is variable.

581. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a display system that delivers light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the display system comprises a plurality of pixels, wherein the display system scans light having variable line pitch;

a blurring module to variably blur one or more pixels of the plurality of pixels to modify a size of the one or more pixels; and

a processor to control the blurring module in a manner such that pixel size is varied based at least in part on the line pitch of the display system.

582. The system of claim 581 wherein the display system is a fiber scanning system.

583. The system of claim 581 , wherein the pixel size is enlarged.

584. The system of claim 581 , wherein the pixel size is reduced.

585. The system of claim 581 , wherein the pitch line is sparse.

586. The system of claim 581 , wherein the pitch line is dense.

587. A method of displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprising:

projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data to be presented to the user using an optically see-through viewing optic that allows the user to view the outside world through the viewing optic;

and selectively attenuating at least a portion of the light from the outside world that would pass through the viewing optic on its way to the user's eye, such that some light from the outside world passes through the viewing optic and reaches the user's eye.

588. The method of claim 587, wherein a light beam is selectively attenuated based at least in part on angle of incidence of the light beam.

589. The method of claim 587, wherein different portions of the frame are attenuated to different amounts.

590. The method of claim 587, wherein a focus level of the attenuated light beams is varied.

591. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising: an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data;

a stack of two or more spatial light modulators (SLMs) positioned such that the stack delivers light associated with the one or more frames of image data to the user, wherein the SLM spatially attenuates light from an outside environment; and

a processor to control the stack of SLMs in a manner such that an angle at which light beams pass through one or more cells of the SLM is modulated

592. The system of claim 591 , further comprising a set of display optics, wherein the set of display optics is positioned between the user's eye and the outside environment.

593. The system of claim 591 , wherein the SLMs of the stack of SLMs are cholesteric

LCDs.

594. The system of claim 591 , wherein at least one of the SLMs is a cholesteric LCD.

595. The system of claim 591 , wherein the stack of SLMs is positioned such that the user views an outside world through the stack of SLMs, wherein the SLMs is at least semi- transparent.

596. The system of claim 591 , wherein the spatial light modulator arrays comprise at least one of a number or liquid crystal arrays, a number of digital mirror device elements of digital light processing systems, a number of micro-electro-mechanical system (MEMS) arrays, or a number of MEMS shutters.

597. The system of claim 591 , further comprising an occluder comprising at least one optical component, and wherein the processor controls the at least one optical component of the occluder to produce a darkfield representation of a dark virtual object.

598. A system for displaying virtual content, the system comprising:

an array of spatial light modulators, the array of spatial light modulators configured to generate light patterns, and wherein the array of spatial light modulators comprises at least two modulators; and

a processor to control the array of spatial modulators in a manner such that the at least two spatial modulators form a Moire pattern, wherein the Moire pattern is a periodic spatial pattern that attenuates light at a different period than a period of the light patterns forms on the at least two spatial light modulators

599. The system of claim 598 wherein the spatial light modulator arrays comprise at least two spatial light modulator arrays optically coupled to one another, and which are control passage of light via moire effects.

600. The system of claim 599 wherein the at least two spatial light modulator arrays each bear a respective attenuation pattern.

601. The system of claim 598 wherein the at least two spatial light modulator arrays each bear a respective fine-pitch sine wave pattern printed, etched, or other inscribed thereon or therein.

602. The system of claim 599 wherein the at least two spatial light modulator arrays are in registration with one another.

603. The system of claim 599 wherein the at least two spatial light modulator arrays each bear a respective attenuation pattern.

604. A system for display virtual content to a user, the system comprising:

a light generating source to provide light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light generating source is a spatial light modulator; and

a pinhole array positioned in a manner relative to the spatial light modulator such that a pinhole of the pinhole array receives light from a plurality of cells of the spatial light modulator, and wherein a first light beam passing through the pinhole corresponds to a different angle than a second light beam passing through the pinhole, and wherein the cell of spatial light modulator selectively attenuate light.

605. The system of claim 604, wherein an outside environment is viewed through the pinhole array and the SLMs, and wherein light beams are selectively attenuated based at least in part on the angle of incidence of the light beams.

606. The system of claim 604, wherein light from different portions of a visual field is selectively attenuated.

607. The system of claim 604, further comprising a selective attenuation layer selectively operable to attenuation transmission of light therethrough, the selective attenuation layer optically in series with the pinhole layer.

608. The system of claim 607, wherein the selective attenuation layer comprises a liquid crystal array, digital light projector system, or spatial light modulator arrays which bear respective attenuation patterns.

609. The system of claim 604 wherein the pinhole array placed at a distance of approximately 30mm from a cornea of an eye of the user, and the selective attenuation panel is located opposite the pinhole array from the eye.

610. The system of claim 604, wherein the pinhole array comprises a plurality of pinholes, and wherein the process controls the SLMs in a manner such light is attenuated as a function of the angles at which light beams pass through the plurality of pinholes, thereby producing an aggregate light field.

61 1. The system of claim 610, wherein the aggregate light field causes occlusion at a desired focal distance.

612. A system comprising: a light generating source to provide light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light generating source is a spatial light modulator; and

a lens array positioned in a manner relative to the spatial light modulator such that a lens of the lens array receives light from a plurality of cells of the spatial light modulator, and wherein a first light beam received at the lens corresponds to a different angle than a second light beam received at the lens, and wherein the cells of spatial light modulator selectively attenuate light.

613. The system of claim 612, wherein an outside environment is viewed through the lens array and the SLMs, and wherein light beams are selectively attenuated based at least in part on the angle of incidence of the light beams.

614. The system of claim 612, wherein light from different portions of a visual field is selectively attenuated.

615. The system of claim 612, wherein the lens array comprises a plurality of lenses, and wherein the process controls the SLMs in a manner such light is attenuated as a function of the angles at which light beams are received at the plurality of lenses, thereby producing an aggregate light field.

616. The system of claim 615, wherein the aggregate light field causes occlusion at a desired focal distance.

617. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising;

a light projector to project light associated with one or more frames of an image data; at least one polarization sensitive layer to receive the light and rotate a polarization of the light; and

an array of polarization modulators to modulate the polarization of the polarization sensitive layer, and wherein a state of the cell in the array determines how much light passes through the polarization sensitive layer.

618. The system of claim 617, wherein the system is placed in a near-to-eye configuration.

619. The system of claim 617, wherein the polarization modulator is a liquid crystal array.

620. The system of claim 617, further comprising a parallax barrier to offset the polarizer such that different exit pupils have different paths through the polarizer.

621. The system of claim 620, wherein the polarizer is an xpol polarizer.

622. The system of claim 620, wherein the polarizer is a multiPol polarizer.

623. The system of claim 620, wherein the polarizer is a patterned polarizer.

624. The system of claim 617, wherein the light interacts with one or more MEMs arrays.

625. The system of claim 618, further comprising SLMs to project light, wherein the SLMs are positioned between one or more optical elements, wherein the optical elements correspond to a zero magnification telescope.

626. The system of claim 625, wherein the user views an outside environment through the zero-magnification telescope.

627. The system of claim 625, wherein at least one SLM is positioned at an image plane within the zero-magnification telescope.

628. The system of claim 617, further comprising a DMD, wherein the DMD corresponds to a transparent substrate.

629. The system of claim 628, further comprising an occluder comprising at least one optical component, and wherein the processor controls the at least one optical component of the occluder to produce a darkfield representation of a dark virtual object.

630. The system of claim 628, further comprising one or more LCDs, wherein the one or more LCDs selectively attenuate light beams.

631. The system of claim 617 , further comprising one or more LCDs, wherein the one or more LCDs serve as polarization rotators.

632. The system of claim 629, wherein the occluder is a louver MEMs device.

633. The system of claim 632, wherein the louver MEMs device is opaque, and wherein the louver MEMs device changes an angle of incidence on a pixel-by-pixel basis.

634. The system of claim 632, wherein the occluder is a sliding panel MEMs device, wherein the sliding panel MEMs device slides back and forth to modify a region of occlusion.

635. A method for displaying virtual content comprising:

projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data;

rotating a polarization of light through a polarization sensitive layer at a substrate which receives the projected light; and

modulating a polarization of light to selectively attenuate light passing through the polarization layer.

636. The method of claim 635, wherein the polarization modulator is a liquid crystal array.

637. The method of claim 635, further comprising a parallax barrier to offset the polarizer such that different exit pupils have different paths through the polarizer.

638 The method of claim 637, wherein the polarizer is an xpol polarizer.

639. The method of claim 637, wherein the polarizer is a multiPol polarizer.

640. The method of claim 637, wherein the polarizer is a patterned polarizer.

641. The method of claim 617, wherein the light interacts with one or more MEMs arrays.

642. The method of claim 636, further comprising SLMs to project light, wherein the SLMs are positioned between one or more optical elements, wherein the optical elements correspond to a zero magnification telescope.

643. The method of claim 642, wherein the user views an outside environment through the zero-magnification telescope.

644. The method of claim 642, wherein at least one SLM is positioned at an image plane within the zero-magnification telescope.

645. The method of claim 635, further comprising a DMD, wherein the DMD corresponds to a transparent substrate.

646. The method of claim 635, further comprising an occluder comprising at least one optical component, and wherein the processor controls the at least one optical component of the occluder to produce a darkfield representation of a dark virtual object.

647. The method of claim 635, further comprising one or more LCDs, wherein the one or more LCDs selectively attenuate light beams.

648. The method of claim 635 , further comprising one or more LCDs, wherein the one or more LCDs serve as polarization rotators.

649. The method of claim 646, wherein the occluder is a louver MEMs device.

650. The method of claim 649, wherein the louver MEMs device is opaque, and wherein the louver MEMs device changes an angle of incidence on a pixel-by-pixel basis.

651. The method of claim 646, wherein the occluder is a sliding panel MEMs device, wherein the sliding panel MEMs device slides back and forth to modify a region of occlusion.

652. A system for displaying virtual content, comprising:

a light generating source to provide light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light generating source is a spatial light modulator;

an array of micro-electro-mechanical (MEMs) louvers, wherein the MEMs louvers are housed in a substantially transparent substrate, and wherein the MEMs louvers are configurable to change an angle at which light is delivered to a pixel, and wherein the angle of a first pixel delivered to the user is different from a second pixel delivered to the user.

653. The system of claim 652 wherein the at least one optical component comprises a first array of micro-electro-mechanical system (MEMS) louvers.

654. The system of claim 652 wherein the array of MEMS louvers comprises a plurality of substantially opaque louvers carried by an optically transparent substrate.

655. The system of claim 652 wherein the array of micro-electro-mechanical system (MEMS) louvers has a louver pitch sufficiently fine to selectably occlude light on a pixel-by- pixel basis.

656. The system of claim 652, further comprising at least one optical component of the occluder comprises a second array of MEMS louvers, the second array of MEMS louvers in a stack configuration with the first array of MEMS louvers.

657. The system of claim 652 wherein the array of MEMS louvers comprises a plurality of polarizing louvers carried by an optically transparent substrate, a respective polarization state of each of the louvers selectively controllable.

658. The system of claim 652 wherein the louvers of the first and the second arrays of MEMS panels are polarizers.

659. The system of claim 652 wherein the at least one optical component of the occluder comprises a first array of micro-electro-mechanical system (MEMS) panels mounted for movement in a frame.

660. The system of claim 625 wherein the panels of the first array of MEMS panels are slidably mounted for movement in the frame.

661. The system of claim 652 wherein the panels of the first array of MEMS panels are pivotably mounted for movement in the frame.

662. The system of claim 652 wherein the panels of the first array of MEMS panels are both translationally and pivotably mounted for movement in the frame.

663. The system of claim 652 wherein the panels of moveably to produce a moire pattern.

664. The system of claim 652 wherein the at least one optical component of the occluder further comprises a second array of MEMS panels mounted for movement in a frame, the second array in a stack configuration with the first array.

665. The system of claim 652 wherein the panels of the first and the second arrays of MEMS panels are polarizers.

666. The system of claim 652 wherein the at least one optical component of the occluder comprises a reflector array.

667. A system comprising:

at least one waveguide to receive light from an outside environment and direct the light to one or more spatial light modulators, wherein the one or more spatial light modulators selectively attenuate the received light in different portions of a visual field of the user.

668. The system of claim 667, wherein the at least one waveguide comprises a first and second waveguides, and wherein the second waveguide is configured to deliver light exiting the SLMs to the user's eye.

669. A method comprising:

receiving light from an outside environment;

directing the light to a selective attenuator; and selectively attenuating, through the selective attenuator, the received light in different portions of a visual field of the user.

670. The method of claim 669, wherein the at least one waveguide comprises a first and second waveguides, and wherein the second waveguide is configured to deliver light exiting the SLMs to the user's eye.

671. The method of claim 669, wherein the select is a DMD.

672. The method of claim 669, wherein the spatial light modulator is a DMD array.

673. The method of claim 669, wherein light is directed to the one or more spatial light modulators through one or more waveguides.

674. The method of claim 673, further comprising recoupling light back to the waveguide, causing light to partially exit toward the user's eye.

675. The method of claim 673, wherein the waveguide is oriented substantially perpendicular to the selective attenuator.

676. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a light generating source to provide light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light generating source comprises a plurality of microprojectors;

a waveguide configured to receive light from the plurality of microprojectors and transmit light to a user's eye.

677. The system of claim 676, wherein the microprojectors are placed in a linear array.

678. The system of claim 676, wherein the microprojectors are placed in one edge of the waveguide.

679 The system of claim 676, wherein the microprojectors are placed in multiple edges of the waveguide.

680. The system of claim 676, wherein the microprojectors are placed in a two dimensional array.

681. The system of claim 676, wherein the microprojectors are placed in a three- dimensional array.

682. The system of claim 681 , wherein the microprojectors are placed at multiple edges of the substrate.

683. The system of claim 681 , wherein the microprojectors are placed at multiple angles.

684. A system for displaying virtual content, comprising:

an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data, wherein the image data comprises one or more virtual objects to be presented to a user; and a rendering engine to render the one or more virtual objects in a manner such that a halo is perceived by the user around the one or more virtual objects.

685. The system of claim 684, further comprising a light attenuator, wherein the light attenuator balances a light intensity of the halo across the visual field of the user.

686. A method for displaying virtual content, comprising:

providing one or more frames of image data, wherein the image data comprises one or more virtual objects to be presented to a user; and

rendering the one or more virtual objects in a manner such that a halo is perceived by the user around the one or more virtual objects, thereby making it easier for the user to view the virtual object, wherein the virtual object is a dark virtual object.

687. The method of claim 686, further comprising selectively attenuating light receiving from an outside environment, through a light attenuator, wherein the light attenuator balances a light intensity of the halo across a visual field of the user.

688. A system for displaying virtual content, comprising:

a camera system to capture a view of a real environment;

an optical see-through system that displays one or more virtual objects superimposed over the view of the real environment, wherein the captured view is used to render the one or more virtual objects presented to the user; and

a light intensity module to modulate a light intensity of the view of the real environment, based at least on a correlation between one or more real objects, and the one or more virtual objects, such that a dark virtual object is visible in contrast with the one or more real objects.

689. The system of claim 688, wherein the captured view is used to generate a halo around one or more virtual objects, wherein the halo fades across space.

690. The system of claim 688, further comprising a light attenuator, wherein the light attenuator balances a light intensity of the halo across the visual field of the user.

691. A method of driving an augmented reality display system, the method comprising:

rendering a first virtual object at a location on a field of view of a user; and

rendering a visual emphasis at least spatially proximate the rendered first virtual object in the field of view of the user substantially concurrently with the rendering of the first virtual object.

692. The method of claim 691 wherein rendering a visual emphasis includes rendering the visual emphasis with an intensity gradient.

693. The method of claim 691 wherein rendering a visual emphasis includes rendering the visual emphasis with blurring proximate a perimeter of the visual emphasis.

694. The method of claim 691 wherein rendering a visual emphasis at least spatially proximate the rendered first virtual object includes rendering a halo visual effect spatially proximate the rendered first virtual object.

695. The method of claim 694 wherein rendering a halo visual effect spatially proximate the rendered first virtual object includes rendering the halo visual effect to be brighter than the rendered first virtual object.

696. The method of claim 694 wherein rendering the halo visual effect to be brighter than the rendered first virtual object is in response to a determination that the rendered first virtual object is darker than a threshold value of darkness.

697. The method of claim 694 wherein rendering a halo visual effect includes rendering the halo visual effect in a separate focal plane from the rendered first virtual object in a perceived three-dimensional space.

698. The method of claim 694 wherein rendering a halo visual effect includes rendering the halo visual effect with an intensity gradient.

699. The method of claim 694 wherein rendering a halo visual effect includes rendering the halo visual effect with an intensity gradient that matches a dark halo resulting from occlusion applied to the rendering of the first virtual object to compensate for a darkfield effect of the occlusion.

700. The method of claim 694 wherein rendering a halo visual effect includes rendering the halo visual effect with blurring proximate a perimeter of the halo visual effect.

701. The method of claim 691 wherein the rendered first visual object has a non- circular perimeter and the rendered halo visual effect conforms to the non-circular perimeter.

702. The method of claim 691 wherein rendering a visual emphasis at least spatially proximate the rendered first virtual object includes rendering the visual effect in a separate focal plane from the rendered first virtual object in a perceived three-dimensional space.

703. The method of claim 691 wherein rendering the visual effect in a separate focal plane from the rendered first virtual object in a perceived three-dimensional space includes rendering the visual effect in a focal plane spaced relative away from the user with respect to a focal plane in which the rendered first virtual object is rendered.

704. A system for displaying virtual content, comprising:

an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user, wherein the one or more frames of image data comprises at least one black virtual object; and

a rendering image to render the one or more frames of image data, and wherein the rendering engine renders the black virtual object as a blue virtual object, such that the black virtual object is visible to the user.

705. The system of claim 704, wherein rendering a first virtual object at a location on a field of view of a user includes, first changing any black intonations of the first virtual object to a dark blue color.

706. A system for transmitting light beams for display of virtual content, comprising; at least one waveguide, the at least one waveguide having a first end, a second end spaced from the first end across a length of the at least one waveguide, the length along which light entering the respective waveguide at defined angles propagates via total internal reflection;

at least one edge reflector positioned at least proximate a first end of the at least one waveguide to optically reflectively couple light back to the first end of the at least one waveguide; and

at least one edge reflector positioned at least proximate a second end of the at least one waveguide to optically reflectively couple light back to the second end of the at least one waveguide.

707. The system of claim 706 wherein the at least one waveguide has a number of transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces internal to the waveguide that redirect at least a portion of the light transversely outward of the waveguide.

708. The system of claim 706 wherein the transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces are low diffraction efficiency diffractive optical elements (DOEs).

709. The system of claim 706 wherein at least one edge reflector positioned at least proximate a first end of the at least one waveguide comprises a plurality of reflectors positioned at least proximate the first end of the at least one waveguide.

710. The system of claim 706 wherein at least one edge reflector positioned at least proximate a second end of the at least one waveguide comprises a plurality of reflectors positioned at least proximate the second end of the at least one waveguide.

71 1. The system of claim 706 wherein at least one waveguide is a single waveguide.

712. A system for transmitting light beams for display of virtual content, comprising: a waveguide assembly comprising a plurality of planar waveguides, each of the planar waveguides respectively having at least two flat parallel major faces opposed from one another across a thickness of the planar waveguide, a first end, and a second opposed to the first end across a length of the waveguide, the length along which light entering the respective waveguide at defined angles propagates via total internal reflection, and two flat major edges opposed to one another across a width of the waveguide, the plurality of planar waveguides in a stacked configuration along a first axis that is parallel with a direction of the thicknesses of planar waveguides and along a second axis that is parallel with the widths of the planar waveguides to form a three-dimensional array of planar waveguides.

713. The system of claim 712 wherein there are at least three planar waveguides stacked in the direction of the first axis.

714. The system of claim 713 wherein there are at least three planar waveguides stacked in the direction of the second axis.

715. The system of claim 713 wherein there are at least three planar waveguides stacked in the direction of the second axis.

716. The system of claim 712 wherein successive planar waveguides in the stack along the first axis are immediately adjacent one another, and successive planar waveguides in the stack along the second axis are immediately adjacent one another.

717. The system of claim 712 wherein the waveguide assembly further comprises a plurality of reflective layers carried on at least one surface of at least one of the planar waveguides.

718. The system of claim 717 wherein the reflective layers include a completely reflective metalized coating.

719. The system of claim 717 wherein the reflective layers include a wavelength specific reflector.

720. The system of claim 717 wherein the reflective layers separate the planar waveguides in each successive pair of the planar waveguides along at least one of the first or the second axes.

721. The system of claim 717 wherein the reflective layers separate the planar waveguides in each successive pair of the planar waveguides along both the first and the second axes.

722. The system of claim 712 wherein each of a number of the planar waveguides respectively includes a number of transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces that redirect at least a portion of the light received by the respective planar waveguide transversely outward of the planar waveguide.

723. The system of claim 712 wherein the transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces comprise diffractive optical elements sandwiched in the respective planar waveguides between the major faces of the respective planar waveguide.

724. The system of claim 713 wherein the diffractive optical elements are selectively operable to vary a focal distance.

725. The system of claim 713 wherein the first axis is a curved axis, and at least one of the major edges of each of the planar waveguides in at least one set in the waveguide assembly is oriented to focus on a single line, the single line parallel to the lengths of the planar waveguides.

726. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, the system comprising: a light projector to project light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light projector is a fiber scanning display;

a waveguide assembly to variably deflect light to a user's eye, wherein the waveguide is curved con cave ly toward the eye.

727. The system of claim 726, wherein the curved waveguide expands a field of view.

728. The system of claim 726, wherein the curved waveguide efficiently directs light to the user's eye.

729. The system of claim 726, wherein the curved waveguide comprises a time- varying grating, thereby creating an axis for scanning the light for the fiber scanning display.

730. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising:

a transmissive beam splitter substrate having an entrance to receive light and a number of internal reflective or diffractive surfaces angled with respect to the entrance to redirect at least a portion of the light received at the entrance transversely outward of the transmissive beam splitter substrate toward an eye of the user, wherein the number of internal reflective or diffractive surfaces includes a plurality of transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces spaced along a longitudinal axis of the transmissive beam splitter substrate, each of the transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces angled or angleable with respect to the entrance to redirect at least a portion of the light received at the entrance transversely outward of the transmissive beam splitter substrate along an optical path toward an eye of the user; a light generating system to transmit light to the transmissive beam splitter; and a local controller communicatively coupled to the display system to provide image information to the display system, the local controller comprising at least one processor, and at least one nontransitory processor readable media communicatively coupled to the at least one processor, the at least one nontransitory processor readable media which stores at last one of processor-executable instructions or data, which when executed by the at least one processor causes the at least one processor to at least one of process, cache, and store data and provide the image information to the display to produce at least one of a virtual or an augmented reality visual experience to the user.

731. The system of claim 730 wherein the transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces comprise at least one diffractive optical element (DOE), where a collimated beam that enters the beam splitter at a number of defined angles is totally internally reflected along the length of thereof, and intersects the DOE at one or more locations.

732. The system of claim 730 wherein at least one diffractive optical element (DOE) comprises a first grating.

733. The system of claim 730 wherein the first grating is a first Bragg grating.

734. The system of claim 730 wherein the DOE comprises a second grating, the first grating on a first plane and the second grating on a second plane, the second plane spaced from the first plane such that the first and the second gratings interact to produce a moire beat pattern.

735. The system of claim 734 wherein the first grating has a first pitch and the second grating has a second pitch, the first pitch the same as the second pitch.

736. The system of claim 734 wherein the first grating has a first pitch and the second grating has a second pitch, the first pitch the different from the second pitch.

737. The system of claims 734 wherein the first grating pitch is controllable to change the first grating pitch over time.

738. The system of claim 737 wherein the first grating comprises an elastic material and is subject to mechanical deformation

739. The system of claim 738 wherein the first grating is carried by an elastic material which is subject to mechanical deformation

740. The system of claims 734 wherein the first grating pitch is controllable to change the first grating pitch over time.

741. The system of claims 734 wherein the second grating pitch is controllable to change the second grating pitch over time.

742. The system of claims 4734 wherein the first grating is an electro-active grating, having at least one ON state and an OFF state.

743. The system of claims 734 wherein the first grating comprises a polymer dispersed liquid crystal, a plurality of liquid crystal droplets of the polymer dispersed liquid crystal controllably activated to change a refractive index of the first grating.

744. The system of claims 738, wherein the first grating is a time-varying grating wherein the first grating is a time-varying grating, and the local controller controls at least the first grating to expand a field of view of the display.

745. The system of claims 738 wherein the first grating is a time-varying grating, and the local controller employs time-varying control of at least the first grating to correction for a chromatic aberration.

746. The system of claims 745 wherein the local controller drives at least the first grating to vary a placement of a red sub-pixel of a pixel of an image with respect to at least one of a blue or a green sub-pixel of corresponding pixel of the image.

747. The system of claims 746 wherein the local controller drives at least the first grating to laterally shift an exit pattern to fill a gap in an outbound image pattern.

748. The system of claim 732 wherein at least one DOE element has a first circularly- symmetric term.

749. The system of claim 732 wherein at least one DOE element has a first linear term, the first linear term summed with the first circularly-symmetric term.

750. The system of claim 749 wherein the circularly-symmetric term is controllable.

751. The system of claim 730 wherein at least one DOE element has a second first circularly-symmetric term.

752. The system of claim 730 wherein the at least one diffractive optical (DOE) element comprises a first DOE.

753. The system of claim 752 wherein the first DOE is a circular DOE.

754. The system of claim 753, wherein the circular DOE is a time-varying DOE.

755. The system of claim 753, wherein the circular DOE is layered in relation to a waveguide for focus modulation.

756. The system of claim 753, wherein a diffraction pattern of the circular DOE is static.

757. The system of claim 753, wherein a diffraction pattern of the circular DOE is dynamic

758. The system of claim 753, comprising additional circular DOEs, wherein the additional circular DOEs are positioned in relation to the circular DOE, such that many focus levels are achieved through a small number of switchable DOEs.

759. The system of claim 740, further comprising a matrix of switchable DOE elements.

760. The system of claim 759, wherein the matrix is utilized to expand a field of view.

761. The system of claim 759, wherein the matrix is utilized to expand a size of an exit pupil.

762. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising;

a light projecting system to project light beams associated with one or more frames of image data;

a diffractive optical element (DOE) to receive the projected light beams and deliver the light beams at a desired focus, wherein the DOE is a circular DOE.

763. The system of claim 762 wherein the DOE is stretchable along a single axis to adjust an angle of a linear DOE term.

764. The system of claim 792 wherein the DOE comprises a membrane, and at least one transducer operable to selectively vibrate the membrane with an oscillatory motion in a Z- axis to provide Z-axis control and change of focus over time.

765. The system of claim 792, wherein the DOE is embedded in a stretchable medium, such that a pitch of the DOE can be adjusted by physically stretching the medium.

766. The system of claim 762, wherein the DOE is stretched biaxially, and wherein the stretching of the DOE affects a focal length of the DOE.

767. The system of claim 762, further comprising a plurality of circular DOEs, wherein the DOEs are stacked along a Z axis.

768. The system of claim 762, wherein a circular DOE is layered in front of a waveguide for focus modulation.

769. The system of claim 768, wherein the DOE is static.

770. The system of claim 768, wherein the DOE is dynamic.

771. A system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising;

a light projecting system to project light beams associated with one or more frames of image data;

a first waveguide without any diffractive optical elements (DOEs), the first waveguide which propagates light received by the first waveguide at a number of defined angles along at least a portion of a length of the first waveguide via total internal reflection and which provides the light externally from the first waveguide as collimated light;

a second waveguide with at least a first circularly-symmetric diffractive optical element (DOE), the second waveguide optically coupled to receive the collimated light from the first waveguide; and

a processor to control the gratings of the DOE.

772. The system of claim 771 wherein the first DOE is selectively controllable.

773. The system of claim 771 wherein the display comprises a plurality of additional DOEs in addition to the first DOE, the DOEs arranged in a stack configuration.

774. The system of claim 771 wherein each of the DOEs of the plurality of additional DOEs is selectively controllable.

775. The system of claim 771 wherein a local controller controls the first DOE and the plurality of additional DOEs to dynamically modulate a focus of light passing through the display.

776. The system of claim 771 wherein the processor selectively respectively switches the first DOE and the plurality of additional DOEs to realize a number of focus levels, the number of realizable focus levels greater than a total number of the DOEs in the stack.

777. The system of claim 771 wherein each of the DOEs in the stack has a respective optical power, the optical power of the DOEs in the static controllable additive to one another.

778. The system of claim 771 wherein the respective optical power of at least one of the DOEs in the stack is twice the respective optical power of at least one other of the DOEs in the stack.

779. The system of claim 771 wherein the processor selectively respectively switches the first DOE and the plurality of additional DOEs to modulate respective linear and radial terms of the DOEs over time.

780. The system of claim 771 wherein the processor selectively respectively switches the first DOE and the plurality of additional DOEs on a frame sequential basis.

781. The system of claim 771 wherein the stack of DOEs comprises a stack of polymer dispersed liquid crystal elements.

782. The system of claim 781 wherein in absence of an applied voltage, a host medium refraction index matches that of a set of dispersed molecules of the polymer dispersed liquid crystal elements.

783. The system of claim 781 wherein the polymer dispersed liquid crystal elements comprise molecules of lithium niobate, and a number of transparent indium tin oxide layer electrode on either side of a host medium, wherein the dispersed molecules of lithium niobate controllably change index of refraction and functionally form a diffraction pattern within the host medium.

784. A method for displaying virtual content, comprising:

projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data to a user;

receiving light at a first waveguide, the first waveguide without any diffractive optical elements, and propagating the light through internal reflection

receiving collimated light at a second waveguide with at least a first circularly- symmetric diffractive optical element (DOE), the second waveguide optically coupled to receive the collimated light from the first waveguide, wherein a grating of the circularly symmetric DOE is varied, and wherein the first waveguide and second waveguide are assembled in a stack of DOEs.

785. The method of claim 784, wherein the stack of DOEs comprises a stack of polymer dispersed liquid crystal elements.

786. The method of claim 785, wherein the polymer dispersed liquid crystal elements comprise molecules of lithium niobate, and a number of transparent indium tin oxide layer electrode on either side of a host medium, wherein the dispersed molecules of lithium niobate controllably change index of refraction and functionally form a diffraction pattern within the host medium.

787. The method of claim 784, wherein in absence of an applied voltage, a host medium refraction index matches that of a set of dispersed molecules of the polymer dispersed liquid crystal elements.

788. An optical element for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising: at least one diffractive optical element (DOE) positioned to receive light, the at least one DOE comprising a first array of a plurality of separately addressable sections, with at least one electrode for each of the separately addressable subsection, each of the separately addressable subsections responsive to at least one respective single received via the respective at least one electrode to selectively switch between at least a first state and a section state, the second state different from the first state.

789. The system of claim 788, wherein a field of view is expanded by multiplexing adjacently addressable subsections.

790. The system of claim 788 wherein the first state is an ON state and the second state is an OFF state.

791. The system of claim 788 wherein each of the separately addressable subsections has a respective set of at least two indium tin oxide electrodes.

792. The system of claim 788 wherein the first array of a plurality of separately addressable sections of the at least one DOE is a one-dimensional array.

793. The system of claim 788 wherein the first array of a plurality of separately addressable sections of the at least one DOE is a two-dimensional array.

794. The system of claim 788 wherein the first array of separately addressable sections are sections of a first DOE that resides on a first planar layer.

795. The system of claim 794 wherein the at least one DOE comprises at least second DOE, the second DOE comprising a second array of a plurality of separately addressable sections, with at least one electrode for each of the separately addressable subsection, each of the separately addressable subsections responsive to at least one respective single received via the respective at least one electrode to selectively switch between at least a first state and a section state, the second state different from the first state, the second array of DOEs residing on a second planar layer, the second planar layer in a stacked configuration with the first planar layer.

796. The system of claim 794 wherein the at least one DOE comprises at least third DOE, the third DOE comprising a third array of a plurality of separately addressable sections, with at least one electrode for each of the separately addressable subsection, each of the separately addressable subsections responsive to at least one respective single received via the respective at least one electrode to selectively switch between at least a first state and a section state, the second state different from the first state, the third array of DOEs residing on a third planar layer, the third planar layer in a stacked configuration with the first and the second planar layers.

797. The system of claim 788 wherein the first array of separately addressable sections are embedded in a single planar waveguide.

798. The system of claim 794 wherein the local control controls the separately addressable subsections to selectively emit collimated light from the planar waveguide at a first time and to emit a diverging light from the planar waveguide at a second time, the second time different from the first time.

799. The system of claim 794 wherein the local control controls the separately addressable subsections to selectively emit light in a first direction from the planar waveguide at a first time and to emit light in a second direction from the planar waveguide at the first time, the second direction different from the first direction.

800. The system of claim 788 wherein the local control controls the separately addressable subsections to selectively scan light across a direction over time.

801. The system of claim 788 wherein the local control controls the separately addressable subsections to selectively focus light over time.

802. The system of claim 788 wherein the local control controls the separately addressable subsections to selectively vary a field of view of an exit pupil over time.

803. A system comprising:

a first freeform reflective and lens optical component to increase a size of a field-of- view for a defined set of optical parameters, the first freeform reflective and lens optical component comprising: a first curved surface, a second curved surface, and a third curved surface, the first curved surface at least partially optically transmissive and refractive and which imparts a focal change to the light received by the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first curved surface, the second curved surface which at least partially reflects light received by the second curved surface from the first curved surface toward the third curved surface and which passes light received by the second curved surface from the third curved surface, the third curved surface which at least partially reflects light out of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the second curved surface.

804. The system of claim 803 wherein the first curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component is a respective freeform curved surface.

805. The system of claim 803 wherein the first curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component adds a stigmatism to the light.

806. The system of claim 803 wherein the third curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component adds an opposite stigmatism to cancel the stigmatism added by the first curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component.

807. The system of claim 803 wherein the second curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component is a respective freeform curved surface.

808. The system of claim 803 wherein the second curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component reflects defined angles of light to be reflected by total internal reflection toward the third curved surface.

809. A system comprising:

a fiber scanning display to project light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the fiber scanning display is configured to deliver the light to a first free form optical element; and

a first freeform reflective and lens optical component to increase a size of a field-of- view for a defined set of optical parameters, the first freeform reflective and lens optical component comprising: a first curved surface, a second curved surface, and a third curved surface, the first curved surface at least partially optically transmissive and refractive and which imparts a focal change to the light received by the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first curved surface, the second curved surface which at least partially reflects light received by the second curved surface from the first curved surface toward the third curved surface and which passes light received by the second curved surface from the third curved surface, the third curved surface which at least partially reflects light out of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the second curved surface.

810. The system of claim 809, wherein the freeform optic is a TIR freeform optic.

81 1. The system of claim 809, wherein the freeform optic has non-uniform thickness.

812. The system of claim 809, wherein the freeform optic is a wedge optic.

813. The system of claim 809, wherein the freeform optic is a conic.

814. The system of claim 809, wherein the freeform optic corresponds to arbitrary curves.

815. A system comprising:

an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user;

a display system to provide light associated with the one or more frames of image data; and

a free form optical element to modify the provided light and deliver the light to the user, wherein the freeform optic includes reflective coating, wherein the display system is configured to illuminate the freeform optical element with light such that a wavelength of the light matches a corresponding wavelength of the reflective coating.

816. The system of claim 815, wherein one or more freeform optical elements are tiled in relation to one another.

817. The system of claim 816, wherein the one or more freeform optical elements are tiled along a z axis.

818. A system comprising:

an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user;

a display system to provide light associated with the one or more frames of image data, wherein the display system comprises a plurality of microdisplays; and

a free form optical element to modify the provided light and deliver the light to the user.

819. The system of claim 818, wherein one or more freeform optics are tiled in relation to one another.

820. The system of claim 818, wherein the light projected by the plurality of microdisplays increases a field of view.

821. The system of claim 818, wherein the freeform optical elements are configured such that only one color is delivered by a particular freeform optical element.

822. The system of claim 821 , wherein the tiled freeform is a star shape.

823. The system of claim 821 , wherein the tiled freeform optical elements increase a size of an exit pupil.

824. The system of claim 818, further comprising another free form optical element, wherein the freeform optical element and stacked together in a manner to create a uniform material thickness.

825. The system of claim 818, further comprising another free form optical element, wherein the other optical element is configured to capture light corresponding to an outside environment.

826. The system of claim 818, further comprising a DMD, wherein the DMD is configured to occlude one or more pixels.

827. The system of claim 818, further comprising one or more LCDs.

828. The system of claim 818, further comprising a contact lens substrate, wherein the freeform optics is coupled to the contact lens substrate.

829. The system of claim 818, wherein the plurality of microdisplays provides an array of small exit pupils that in an aggregate form a functional equivalent of a large exit pupil.

830. The system of claim 818 wherein the at least one image source includes at least a first monochromatic image source that provides light of a first color, at least a second monochromatic image source that provides light of a second color, the second color different from the first color, and at least a third monochromatic image source that provides light of a third color, the third color different from the first and the second colors.

831. The system of claim 830 wherein the at least a first monochromatic image source comprises a first subgroup of scanning fibers, the at least a second monochromatic image source comprises a second subgroup of scanning fibers, and the at least a third monochromatic image source comprises a third subgroup of scanning fibers.

832. The system of claim 818, further comprising:

an occluder positioned in an optical path between the first freeform reflective and lens optical component and the at least one reflector, the occluder operable to selective occlude light on a pixel-by-pixel basis.

833. The system of claim 832 wherein the first freeform reflective and lens optical component forms at least a portion of a contact lens.

834. The system of claim 818, further comprising:

a compensator lens optically coupled to a portion of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component.

835. A system comprising:

a first freeform reflective and lens optical component to increase a size of a field-of- view for a defined set of optical parameters, the first freeform reflective and lens optical component comprising: a first surface, a second surface, and a third surface, the first surface at least partially optically transmissive to light received by the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first surface, the second surface which is curved and at least partially reflects light received by the second surface from the first surface toward the third surface and which passes light received by the second surface from the curved surface, the third surface which is curved and at least partially reflects light out of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the second surface; and

a second freeform reflective and lens optical component, the second freeform reflective and lens optical component comprising: a first surface, a second surface, and a third surface, the first surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component at least partially optically transmissive to light received by the second freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first surface, the second surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component which is curved and at least partially reflects light received by the second surface from the first surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component toward the third surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component and which passes light received by the second surface from the third surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component, the third surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component which is curved and at least partially reflects light out of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component via the second surface,

wherein the first and the second freeform reflective and lens optical components are in an oppositely oriented stacked configuration along a Z-axis.

836. The system of claim 835 wherein the second surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component is adjacent the third surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component.

837. The system of claim 835 wherein the second surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component is concave and the third surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component is convex, that the third surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component closely receives the second surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component.

838. The system of claim 835 wherein the first surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component is flat and the first surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component is flat, and further comprising:

at least a first projector optically coupled to the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component; and at least a second projector optically coupled to the second freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component.

839. The system of claim 835, further comprising:

at least one wavelength selective material carried by at least one of the first or the second freeform reflective and lens optical components.

840. The system of claim 835, further comprising:

at least a first wavelength selective material carried by the first freeform reflective and lens optical components;

at least a second wavelength selective material carried by the second freeform reflective and lens optical components,

the first wavelength selective material selective of a first set of wavelengths and the second wavelength selective material selective of a second set of wavelengths, the second set of wavelengths different from the first set of wavelengths.

841. The system of claim 835, further comprising:

at least a first polarizer carried by the first freeform reflective and lens optical components;

at least a second polarizer carried by the second freeform reflective and lens optical components,

the first polarizer having a different polarization orientation than the second polarizer.

842. The system of claim 436, wherein the optical fiber cores are in the same fiber cladding.

843. The system of claim 436, wherein the optical fiber cores are in separate fiber claddings.

844. The system of claim 428, wherein the optical fiber cores are in the same fiber cladding.

845. The system of claim 428, wherein the optical fiber cores are in separate fiber claddings.

846. The system of claim 418, wherein the optical fiber cores are in the same fiber cladding.

847. The system of claim 418, wherein the optical fiber cores are in separate fiber claddings.

848. The system of claim 80, wherein the accommodation module tracks accommodation indirectly, by tracking the vergence or gaze of the user's eyes.

849. The system of claim 79, wherein the partially reflective mirror has relatively high reflectance for the polarization of light provided by the light source, and relative low reflectance for the other polarization states of light provided by the outside world.

850. The system of claim 79, wherein the plurality of partially reflective mirrors comprises a dielectric coating.

851. The system of claim 79, wherein the plurality of reflective mirrors has relatively high reflectance for the waveguides for the wavelengths of light provided by the light source, and relatively low reflectance for the other waveguides of light provided by the outside world.

852. The system of claim 77, wherein the VFE is a deformable mirror, the surface shape of which can be varied over time.

853. The system of claim 77, wherein the VFE is an electrostatically actuated membrane mirror, and wherein the waveguide or an additional transparent layer comprises one or more substantially transparent electrodes, and wherein a voltage applied to the one or more electrodes electrostatically deforms the membrane mirror.

854. The system of claim 68, wherein the light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus on a line segment basis.

855. The system of claim 68, wherein the waveguide comprises an exit pupil expansion function, wherein an input ray of light is split and outcoupled as multiple rays of light exiting the waveguide at multiple locations.

856. The system of claim 70, wherein the image data is scaled by a processor in accordance with and to compensate for changing optical image magnification, before the waveguide receives the one or more light patterns, such that the image magnification appears to remain substantially fixed while adjusting focus level.

857. The system of claim 68, wherein the first focus level is collimated.

858. The system of claim 68, wherein the VFE is integrated into the waveguide.

859. The system of claim 68, wherein the VFE is separate from the waveguide.

860. The system of claim 93, wherein the accommodation module tracks accommodation indirectly, by tracking the vergence or gaze of the user's eyes.

861. The system of claim 92, wherein the partially reflective mirror has relatively high reflectance for the polarization of light provided by the light source, and relative low reflectance for the other polarization states of light provided by the outside world.

862. The system of claim 92, wherein the plurality of partially reflective mirrors comprises a dielectric coating.

863. The system of claim 90, wherein the plurality of reflective mirrors has relatively high reflectance for the waveguides for the wavelengths of light provided by the light source, and relatively low reflectance for the other waveguides of light provided by the outside world.

864. The system of claim 81 , wherein the VFE is a deformable mirror, the surface shape of which can be varied over time.

865. The system of claim 81 , wherein the VFE is an electrostatically actuated membrane mirror, and wherein the waveguide or an additional transparent layer comprises one or more substantially transparent electrodes, and wherein a voltage applied to the one or more electrodes electrostatically deforms the membrane mirror.

866. The system of claim 81 , wherein the light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus on a line segment basis.

867. The system of claim 81 , wherein the waveguide comprises an exit pupil expansion function, wherein an input ray of light is split and outcoupled as multiple rays of light exiting the waveguide at multiple locations.

868. The system of claim 81 , wherein the image data is scaled by a processor in accordance with and to compensate for changing optical image magnification, before the waveguide receives the one or more light patterns, such that the image magnification appears to remain substantially fixed while adjusting focus level.

869. The system of claim 68, wherein the first focus level is collimated.

870. The system of claim 106, wherein the accommodation module tracks accommodation indirectly, by tracking the vergence or gaze of the user's eyes.

871. The system of claim 105, wherein the partially reflective mirror has relatively high reflectance for the polarization of light provided by the light source, and relative low reflectance for the other polarization states of light provided by the outside world.

872. The system of claim 105, wherein the plurality of partially reflective mirrors comprises a dielectric coating.

873. The system of claim 103, wherein the plurality of reflective mirrors has relatively high reflectance for the waveguides for the wavelengths of light provided by the light source, and relatively low reflectance for the other waveguides of light provided by the outside world.

874. The system of claim 94, wherein the VFE is a deformable mirror, the surface shape of which can be varied over time.

875. The system of claim 94, wherein the VFE is an electrostatically actuated membrane mirror, and wherein the waveguide or an additional transparent layer comprises one or more substantially transparent electrodes, and wherein a voltage applied to the one or more electrodes electrostatically deforms the membrane mirror.

876. The system of claim 94, wherein the light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus on a line segment basis.

878. The system of claim 94, wherein the waveguide comprises an exit pupil expansion function, wherein an input ray of light is split and outcoupled as multiple rays of light exiting the waveguide at multiple locations.

879. The system of claim 94, wherein the image data is scaled by a processor in accordance with and to compensate for changing optical image magnification, before the waveguide receives the one or more light patterns, such that the image magnification appears to remain substantially fixed while adjusting focus level.

880. The system of claim 94, wherein the first focus level is collimated.

Description:
VIRTUAL AND AUGMENTED REALITY SYSTEMS AND METHODS

FIELD OF THE INVENTION

[0001] The present disclosure relates to virtual reality and augmented reality imaging and visualization systems.

BACKGROUND

[0002] Modern computing and display technologies have facilitated the development of systems for so called "virtual reality" or "augmented reality" experiences, wherein digitally reproduced images or portions thereof are presented to a user in a manner wherein they seem to be, or may be perceived as, real. A virtual reality, or "VR", scenario typically involves presentation of digital or virtual image information without transparency to other actual real- world visual input; an augmented reality, or "AR", scenario typically involves presentation of digital or virtual image information as an augmentation to visualization of the actual world around the user. For example, referring to Figure 1 , an augmented reality scene (4) is depicted wherein a user of an AR technology sees a real-world park-like setting (6) featuring people, trees, buildings in the background, and a concrete platform (1 120). In addition to these items, the user of the AR technology also perceives that he "sees" a robot statue (11 10) standing upon the real-world platform (1 120), and a cartoon-like avatar character (2) flying by which seems to be a personification of a bumble bee, even though these elements (2, 1 1 10) do not exist in the real world. As it turns out, the human visual perception system is very complex, and producing a VR or AR technology that facilitates a comfortable, natural-feeling, rich

presentation of virtual image elements amongst other virtual or real-world imagery elements is challenging.

[0003] Referring to Figure 2A, stereoscopic wearable glasses (8) type configurations have been developed which generally feature two displays (10, 12) that are configured to display images with slightly different element presentation such that a three-dimensional perspective is perceived by the human visual system. Such configurations have been found to be uncomfortable for many users due to a mismatch between vergence and accommodation which must be overcome to perceive the images in three dimensions; indeed, some users are not able to tolerate stereoscopic configurations. Figure 2B shows another stereoscopic wearable glasses (14) type configuration featuring two forward-oriented cameras (16, 18) configured to capture images for an augmented reality presentation to the user through stereoscopic displays. The position of the cameras (16, 18) and displays generally blocks the natural field of view of the user when the glasses (14) are mounted on the user's head.

[0004] Referring to Figure 2C, an augmented reality configuration (20) is shown which features a visualization module (26) coupled to a glasses frame (24) which also holds conventional glasses lenses (22). The user is able to see an at least partially unobstructed view of the real world with such a system, and has a small display (28) with which digital imagery may be presented in an AR configuration to one eye - for a monocular AR

presentation. Figure 2D features a configuration wherein a visualization module (32) may be coupled to a hat or helmet (30) and configured to present monocular augmented digital imagery to a user through a small display (34). Figure 2E illustrates another similar configuration wherein a frame (36) couple-able to a user's head in a manner similar to an eyeglasses coupling so that a visualization module (38) may be utilized to capture images and also present monocular augmented digital imagery to a user through a small display (40). Such a configuration is available, for example, from Google, Inc., of Mountain View, CA under the trade name GoogleGlass (RTM). None of these configurations is optimally suited for presenting a rich, binocular, three-dimensional augmented reality experience in a manner that will be comfortable and maximally useful to the user, in part because prior systems fail to address some of the fundamental aspects of the human perception system, including the

photoreceptors of the retina and their interoperation with the brain to produce the perception of visualization to the user.

[0005] Referring to Figure 3, a simplified cross-sectional view of a human eye is depicted featuring a cornea (42), iris (44), lens - or "crystalline lens" (46), sclera (48), choroid layer (50), macula (52), retina (54), and optic nerve pathway (56) to the brain. The macula is the center of the retina, which is utilized to see moderate detail; at the center of the macula is a portion of the retina that is referred to as the "fovea", which is utilized for seeing the finest details, and which contains more photoreceptors (approximately 120 cones per visual degree) than any other portion of the retina. The human visual system is not a passive sensor type of system; it is configured to actively scan the environment. In a manner somewhat akin to use of a flatbed scanner to capture an image, or use of a finger to read Braille from a paper, the photoreceptors of the eye fire in response to changes in stimulation, rather than constantly responding to a constant state of stimulation. Thus motion is required to present photoreceptor information to the brain (as is motion of the linear scanner array across a piece of paper in a flatbed scanner, or motion of a finger across a word of Braille imprinted into a paper). Indeed, experiments with substances such as cobra venom, which has been utilized to paralyze the muscles of the eye, have shown that a human subject will experience blindness if positioned with his eyes open, viewing a static scene with venom-induced paralysis of the eyes. In other words, without changes in stimulation, the photoreceptors do not provide input to the brain and blindness is experienced. It is believed that this is at least one reason that the eyes of normal humans have been observed to move back and forth, or dither, in side-to-side motion in what are called "microsaccades".

[0006] As noted above, the fovea of the retina contains the greatest density of

photoreceptors, and while humans typically have the perception that they have high-resolution visualization capabilities throughout their field of view, they generally actually have only a small high-resolution center that they are mechanically sweeping around a lot, along with a persistent memory of the high-resolution information recently captured with the fovea. In a somewhat similar manner, the focal distance control mechanism of the eye (ciliary muscles operatively coupled to the crystalline lens in a manner wherein ciliary relaxation causes taut ciliary connective fibers to flatten out the lens for more distant focal lengths; ciliary contraction causes loose ciliary connective fibers, which allow the lens to assume a more rounded geometry for more close-in focal lengths) dithers back and forth by approximately ¼ to ½ diopter to cyclically induce a small amount of what is called "dioptric blur" on both the close side and far side of the targeted focal length; this is utilized by the accommodation control circuits of the brain as cyclical negative feedback that helps to constantly correct course and keep the retinal image of a fixated object approximately in focus.

[0007] The visualization center of the brain also gains valuable perception information from the motion of both eyes and components thereof relative to each other. Vergence movements (i.e., rolling movements of the pupils toward or away from each other to converge the lines of sight of the eyes to fixate upon an object) of the two eyes relative to each other are closely associated with focusing (or "accommodation") of the lenses of the eyes. Under normal conditions, changing the focus of the lenses of the eyes, or accommodating the eyes, to focus upon an object at a different distance will automatically cause a matching change in vergence to the same distance, under a relationship known as the "accommodation-vergence reflex." Likewise, a change in vergence will trigger a matching change in accommodation, under normal conditions. Working against this reflex, as do most conventional stereoscopic AR or VR configurations, is known to produce eye fatigue, headaches, or other forms of discomfort in users. [0008] Movement of the head, which houses the eyes, also has a key impact upon visualization of objects. Humans move their heads to visualize the world around them; they often are in a fairly constant state of repositioning and reorienting the head relative to an object of interest. Further, most people prefer to move their heads when their eye gaze needs to move more than about 20 degrees off center to focus on a particular object (i.e., people do not typically like to look at things "from the corner of the eye"). Humans also typically scan or move their heads in relation to sounds - to improve audio signal capture and utilize the geometry of the ears relative to the head. The human visual system gains powerful depth cues from what is called "head motion parallax", which is related to the relative motion of objects at different distances as a function of head motion and eye vergence distance (i.e., if a person moves his head from side to side and maintains fixation on an object, items farther out from that object will move in the same direction as the head; items in front of that object will move opposite the head motion; these are very salient cues for where things are spatially in the environment relative to the person - perhaps as powerful as stereopsis). Head motion also is utilized to look around objects, of course.

[0009] Further, head and eye motion are coordinated with something called the "vestibulo- ocular reflex", which stabilizes image information relative to the retina during head rotations, thus keeping the object image information approximately centered on the retina. In response to a head rotation, the eyes are reflexively and proportionately rotated in the opposite direction to maintain stable fixation on an object. As a result of this compensatory relationship, many humans can read a book while shaking their head back and forth (interestingly, if the book is panned back and forth at the same speed with the head approximately stationary, the same generally is not true - the person is not likely to be able to read the moving book; the vestibulo- ocular reflex is one of head and eye motion coordination, generally not developed for hand motion). This paradigm may be important for augmented reality systems, because head motions of the user may be associated relatively directly with eye motions, and the system preferably will be ready to work with this relationship.

[0010] Indeed, given these various relationships, when placing digital content (e.g., 3-D content such as a virtual chandelier object presented to augment a real-world view of a room; or 2-D content such as a planar/flat virtual oil painting object presented to augment a real-world view of a room), design choices may be made to control behavior of the objects. For example, the 2-D oil painting object may be head-centric, in which case the object moves around along with the user's head (e.g., as in a GoogleGlass approach); or the object may be world-centric, in which case it may be presented as though it is part of the real world coordinate system, so that the user may move his head or eyes without moving the position of the object relative to the real world.

[001 1] Thus when placing virtual content into the augmented reality world presented with an augmented reality system, whether the object should be presented as world centric (i.e., the virtual object stays in position in the real world so that the user may move his body, head, eyes around it without changing its position relative to the real world objects surrounding it, such as a real world wall); body, or torso, centric, in which case a virtual element may be fixed relative to the user's torso, so that the user can move his head or eyes without moving the object, but that is slaved to torso movements; head centric, in which case the displayed object (and/or display itself) may be moved along with head movements, as described above in reference to

GoogleGlass; or eye centric, as in a "foveated display" configuration, as is described below, wherein content is slewed around as a function of what the eye position is.

[0012] With world-centric configurations, it may be desirable to have inputs such as accurate head pose measurement, accurate representation and/or measurement of real world objects and geometries around the user, low-latency dynamic rendering in the augmented reality display as a function of head pose, and a generally low-latency display.

[0013] The systems and techniques described herein are configured to work with the visual configuration of the typical human to address these challenges.

SUMMARY

[0014] Embodiments of the present invention are directed to devices, systems and methods for facilitating virtual reality and/or augmented reality interaction for one or more users. In one aspect, a system for displaying virtual content is disclosed.

[0015] In one or more embodiments, the system comprises a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner; and an array of reflectors to receive the one or more light patterns and variably converge light on an exit pupil.

[0016] In one or more embodiment, the system comprises an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner, a light modulator configured to transmit light associated with the one or more frames of image data, a substrate to direct image information to a user's eye, wherein the substrate houses a plurality of reflectors, a first reflector of the plurality of reflectors to reflect light associated with a first frame of image data at a first angle to the user's eye, and a second reflector of the plurality of reflectors to reflect light associated with a second frame of image data at a second angle to the user's eye.

[0017] The angle of reflection of the plurality of reflectors may be variable in one or more embodiments. The reflectors may be switchable in one or more embodiments. The plurality of reflectors may be electro-optically active in one or more embodiments. A refractive index of the plurality of reflectors may be varied to match a refractive index of the substrate in one or more embodiments. In an optional embodiment, the system may also comprise a high-frequency gating layer configurable to be placed in between the substrate and the user's eye, the high- frequency gating layer having an aperture that is controllably movable. The aperture of the high-frequency gating layer may be moved in a manner such that image data is selectively transmitted only through the light that is reflected through the aperture in one or more embodiments. One or more reflectors of the transmissive beamsplitter substrate may be blocked by the high-frequency gating layer. The aperture may be an LCD aperture in one or more embodiments. The aperture may be a MEMs array in one or more embodiments. The first angle may be the same as the second angle in one or more embodiments. The first angle may be different than the second angle in one or more embodiments.

[0018] In one or more embodiments, the system may further comprise a first lens to steer a set of light rays through a nodal point and to the user's eye. The first lens may be configurable to be placed on the substrate and in front of the first reflector such that the set of light rays exiting the reflector pass through the first lens before reaching the user's eye in one or more embodiments.

[0019] The system may further comprise a second lens to compensate for the first lens, the second lens configurable to be placed on the substrate and on a side opposite to the side on which the first lens is placed, thereby resulting in zero magnification, in one or more embodiments.

[0020] The first reflector of the plurality of reflectors may be a curved reflective surface to collect a set of light rays associated with the image data into a single output point before being delivered to the user's eye in one or more embodiments. The curved reflector may a parabolic reflector in one or more embodiments. The curved reflector may be an elliptical reflector in one or more embodiments.

[0021] In another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content comprises providing one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time- sequential manner and reflecting the one or more light patterns associated with the one or more frames of image data via a transmissive beamsplitter to an exit pupil, the transmissive beamsplitter having a plurality of reflectors to variably converge on the exit pupil. [0022] The angle of reflection of the plurality of reflectors may be variable in one or more embodiments. The reflectors may be switchable in one or more embodiments. The plurality of reflectors may be electro-optically active in one or more embodiments. A refractive index of the plurality of reflectors may be varied to match a refractive index of the substrate in one or more embodiments. In an optional embodiment, the system may also comprise a high-frequency gating layer configurable to be placed in between the substrate and the user's eye, the high- frequency gating layer having an aperture that is controllably movable. The aperture of the high-frequency gating layer may be moved in a manner such that image data is selectively transmitted only through the light that is reflected through the aperture in one or more embodiments. One or more reflectors of the transmissive beamsplitter substrate may be blocked by the high-frequency gating layer. The aperture may be an LCD aperture in one or more embodiments. The aperture may be a MEMs array in one or more embodiments. The first angle may be the same as the second angle in one or more embodiments. The first angle may be different than the second angle in one or more embodiments.

[0023] In one or more embodiments, the system may further comprise a first lens to steer a set of light rays through a nodal point and to the user's eye. The first lens may be configurable to be placed on the substrate and in front of the first reflector such that the set of light rays exiting the reflector pass through the first lens before reaching the user's eye in one or more embodiments.

[0024] The system may further comprise a second lens to compensate for the first lens, the second lens configurable to be placed on the substrate and on a side opposite to the side on which the first lens is placed, thereby resulting in zero magnification, in one or more embodiments.

[0025] The first reflector of the plurality of reflectors may be a curved reflective surface to collect a set of light rays associated with the image data into a single output point before being delivered to the user's eye in one or more embodiments. The curved reflector may a parabolic reflector in one or more embodiments. The curved reflector may be an elliptical reflector in one or more embodiments.

[0026] In one or more embodiments, the wavefront may be collimated. In one or more embodiments, the wavefront may be curved. The collimated wavefront may be perceived as an infinity depth plane, in some embodiments. The curved wavefront may be perceived as a depth plane closer than optical infinity, in some embodiments.

[0027] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner, an array of reflectors to receive the one or more light patterns, the array of reflectors oriented at a particular angle, and a plurality of optical elements coupled to the array of reflectors to variably converge the light patterns on an exit pupil.

[0028] In one or more embodiments, the array of reflectors may be separate from the optical elements, in one or more embodiments. The array of reflectors may comprise flat mirrors, in one or more embodiments. The optical elements may be lenslets coupled to the array of reflectors, in one or more embodiments. The one or more reflectors of the array of reflectors may be curved, in one or more embodiments. The optical elements may be integrated into the array of reflectors. The plurality of optical elements may expand an exit pupil, in one or more embodiments.

[0029] The system may further comprise a first lens to steer a set of light rays through a nodal point and to the user's eye, wherein the first lens is configurable to be placed on the substrate and in front of the first reflector such that the set of light rays exiting the reflector pass through the first lens before reaching the user's eye, in one or more embodiments.

[0030] The system may further comprise a second lens to compensate for the first lens, the second lens configurable to be placed on the substrate and on a side opposite to the side on which the first lens is placed, thereby resulting in zero magnification, in one or more embodiments. The plurality of reflectors may comprise wavelength-selective reflectors, in one or more embodiments. The plurality of reflectors may comprise half-silvered mirrors, in one or more embodiments. The plurality of optical elements may comprise refractive lenses. The plurality of optical elements may comprise diffractive lenses, in one or more embodiments. The curved reflectors may comprise wave-length selective notch filters, in one or more embodiments.

[0031] In another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content to a user comprises providing one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner, reflecting the one or more light patterns associated with the one or more frames of image data via a transmissive beamsplitter to an exit pupil, the transmissive beamsplitter having a plurality of reflectors to variably converge on the exit pupil, and expanding an exit pupil through a plurality of optical elements coupled to the plurality of reflectors of the transmissive beamsplitter.

[0032] In one or more embodiments, the array of reflectors may be separate from the optical elements. In one or more embodiments the array of reflectors comprise flat mirrors. The optical elements may be lenslets coupled to the array of reflectors, in one or more embodiments.

[0033] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner, and a waveguide to receive the one or more light patterns and converge the light patterns to a first focus, and a variable focus element (VFE) coupled to the waveguide to converge at least some of the light patterns to a second focus.

[0034] In one or more embodiments, the VFE is telecentric, in one or more embodiments. The VFE is non-telecentric, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a compensating lens such that the user's view of the outside world is undistorted, in one or more embodiments. The plurality of frames are presented to the user at a high frequency such that the user perceives the frames as part of a single coherent scene, wherein the VFE varies the focus from a first frame to a second frame, in one or more embodiments. The light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus in a line-by-line manner, in one or more embodiments. The light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus in a pixel-by-pixel manner, in one or more embodiments.

[0035] The VFE is a diffractive lens, in one or more embodiments. The VFE is a refractive lens, in one or more embodiments. The VFE is a reflective mirror, in one or more embodiments. The reflective mirror is opaque, in one or more embodiments. The reflective mirror is partially reflective, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises an accommodation module to track an accommodation of a user's eyes, wherein the VFE varies the focus of the light patterns based at least in part on the accommodation of the user's eyes, in one or more embodiments.

[0036] In yet another embodiment, system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner, a waveguide to receive the one or more light patterns and converge the light patterns to a first focus, and a variable focus element (VFE) coupled to the waveguide to converge at least some of the light patterns to a second focus, wherein the VFE is integrated into the waveguide.

[0037] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user comprises a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner, a waveguide to receive the one or more light patterns and converge the light patterns to a first focus, and a variable focus element (VFE) coupled to the waveguide to converge at least some of the light patterns to a second focus, wherein the VFE is separate from the waveguide.

[0038] In another aspect, a method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises providing one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data, converging the one or more light patterns associated with the one or more frames of image data to a first focus through a waveguide, and modifying, through a variable focus element (VFE), the first focus of the light to produce a wavefront at a second focus. [0039] The VFE is separate from the waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The VFE is integrated into the waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The one or more frames of image data are provided in a time-sequential manner, in one or more embodiments. The VFE modifies the focus of the one or more frames of image data on a frame-by-frame basis, in one or more embodiments. The VFE modifies the focus of the one or more frames of image data on a pixel-by-pixel basis, in one or more embodiments. The VFE modifies the first focus to produce a wavefront at a third focus, wherein the second focus is different than the third focus, in one or more embodiments. The wavefront at the second focus is perceived by the user as coming from a particular depth plane, in one or more embodiments.

[0040] In some embodiments, the plurality of frames are presented to the user at a high frequency such that the user perceives the frames as part of a single coherent scene, wherein the VFE varies the focus from a first frame to a second frame. The light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus in a line-by-line manner, in one or more embodiments.

[0041] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a plurality of waveguides to receive light rays associated with image data and to transmit the light rays toward the user's eyes, wherein the plurality of waveguides are stacked in a direction facing the user's eye, and a first lens coupled to a first waveguide of the plurality of waveguides to modify light rays transmitted from the first waveguide, thereby delivering light rays having a first wavefront curvature, and a second lens coupled to a second waveguide of the plurality of waveguides to modify light rays transmitted from the second waveguide, thereby delivering light rays having a second wavefront curvature, wherein the first lens coupled to the first waveguide and the second lens coupled to the second waveguide are stacked horizontally in a direction facing the user's eye.

[0042] In one or more embodiments, the first wavefront curvature is different from the second wavefront curvature. The system further comprises a third waveguide of the plurality of waveguides to deliver collimated light to the user's eye, such that the user perceives the image data as coming from an optical infinity plane, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide is configured to transmit collimated light to the lens, in one or more embodiments.

[0043] The system further comprises a compensating lens layer to compensate for an aggregate power of the lenses stacked in the direction facing the user's eyes, wherein the compensating lens layer is stacked farthest from the user's eye, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide comprises a plurality of reflectors configurable to reflect the light rays injected into the waveguide toward the user's eye, in one or more embodiments.

[0044] The waveguide is electro-active, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide is switchable, in one or more embodiments. The light rays having the first wavefront curvature and the light rays having the second wavefront curvature are delivered simultaneously, in one or more embodiments. The light rays having the first wavefront curvature and the light rays having the second wavefront curvature are delivered sequentially, in one or more embodiments. The second wavefront curvature corresponds to a margin of the first wavefront curvature, thereby providing a focal range in which the user can accommodate, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises an accommodation module to track an accommodation of a user's eyes, and wherein the VFE varies the focus of the light patterns based at least in part on the accommodation of the user's eyes, in one or more embodiments.

[0045] In yet another embodiments, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a light source to multiplex one or more light patterns associated with one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner, a plurality of waveguides to receive the one or more light patterns and to converge light to an exit pupil, wherein the plurality of waveguides are stacked along a z-axis and away from the user's line of vision, and at least one optical element coupled to the stacked waveguides to modify a focus of the light transmitted by the plurality of waveguides.

[0046] The waveguide of the plurality of waveguides may comprise a waveguide to distribute the projected light across the length of the waveguide, and a lens to modify the light in a manner such that a wavefront curvature is created, wherein the created wavefront curvature corresponds to a focal plane when viewed by the user in one or more embodiments.

[0047] The waveguide of the plurality of waveguides comprises a diffractive optical element (DOE) , in one or more embodiments. The DOE is switchable between an on and off state, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide of the plurality of waveguides comprises a refractive lens, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide of the plurality of waveguides comprises a Fresnel zone plate, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide of the plurality of waveguides comprises a substrate guided optics (SGO) element, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide is switchable between an on and off state, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide is static, in one or more embodiments. The first frame of image data and second frame of image data are delivered to the user's eye simultaneously, in one or more embodiments. The first frame of image data and second frame of image data are delivered to the user's eye sequentially, in one or more embodiments.

[0048] The system further comprises a plurality of angled reflectors to deliver light to the user's eye, wherein the first waveguide component and the second waveguide component direct light to the one or more angled reflectors, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a beam distribution waveguide optic, the beam distribution waveguide coupled to the waveguide assembly, wherein the beam distribution waveguide optic is configurable to spread the projected light across the waveguide assembly, such that a light ray injected into the beam distributed waveguide optic is cloned and injected into waveguide components of the waveguide assembly, in one or more embodiments.

[0049] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user comprises an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner, a light modulator to project light associated with the one or more frames of image data, a waveguide assembly to receiving the projected light and deliver the light towards the user's eye, wherein the waveguide assembly comprises at least a first waveguide component configurable to modify light associated with a first frame of the image data such the light is perceived as coming from a first focal plane, and a second waveguide component configurable to modify light associated with a second frame of the image data such that the light is perceived as coming from a second focal plane, and wherein the first waveguide component and second waveguide component are stacked along a z-axis in front of the user's eye.

[0050] In some embodiments, the waveguide component of the waveguide assembly comprises a waveguide to distribute the projected light across the length of the waveguide, and a lens to modify the light in a manner such that a wavefront curvature is created, wherein the created wavefront curvature corresponds to a focal plane when viewed by the user. The waveguide component of the waveguide assembly comprises a diffractive optical element (DOE) in one or more embodiments.

[0051] The DOE is switchable between an on and off state in one or more embodiments. . The waveguide component of the waveguide assembly comprises a refractive lens in one or more embodiments. The waveguide component of the waveguide assembly comprises a Fresnel zone plate in one or more embodiments. The first frame of image data and second frame of image data are delivered to the user's eye simultaneously in one or more embodiments. The first frame of image data and second frame of image data are delivered to the user's eye sequentially, in one or more embodiments.

[0052] The system further comprises a plurality of angled reflectors to deliver light to the user's eye, wherein the first waveguide component and the second waveguide component direct light to the one or more angled reflectors in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a beam distribution waveguide optic, the beam distribution waveguide coupled to the waveguide assembly, wherein the beam distribution waveguide optic is configurable to spread the projected light across the waveguide assembly, such that a light ray injected into the beam distributed waveguide optic is cloned and injected into waveguide components of the waveguide assembly in one or more embodiments.

[0053] The waveguide component of the waveguide assembly comprises a reflector configurable to reflect the projected light at a desired angle toward the user's eye. The first waveguide component comprises a first reflector configured to reflect the projected light at a first angle, and wherein the second waveguide component comprises a second reflector to reflect the projected light at a second angle in one or more embodiments. The first reflector is staggered in relation to the second reflector, thereby expanding a field of view of the image as viewed by the user in one or more embodiments.

[0054] The reflectors of the waveguide components are positioned in a manner to form a continuous curved reflection surface across the waveguide assembly in one or more embodiments. The continuous curved reflection surface comprises a parabolic curve in one or more embodiments. The continuous curved reflection surface comprises an elliptical curve in one or more embodiments.

[0055] In yet another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content to a user comprises delivering, through a first waveguide, light rays associated with a first frame of image data to the user, the light rays having a first wavefront curvature, and delivering, through a second waveguide, light rays associated with a second frame of image data to the user, the light rays having a second wavefront curvature, wherein the first waveguide and second waveguide are stacked along a z axis facing the user's eyes.

[0056] The first wavefront curvature and the second wavefront curvature are delivered simultaneously, in one or more embodiments. The first wavefront curvature and the second wavefront curvature are delivered sequentially, in one or more embodiments. The first and second wavefront curvatures are perceived as a first and second depth plane by the user, in one or more embodiments. The first and second waveguides are coupled to one or more optical elements, in one or more embodiments. The method may further comprise compensating for an effect of the one or more optical elements through a compensation lens, in one or more embodiments.

[0057] The method may further comprise determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, and delivering light rays through at least one of the first and second waveguides based at least in part on the determined accommodation, in one or more embodiments.

[0058] In another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content to a user comprises determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, delivering, through a first waveguide of a stack of waveguides, light rays having a first wavefront curvature based at least in part on the determined accommodation, wherein the first wavefront curvature corresponds to a focal distance of the determined accommodation, and delivering, through a second waveguide of the stack of waveguides, light rays having a second wavefront curvature, the second wavefront curvature associated with a predetermined margin of the focal distance of the determined accommodation.

[0059] The margin is a positive margin, in one or more embodiments. The margin is a negative margin, in one or more embodiments. The second waveguide increases a focal range in which the user can accommodate, in one or more embodiments. The first waveguide is coupled to a variable focus element (VFE), wherein the VFE varies a focus at which the waveguide focuses the light rays, in one or more embodiments. The focus is varied based at least in part on the determined accommodation of the users' eyes, in one or more embodiments. The first wavefront curvature and the second wavefront curvature are delivered simultaneously, in one or more embodiments.

[0060] The first and second wavefront curvatures are perceived as a first and second depth plane by the user, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide is a diffractive optical element (DOE) , in one or more embodiments. The waveguide is a substrate guided optic (SGO), in one or more embodiments. The first and second waveguides are switchable, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide comprises one or more switchable elements, in one or more embodiments.

[0061] In yet another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user comprises an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time- sequential manner, a display assembly to project light rays associated with the one or more frames of image data, the display assembly comprises a first display element corresponding to a first frame-rate and a first bit depth, and a second display element corresponding to a second frame-rate and a second bit depth, and a variable focus element (VFE) configurable to vary a focus of the projected light and transmit the light to the user's eye.

[0062] The first frame-rate is higher than the second frame-rate, and the first bit depth is lower than the second bit depth, in one or more embodiments. The first display element is a DLP projection system, in one or more embodiments. The second display element is a liquid crystal display (LCD), in one or more embodiments. The first display element projects light to a subset of the second display element such that a periphery of the LCD has constant illumination, in one or more embodiments. Only light transmitted from the first display element is focused through the VFE, in one or more embodiments.

[0063] The VFE is optically conjugate to an exit pupil, such that a focus of the projected light is varied without affecting a magnification of the image data, in one or more embodiments. The first display element is a DLP, and the second display element is an LCD, and wherein the DLP is of low resolution, and wherein the LCD is of high resolution, in one or more embodiments. The intensity of backlight is varied over time to equalize a brightness of sub- images projected by the first display element, thereby increase a frame rate of the first display element, in one or more embodiments.

[0064] The VFE is configurable to vary the focus of the projected light on a frame- by-frame basis, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises software to compensate for optical magnification associated with an operation of the VFE, in one or more embodiments. The image-generating source produces slices of a particular image that when projected together or sequentially produces a three-dimensional volume of an object, in one or more embodiments. The DLP is operated in a binary mode, in one or more embodiments. The DLP is operated in a grayscale mode, in one or more embodiments.

[0065] The VFE varies the projected light such that a first frame is perceived as coming from a first focal plane, and a second frame is perceived as coming from a second focal plane, wherein the first focal plane is different from the second focal plane, in one or more embodiments. The focal distance associated with the focal plane is fixed, in one or more embodiments. The focal distance associated with the focal plane is variable, in one or more embodiments.

[0066] In another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content to a user comprises providing one or more image slices, wherein a first and second image slice of the one or more image slices represents a three-dimensional volume, projecting light associated with the first image slice through a spatial light modulator, focusing, through a variable focus element (VFE), the first image slice to a first focus, delivering the first image slice having the first focus to the user, providing light associated with the second image slice, focusing, through the VFE, the second image slice to a second focus, wherein the first focus is different from the second focus, and delivering the second image slice having the second focus to the user.

[0067] The method may further comprise determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the VFE focuses the projected light based at least in part on the determined accommodation, in one or more embodiments. The image slices are provided in a frame- sequential fashion, in one or more embodiments. The first image slice and the second image slice are delivered simultaneously, in one or more embodiments. The first image slice and the second image slice are delivered sequentially, in one or more embodiments.

[0068] In yet another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content to a user comprises combining a first display element with a second display element, the first display element corresponding to a high frame rate and a low bit depth, and the second display element corresponding to a low frame rate and a high bit depth, such that the combined display elements correspond to a high frame rate and high bit depth, projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data through the combined display elements, and switching a focus of the projected light, through a variable focus element (VFE), on a frame-by-frame basis, such that a first image slice is projected at a first focus, and a second image slice is projected at a second focus.

[0069] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a plurality of lightguides to receive coherent light associated with one or more frames of image data and to produce an aggregate wavefront, a phase modulator coupled to one or more lightguides of the plurality of light guides to induce a phase delay in the light projected by the one or more lightguides, and a processor to control the phase modulator in a manner such that the aggregate wavefront produced by the plurality of lightguides is varied.

[0070] The wavefront produced a lightguide of the plurality of light guides is a spherical wavefront, in one or more embodiments. The spherical wavefronts produced by at least two lightguides constructively interfere with each other, in one or more embodiments. The spherical wavefronts produced by the at least two lightguides destructively interfere with each other, in one or more embodiments. The aggregate wavefront is an approximately planar wavefront, in one or more embodiments.

[0071] The planar wavefront corresponds to an optical infinity depth plane. The aggregate wavefront is spherical, in one or more embodiments. The spherical wavefront corresponds to a depth plane closer than optical infinity, in one or more embodiments. An inverse Fourier transform of a desired beam is injected into the multicore fibers, such that a desired aggregate wavefront is produced, in one or more embodiments.

[0072] In another aspect, a system of displaying virtual content to a user comprises an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data, a multicore assembly comprising a plurality of multicore fibers to project light associated with the one or more frames of image data, a multicore fiber of the plurality of multicore fibers emitting light in a wavefront, such that the multicore assembly produces an aggregate wavefront of the projected light, and a phase modulator to induce phase delays between the multicore fibers in a manner such that the aggregate wavefront emitted by the multicore assembly is varied, thereby varying a focal distance at which the user perceives the one or more frames of image data.

[0073] In yet another aspect, a method for displaying virtual content to a user comprises emitting light through a multicore fiber, the multicore fiber comprising a plurality of single core fibers, wherein the singlecore fibers emit a spherical wavefront, providing an aggregate wavefront from light emitted from the plurality of single core fibers, and inducing a phase delay between the singlecore fibers of the multicore fiber such the aggregate wavefront produced by the multicore fiber is varied based at least in part on the induced phase delay.

[0074] The aggregate wavefront is a planar wavefront, in one or more embodiments. The planar wavefront corresponds to optical infinity, in one or more embodiments. The aggregate wavefront is spherical, in one or more embodiments. The spherical wavefront corresponds to a depth plane closer than optical infinity, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises injecting an inverse Fourier transform of a desired wavefront into the multicore fiber such that the aggregate wavefront corresponds to the desired wavefront, in one or more embodiments. [0075] In yet another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user comprises an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data, a multicore assembly comprising a plurality of multicore fibers to project light associated with the one or more frames of image data, an image injector to input images into the multicore assembly, wherein the input injector is further configurable to input an inverse Fourier transform of a desired wavefront into the multicore assembly such that the multicore assembly outputs the Fourier transform by producing light associated with the image data in the desired wavefront, thereby allowing the user to perceive the image data at a desired focal distance.

[0076] The desired wavefront is associated with a hologram, in one or more embodiments. The inverse Fourier transform is input to modulate a focus of the one or more light beams, in one or more embodiments. A multicore fiber of the plurality of multicore fibers is a multi-mode fiber, in one or more embodiments. The multicore fiber of the plurality of multicore fibers is configured to propagate light along a plurality of paths along the fiber, in one or more embodiments. The multicore fiber is a single core fiber, in one or more embodiments. The multicore fiber is a concentric core fiber, in one or more embodiments.

[0077] The image injector is configured to input a wavelet pattern into the multicore assembly, in one or more embodiments. The image injector is configured to input a Zernike coefficient into the multicore assembly, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of the user's eye, wherein the image injector is configured to input an inverse Fourier transform of a wavefront corresponding to the determined accommodation of the user's eyes, in one or more embodiments.

[0078] In yet another embodiment, a method of displaying virtual content to a user comprises determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the determined accommodation is associated with a focal distance corresponding to a user's current state of focus, projecting, through a waveguide, light associated with one or more frames of image data, varying a focus of the projected light based at least in part on the determined accommodation, and delivering the projected light to the user's eyes, such that the light is perceived by the user as coming from the focal distance corresponding to the user's current state of focus.

[0079] The accommodation is measured directly, in one or more embodiments. The accommodation is measured indirectly, in one or more embodiments. The accommodation is measured through an infrared autorefractor. The accommodation is measured through eccentric photorefraction, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises measuring a convergence level of two eyes of the user to estimate the accommodation, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises blurring one or more portions of the one or more frames of image data based at least in part on the determined accommodation, in one or more embodiments. The focus is varied between fixed depth planes, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises a compensating lens to compensate for an optical effect of the waveguide, in one or more embodiments.

[0080] In one or more embodiments, a method of displaying virtual content to a user comprises determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the determined accommodation is associated with a focal distance corresponding to a user's current state of focus, projecting, through a diffractive optics element (DOE), light associated with one or more frames of image data, varying a focus of the projected light based at least in part on the determined accommodation, and delivering the projected light to the user's eyes, such that the light is perceived by the user as coming from the focal distance corresponding to the user's current state of focus.

[0081] In another embodiment, a method of displaying virtual content to a user comprises determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the determined accommodation is associated with a focal distance corresponding to a user's current state of focus, projecting, through a freeform optic, light associated with one or more frames of image data, varying a focus of the projected light based at least in part on the determined accommodation, and delivering the projected light to the user's eyes, such that the light is perceived by the user as coming from the focal distance corresponding to the user's current state of focus.

[0082] In another aspect, a method of displaying virtual content to a user comprises determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the determined accommodation is associated with a focal distance corresponding to a user's current state of focus, projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data, varying a focus of the projected light based at least in part on the determined accommodation, and delivering the projected light to the user's eyes, such that the light is perceived by the user as coming from the focal distance corresponding to the user's current state of focus.

[0083] The light is delivered to the user through a substrate guided optics assembly, in one or more embodiments. The light is delivered to the user through a freeform optical element, in one or more embodiments. The light is delivered to the user through a diffractive optical element (DOE) , in one or more embodiments. The light is projected through a stack of waveguides, a first of the stack of waveguide configured to output light at a particular wavefront, a second waveguide to output a positive margin wavefront relative to the particular wavefront, a third waveguide to output a negative margin wavefront relative to the particular wavefront, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises blurring a portion of the one or more frames of image data in a manner such that the portion is out of focus when the projected light is delivered to the user's eyes, in one or more embodiments. [0084] In yet another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time- sequential manner, a light generator to provide light associated with the one or more frames of image data, an accommodation tracking module to track an accommodation of the user's eye, and a waveguide assembly to vary a focus of the light associated with the one or more frames of image data, wherein different frames of image data are focused differently based at least in part on the tracked accommodation.

[0085] In another aspect, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of the user's eyes, an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner, a light generator to project light associated with the one or more frames of image data, a plurality of waveguides to receive light rays associated with image data and to transmit the light rays toward the user's eyes, wherein the plurality of waveguides are stacked in a direction facing the user's eye, and a variable focus element (VFE) to vary a focus of the transmitted light based at least in part on the determined accommodation of the user's eyes.

[0086] The waveguide of the plurality of waveguides is a waveguide element, wherein the focus of a first frame of image data transmitted from a first waveguide of the plurality of waveguides is different from the focus of a second frame of image data transmitted from a second waveguide of the plurality of waveguides, in one or more embodiments. The first frame is a first layer of a 3D scene, and a second frame is a second layer of the 3D scene, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a blurring module to blur a portion of the one or more frames of image data in a manner such that the portion is out of focus when viewed by the user, in one or more embodiments.

[0087] The VFE is common to the plurality of waveguides, in one or more embodiments. The VFE is associated with a waveguide of the plurality of waveguides, in one or more embodiments. The VFE is coupled to a waveguide of the plurality of waveguides, such that the VFE is interleaved between two waveguides of the plurality of waveguides, in one or more embodiments. The VFE is embedded into a waveguide of the plurality of waveguides, in one or more embodiments. The VFE is a diffractive optical element, in one or more embodiments. The VFE is a refractive element, in one or more embodiments.

[0088] The waveguide is electro-active, in one or more embodiments. One or more waveguides of the plurality of waveguides is switched off, in one or more embodiments. A waveguide of the plurality of waveguides corresponds to a fixed focal plane, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises an exit pupil, wherein a diameter of the exit pupil is no greater than 0.5 mm, in one or more embodiments. The light generator is a scanning fiber display. The system of claim 302, further comprising an array of exit pupils, in one or more embodiments.

[0089] The system further comprises a plurality of light generators, a light generator coupled to an exit pupil, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises an exit pupil expander, in one or more embodiments. The exit pupil is switchable based at least in part on the determined accommodation of the user's eyes, in one or more embodiments.

[0090] In another aspect, a system comprises an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of a user's eyes, a fiber scanning display to scan a plurality of light beams associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein a light beam of the plurality of light beams is movable, a blur software to render a simulated dioptric blur in the one or more frames of image data based at least in part on the determined accommodation of the user's eyes.

[0091] The diameter of light beams is no greater than 2 mm, in one or more embodiments. The diameter of light beams is no greater than 0.5 mm, in one or more embodiments. The scanned light beam is duplicated to create a plurality of exit pupils, in one or more embodiments. The scanned light beam is duplicated to create a larger eye box, in one or more embodiments. The exit pupils are switchable, in one or more embodiments.

[0092] In another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content comprises determining an accommodation of a user's eyes, scanning a plurality of light beams associated with one or more frames of image data, through a fiber scanning display, wherein a diameter of the light beam is no greater than 0.5 mm, such that the frames of image data appear in focus when viewed by the user, and blurring, using blur software, one or more portions of the frame based at least in part on the determined accommodation of the user's eyes.

[0093] A plurality of exit pupils are created, in one or more embodiments. The light beam is generated by a singlecore fiber, in one or more embodiments. The light beam is duplicated to create a plurality of exit pupils, in one or more embodiments. The exit pupils are switchable, in one or more embodiments.

[0094] In another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content to a user comprises determining a position of the user's pupil relative to a bundle of light projectors, wherein the bundle of light projectors corresponds to a sub-image of an image to be presented to the user, and driving, based on the determined position of the user's pupil, light corresponding to the sub-image into a portion of the user's pupil.

[0095] The method further comprises driving light corresponding to another sub-image of the image to be presented to another portion of the user's pupil through another bundle of light projectors, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises mapping one or more bundles of light projectors of the fiber scanning display with one or more portions of the user's pupil, in one or more embodiments. The mapping is a 1 : 1 mapping, in one or more embodiments.

[0096] The diameter of the light is no greater than 0.5 mm, in one or more embodiments. The bundle of light projectors produces an aggregate wavefront, in one or more embodiments. The beamlets produced by the light projectors form a discretized aggregate wavefront, in one or more embodiments. The beamlets approach the user's eye in parallel, the eye deflects the beamlets to converge upon a same spot on the retina, in one or more embodiments. The user's eye receives a superset of beamlets, the beamlets corresponding to a plurality of angles at which they interest the pupil, in one or more embodiments.

[0097] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user comprises a light source to provide light associated with one or more frames of image data, and a light display assembly to receive the light associated with the one or more frames of image data, wherein the light display assembly corresponds to multiple exit pupils spaced together, and wherein the multiple exit pupils transmit light into a pupil of the user.

[0098] The multiple exit pupils are arranged in a hexagonal lattice, in one or more embodiments. The multiple exit pupils are arranged in a square lattice, in one or more embodiments. The multiple exit pupils are arranged in a two-dimensional array, in one or more embodiments. The multiple exit pupils are arranged in a three-dimensional array, in one or more embodiments. The multiple exit pupils are arranged in a time-varying array, in one or more embodiments.

[0099] In one or more embodiments, a method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprising grouping a plurality of light projectors to form an exit pupil, driving a first light pattern, through a first exit pupil, into a first portion of the user's pupil, and driving a second light pattern, through a second exit pupil, into a second portion of the user's pupil, wherein the first light pattern and second light pattern corresponds to sub-images of an image to be presented to the user, and wherein the first light pattern is different than the second light pattern. The method further comprises creating a discretized aggregate wavefront, in one or more embodiments.

[00100] In yet another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises determining a location of a pupil of the user relative to a light display assembly, and calculating a focus at which to converge light to the pupil based at least in part on a limited eye box around the determined location of the pupil.

[00101 ] The diameter of light is no greater than 0.5 mm, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises creating a discretized aggregate wavefront, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises aggregating a plurality of discrete neighboring collimated light beams based at least in part on a center of a radius of curvature of a desired aggregate wavefront, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises determining an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the focus is calculated based at least in part on the determined accommodation, in one or more embodiments.

[00102] The method further comprising selecting an angular trajectory of light of a plurality of beamlets to create an out-of focus light beam, in one or more embodiments. A plurality of beamlets represent a pixel of image data to the presented to the user, in one or more embodiments. The beamlets hit the eye at a plurality of incident angles, in one or more embodiments.

[00103] In yet another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user comprises an image generating source to provide one or more portions of an image to be presented to the user, and a plurality of microprojectors to project light associated with the one or more portions of the image, the microprojectors positioned in a manner facing the user's pupil, and wherein a microprojector of the plurality of microprojectors is configured to project a set of light rays representing a portion of the sub-image, the set of light rays projected to a portion of the user's pupil.

[00104] A first portion of the user's pupil receives light rays from a plurality of microprojectors, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a reflective surface to reflect the light from the plurality of microprojectors to one or more portions of the user's pupil, in one or more embodiments. The reflective surface is positioned in a manner such that the user is able to view the real world through the reflective surface, in one or more embodiments. A diameter of light is no greater than 0.5 mm, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a discretized aggregate wavefront, in one or more embodiments.

[00105] In another embodiment, a system comprises a processor to determine a location of a user's pupil, and an array of spatial light modulators (SLMs) to project light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the array of SLMs are positioned based at least in part on the determined location of the user's pupil, and wherein the array of SLMs generate a lightfield when viewed by the user.

[00106] In another aspect, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data, a first spatial light modulator (SLM) configured to selectively transmit light rays associated with the one or more frames of image data, a second SLM positioned in relation to the first SLM, the second SLM also configured to selectively transmit light rays associated with the one or more frames of image data, and a processor to control the first and second SLMs in a manner such that a lightfield is created when the transmitted light rays are viewed by the user. [00107] The system further comprises an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of the user's eyes, in one or more embodiments. The SLM is an LCD, in one or more embodiments. The LCD is attenuated, in one or more embodiments. The LCD rotates a polarization of the transmitted light, in one or more embodiments. The SLM is a DMD, in one or more embodiments. The DMD is coupled to one or more lenses, in one or more embodiments. The SLM is a MEMs array, in one or more embodiments. The MEMs array comprises an array of sliding MEMs shutters, in one or more embodiments. The MEMs array is a Pixtronics ® MEMs array, in one or more embodiments.

[00108] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user comprises a plurality of optical fibers to project light associated with one or more frames of image data to be presented to the user, wherein an optical fiber of the plurality of optical fibers is coupled to a lens, the lens configured to alter a diameter of the light beam projected by the scanning fiber, wherein the lens comprises a gradient refractive index.

[00109] The lens is a GRIN lens, in one or more embodiments. The lens collimates the light beams, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises an actuator coupled to the optical fiber of the plurality of optical fibers to scan the fiber, in one or more embodiments. The actuator is a piezo-electric actuator, in one or more embodiments. An end of the optical fiber is polished at an angle to create a lensing effect, in one or more embodiments. An end of the optical fiber is melted to create a lensing effect, in one or more embodiments.

[001 10] A method for displaying virtual content to a user comprises projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light is projected through a plurality of optical fibers, modifying the light projected through the plurality of optical fibers through a lens, wherein the lens is coupled to a tip of the plurality of optical fibers, and delivering the modified light to the user, in one or more embodiments.

[001 11] In one or more embodiments, a system for displaying virtual content, comprises a multicore assembly comprising a plurality of fibers to multiplex light associated with one or more frames of image data, and a waveguide to receive the light patterns, and transmit the light patterns such that a first viewing zone only receives light associated with a first portion of an image, and a second viewing zone only receives light associated with a second portion of the image, wherein the first and second viewing zone is no greater than 0.5 mm. The system further comprises blurring software to blur out one or more portions of the frames of image data, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises an accommodation module to determine an accommodation of the user's eyes, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide projects light to a user's eye directly without an intermediate viewing optic, in one or more embodiments. [001 12] A system comprises a multicore assembly comprising a plurality of fibers to multiplex light associated with one or more frames of image data, a waveguide to receive the light patterns, and transmit the light patterns such that a first viewing zone only receives light associated with a first portion of an image, and a second viewing zone only receives light associated with a second portion of the image, wherein the first and second viewing zone is no greater than 0.5 mm, and an optical assembly coupled to the waveguide to modify the transmitted light beams to the first and second viewing zones, in one or more embodiments.

[001 13] The plurality of fibers project light into a single waveguide array. The multicore assembly is scanned, in one or more embodiments. A time-varying light field is generated, in one or more embodiments. The optical assembly is a DOE element. The optical assembly is an LC layer, in one or more embodiments.

[001 14] A method comprising projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data through a multicore assembly, the multicore assembly comprising a plurality of optical fibers, and delivering the projected light, through a waveguide, such that a first portion of the user's pupil receives light associated with a first portion of an image, and a second portion of the user's pupil receives light associated with a second portion of the image, in one or more embodiments.

[001 15] A diameter of the first and second portions is no greater than 0.5 mm, in one or more embodiments. The plurality of optical fibers project light into a single waveguide array, in one or more embodiments. The multicore assembly is scanned, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide comprises a plurality of reflectors, in one or more embodiments. An angle of the reflectors is variable, in one or more embodiments. A set of optics to modify light being delivered to the first and second viewing zones, in one or more embodiments. The set of optics is a DOE element. The set of optics is a freeform optic. The set of optics is an LC layer, in one or more embodiments.

[001 16] In one aspect, a system comprises an array of microprojectors to project light associated with one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user, wherein the array of microprojectors is positioned relative to a location of the user's pupil, and wherein the light is projected into the user's pupil, in one or more embodiments. The fiber scanning display of claim 407, wherein the first and second light beams are superimposed, in one or more embodiments. The fiber scanning display of claim 407, wherein the first and second light beam are deflected based at least in part on the critical angle of the polished bundled fiber, in one or more embodiments. The fiber scanning display of claim 407, wherein the polished bundled fibers is used to increase a resolution of the display. The polished bundled fibers is used to create a lightfield, in one or more embodiments. [001 17] In another embodiment, a system comprises an array of microprojectors to project light associated with one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user, wherein the array of microprojectors is positioned relative to a location of the user's pupil, and wherein the light is projected into the user's pupil, and an optical element coupled to the array of microprojectors to modify the light projected into the user's pupil.

[001 18] In yet another embodiment, a system comprises a plurality of multicore fibers to transmit light beams, the plurality of beams coupled together, and a coupling element to bundle the plurality of multicore fibers together, wherein the bundle of multicore fibers is polished at a critical angle relative to a longitudinal axis of the fiber such that a first light beam transmitted from a first fiber of the bundled fibers has a first path length, and a second light beam transmitted from a second fiber of the bundled fibers has a second path length, and wherein the first path length is different from the second path length such that the first light beam is out of phase relative to the second light beam.

[001 19] The first and second light beams are superimposed, in one or more embodiments. The first and second light beam are deflected based at least in part on the critical angle of the polished bundled fiber, in one or more embodiments. The polished bundled fibers is used to increase a resolution of the display, in one or more embodiments. The polished bundled fibers is used to create a lightfield, in one or more embodiments.

[00120] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user comprises an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data, a plurality of optical fibers to transmit light beams associated with the one or more frames of image data, and an optical element coupled to the plurality of optical fibers to receive collimated light from the optical fibers and deliver the light beams to the user's eye, wherein the light beams are delivered at a plurality of angles to the user's eye such that a first light beam is delivered to a portion of a user's eye at a first angle, and a second light beam is delivered to the same portion of the user's eye at a second angle, wherein the first angle is different from the second angle. The optical element is a waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a phase modulator to modulate the transmission of light through the optical fibers, in one or more embodiments.

[00121] In yet another embodiment, a method comprises providing one or more frames of image data, transmitting light beams associated with the one or more frames of image data through a plurality of optical fibers, and delivering the light beams to the user's eyes at a plurality of angles.

[00122] The method further comprises modulating a phase delay of the plurality of optical fibers, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises coupling an optical element to the plurality of optical fibers, in one or more embodiments. The optical element is a waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The optical element is a freeform optic. The optical element is a DOE, in one or more embodiments. The optical element is a waveguide, in one or more embodiments.

[00123] In one or more embodiments, a virtual reality display system comprises a plurality of optical fibers to generate light beams associated with one or more images to be presented to a user, and a plurality of phase modulators coupled to the plurality of optical fibers to modulate the light beams, wherein the plurality of phase modulators modulate the light in a manner that affects a wavefront generated as a result of the plurality of light beams.

[00124] The one or more optical fibers are deflected, at one or more angles, in one or more embodiments. An optical fiber of the plurality of optical fibers is coupled to a GRIN lens, in one or more embodiments. The plurality of optical fibers is physically actuated to scan the optical fibers, in one or more embodiments.

[00125] In yet another aspect, a method comprises providing one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user, projecting, through a plurality of optical fibers, light associated with the one or more frames of image data, and modulating the light, through a plurality of phase modulators, projects by the plurality of optical fibers in a manner that affects an aggregate wavefront produced by the plurality of optical fibers.

[00126] The light projected by the one or more optical fibers is deflected at one or more angles, in one or more embodiments. The one or more optical fibers is coupled to a GRIN lens, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises scanning the optical light beams, wherein the plurality of optical fibers is physically actuated to scan the optical fibers, in one or more embodiments.

[00127] In another aspect, a system for displaying virtual content, comprises an array of optical fibers to transmit light beams associated with an image to be presented to a user, and a lens coupled to the array of the optical fibers to deflect a plurality of light beams output by the array of optical fibers through a single nodal point, wherein the lens is physically attached to the optical fibers such that a movement of the optical fiber causes the lens to move, and wherein the single nodal point is scanned.

[00128] The light beams output by the array of optical fibers represents a pixel of the image to be presented to the user, in one or more embodiments. The lens is a GRIN lens, in one or more embodiments. The array of optical fibers is used to display a lightfield, in one or more embodiments. Another set of light beams output by another array of optical fibers represents another pixel of the image to be presented to the user, in one or more embodiments. Multiple arrays of optical fibers are combined to represent a pixel of the image to be presented to the user, in one or more embodiments. The array of optical fibers is configured to deliver the light beams to a predetermined portion of the user's pupil, in one or more embodiments. The output light beams are diverging, in one or more embodiments. The output light beams are converging, in one or more embodiments.

[00129] A numerical aperture of the output light beams is increased relative to the light beams transmitted by the individual optical fibers, in one or more embodiments. The increased numerical aperture allows for higher resolution, in one or more embodiments. The array of optical fibers is beveled in a manner such that a path length of a first light beam traveling through a first optical fiber is different than a second light beam traveling through a second optical fiber, thereby allowing for a plurality of focal lengths of the light beams delivered to the user's eye, in one or more embodiments.

[00130] In another aspect, a system for displaying virtual content to a user comprises an array of microprojectors to project light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein one or more microprojectors of the array of microprojectors is polished at an angle such that the projected light is deflected, and wherein the polished angle causes path length differences between a first and second microprojectors of the array of microprojectors relative to an optical element, and a light scanner to receive the deflected light beams and to scan them in at least one axis.

[00131] In yet another aspect, a system to provide at least one of a virtual or an augment reality experience to a user comprises a frame, an array of micro-projectors carried by the frame and positionable in front of at least one eye of the user when the frame is worn by the user, and a local controller communicatively coupled to the array of micro-projectors to provide image information to the micro-projectors, the local controller comprising at least one processor, and at least one nontransitory processor readable media communicatively coupled to the at least one processor, the at least one nontransitory processor readable media which stores at last one of processor-executable instructions or data, which when executed by the at least one processor causes the at least one processor to at least one of process, cache, and store data and provide the image information to the micro-projectors to produce at least one of a virtual or an augment reality visual experience to the user.

[00132] The system further comprises at least one reflector supported by the frame and positioned and oriented to direct light from the micro-projectors toward at least one eye of the user when the frame is worn by the user, in one or more embodiments. The micro-projectors comprise respective ones of a plurality of scanning fiber displays, in one or more embodiments. Each of the scanning fiber displays has a respective collimating lens at a distal tip thereof, in one or more embodiments. The respective collimating lens is a gradient refractive index (GRIN) lens, in one or more embodiments.

[00133] The respective collimating lens is a curved lens, in one or more embodiments. The respective collimating lens is fused to the distal tip of the respective scanning fiber display, in one or more embodiments. The scanning fiber displays has a respective diffractive lens at a distal tip thereof, in one or more embodiments. Each of the scanning fiber displays has a respective diffuser at a distal tip thereof, in one or more embodiments.

[00134] The diffuser is etched into the respective distal tip, in one or more embodiments. Each of the scanning fiber displays has a respective lens at a distal tip thereof, the lens which extends from the distal tip by a sufficient distance as to freely vibrate in response to a stimulus, in one or more embodiments. Each of the scanning fiber displays has a respective reflector at a distal tip thereof, the reflector which extends from the distal tip by a sufficient distance as to freely vibrate in response to a stimulus, in one or more embodiments. The scanning fiber displays each includes a respective single mode optical fiber, in one or more embodiments.

[00135] The scanning fiber displays each include a respective mechanical transducer coupled to move at least a distal tip of the single mode optical fiber, in one or more embodiments. The respective mechanical transducers are each piezoelectric actuators, in one or more embodiments. Each the single mode optical fibers has a distal tip, the distal tips having a hemispherical lens shape, in one or more embodiments. Each the single mode optical fibers has a distal tip, the distal tips having a refractive lens affixed thereto, in one or more embodiments.

[00136] The system further comprises a transparent holder substrate which retains the plurality of single mode optical fibers together, in one or more embodiments. The transparent holder substrate has a refractive index that at least approximately matches a refractive index of a cladding of the single mode optical fibers, in one or more embodiments. The transparent holder substrate retains the plurality of single mode optical fibers each angled toward a common spot, in one or more embodiments.

[00137] The system further comprises at least one mechanical transducer coupled to move the plurality of single mode optical fibers in unison, in one or more embodiments. The at least one mechanical transducer vibrates the plurality of single mode optical fibers at a mechanical resonant frequency of the single mode optical fibers a portion of which are cantilevered out from the transparent holder substrate, in one or more embodiments. The micro-projectors comprise respective ones of a plurality of planar waveguides, a portion of each of the planar waveguides which extends cantilevered from a holder substrate, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises at least one mechanical transducer coupled to move the plurality of planar waveguides in unison, in one or more embodiments.

[00138] The at least one mechanical transducer vibrates the holder substrate at a mechanical resonant frequency of the planar waveguides, in one or more embodiments. The micro-projectors comprise respective ones of a plurality of piezoelectric actuators coupled to move respective ones of the planar waveguides with respect to the holder substrate, in one or more embodiments. The planar waveguides each define an totally internally reflective path along a respective length of the planar waveguide, and the planar waveguides comprise respective ones of a plurality of electronically switchable diffractive optical elements (DOEs) operable to propagate light outward of the respective totally internally reflective path, in one or more embodiments. The array of micro-projectors comprises an array of optical fibers, each having a distal tip and at least one bevel edge, in one or more embodiments. The at least one bevel edge is at the distal tip, and the distal tip is a polished distal tip, in one or more embodiments.

[00139] Each of the optical fibers has a reflective surface at the respective distal tip thereof, in one or more embodiments. The distal tip has an output edge at the distal tip at a defined critical angle to a longitudinal axis of the respective optical fiber, in one or more embodiments. The defined critical angle is an approximately forty-five (45) degree to the longitudinal axis of the respective optical fiber, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a focusing lens in an optical path of light exiting the distal ends of the optical fibers, to receive a plurality of beams of the light, the beams out of phase with one another, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises at least one transducer coupled to move at least one of the optical fibers in an X-Y Cartesian coordinate system, to move light emitted by the at least one optical fiber in an X-Z Cartesian coordinate system, in one or more embodiments. The at least one transducer is a first piezoelectric actuator that resonates a cantilevered portion of the optical fibers in a direction perpendicular to a direction at which the cantilevered portions extend, in one or more embodiments.

[00140] The optical fibers comprise a thin ribbon of optical fibers, in one or more embodiments. The at least one transducer is a second piezoelectric actuator that moves at least the cantilevered portion of the optical fibers in a direction longitudinal to the direction at which the cantilevered portions extend, in one or more embodiments. The microprojectors include at least one a single axis mirror operable to provide a slow scan along a longitudinal axis of at least one of the optical fibers, in one or more embodiments. The array of optical fibers comprises a multicore fiber, in one or more embodiments. The multicore fiber includes a plurality of approximately seven sparsely positioned clusters within a single conduit, each cluster comprising three optical fibers, each optical fiber to carry a respective one of three different colors of light, in one or more embodiments.

[00141] The multicore fiber includes a plurality of approximately nineteen sparsely positioned clusters within a single conduit, each cluster comprising three optical fibers, each optical fiber to carry a respective one of three different colors of light to produce a triad of overlapped spots of three different colors, in one or more embodiments. The multicore fiber includes at least one cluster within a single conduit, the cluster comprising at least three optical fibers, each, each of the optical fibers to carry at least two different colors of light, in one or more embodiments.

[00142] The multicore fiber includes at least one cluster within a single conduit, the at least one cluster comprising four optical fibers, each optical fiber to carry a respective one of four different colors of light, where one of the four colors is infrared or near-infrared, in one or more embodiments. The multicore fiber includes a plurality of cores in a tight bundle, and further comprises at least one transducer coupled to move the cores in a sparse spiral pattern, in one or more embodiments. The at least one bevel edge is spaced inwardly from the distal tip, in one or more embodiments. The at least one bevel edge is polished, in one or more embodiments.

[00143] The system further comprises at least one transducer coupled to move at least one of the optical fibers in an X-Y Cartesian coordinate system, to move light emitted by the at least one optical fiber in an X-Z Cartesian coordinate system, in one or more embodiments.

[00144] The system further comprises a focusing lens in an optical path of light exiting the bevel edges of the optical fibers, to receive a plurality of beams of the light, the beams out of phase with one another, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a laser, and at least one phase modulator that optically couples an output of the laser to a number of cores of the multicore fiber to achieve mutual coherence, in one or more embodiments.

[00145] The system further comprises a lenslet array optically coupled upstream of an input end of respective ones of a number of cores of the multicore fiber, and a prism array optically coupled between the plurality of collimation lenses and the input end of the cores of the multicore fiber to deflect light from the lenslet array to the cores of the multicore fiber, in one or more embodiments.

[00146] The system further comprises a lenslet array optically coupled upstream of an input end of respective ones of a number of cores of the multicore fiber, and a shared focusing lens optically coupled between the lenslet array and the input end of the cores of the multicore fiber to deflect light from the lenslet array to the cores of the multicore fiber, in one or more embodiments.

[00147] The array of micro-projectors further comprises at least one reflector, the at least one reflector operable to produce scan pattern and optically coupled to the array of optical fibers, in one or more embodiments. The at least one reflector is operable to produce at least one of a raster scan pattern, a Lissajous scan pattern, or a spiral scan pattern of a multifocal beam, in one or more embodiments. The each core of the multicore fiber addresses a respective part of an image plane without overlap, in one or more embodiments. The each core of the multicore fiber addresses a respective part of an image plane with substantial overlap, in one or more embodiments. [00148] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content, comprises an image-source to provide one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user, a fiber scanning display, the fiber scanning display comprising a plurality of fibers to project light associated with the one or more frames of image data, wherein the plurality of fibers are scanned using an actuator and a processor to control the fiber scanning display in a manner such that a light field is presented to the user.

[00149] The actuator is shared among all the fibers of the fiber scanning display, in one or more embodiments. The each fiber has its individual actuator, in one or more embodiments. The plurality of fibers are mechanically coupled by a lattice, such that the plurality of fibers move together, in one or more embodiments. The lattice is a graphene plane, in one or more embodiments. The lattice is a lightweight strut, in one or more embodiments.

[00150] In another embodiment, a system to provide at least one of a virtual or an augment reality experience to a user, comprises a frame, a display system carried by the frame and positionable in front of at least one eye of the user when the frame is worn by the user, and a local controller communicatively coupled to the display system to provide image information to the display system, the local controller comprising at least one processor, and at least one nontransitory processor readable media communicatively coupled to the at least one processor, the at least one nontransitory processor readable media which stores at last one of processor-executable instructions or data, which when executed by the at least one processor causes the at least one processor to at least one of process, cache, and store data and provide the image information to the display to produce at least one of a virtual or an augment reality visual experience to the user.

[00151] The display comprises at least one wedge-shaped waveguide, the wedge-shaped waveguide having at least two flat surfaces opposed from one another across a thickness of the first wedge-shaped waveguide and having a length along which light entering the wedge- shaped waveguide at defined angles via an entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide propagates via total internal reflection, the thickness of the wedge-shaped waveguide which varies linearly along the length of the wedge-shaped waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The wedge-shaped waveguide provides a bi-modal total internal reflection, in one or more embodiments.

[00152] The system further comprises at least two projectors optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide at respective different locations along the entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a first linear array of a plurality of projectors optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide at respective different locations along the entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide, in one or more embodiments. [00153] The projectors of the first linear array of a plurality of projectors are scanning fiber displays, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a stack of a plurality of spatial light modulators optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide along the entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a multicore optical fiber optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide at one or more locations along the entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide, in one or more embodiments.

[00154] The projectors of the first linear array of projectors are optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide to inject light into the wedge-shaped waveguide at a first angle, further comprising a second linear array of a plurality of projectors optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide at respective different locations along the entrance portion of the wedge-shaped waveguide, wherein the projectors of the second linear array of projectors are optically coupled to the wedge-shaped waveguide to inject light into the wedge-shaped waveguide at a second angle, the second angle different from the first angle, in one or more embodiments.

[00155] The entrance portion is longitude end of the wedged-shaped waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The entrance portion is a lateral edge of the wedged-shaped waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The entrance portion is a one of the flat surfaces of the wedged- shaped waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises at least one optical component optically coupled to a projector, and which changes an angle of light received from the projector to optically couple the light to the wedge-shaped waveguide at angles that achieve total internal reflection of the light within the wedge-shaped waveguide, in one or more embodiments.

[00156] In another aspect, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises an array of microprojectors to project light beams associated with one or more frames of image data to be presented to the user, wherein the microprojector is configurable to be movable relative to one or more microprojectors of the array of the microprojectors, a frame to house the array of microprojectors, a processor operatively coupled to the one or more microprojectors of the array of microprojectors to control one or more light beams transmitted from the one or more projectors in a manner such that the one or more light beams are modulated as a function of a position of the one or more microprojectors relative to the array of microprojectors, thereby enabling delivery of a lightfield image to the user.

[00157] The microprojector of the array of microprojectors is coupled to a lens, in one or more embodiments. The array of microprojectors is arranged in a manner based on a desired resolution of the image to be presented to the user, in one or more embodiments. The array of microprojectors is arranged based on a desired field of view, in one or more embodiments. The light beams of a plurality of microprojectors overlap, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises an actuator, wherein the actuator is coupled to one or more microprojectors, and wherein the actuator is configurable to move the one or more microprojectors, in one or more embodiments.

[00158] The actuator is coupled to a plurality of microprojectors, in one or more embodiments. The actuator is coupled to a single microprojector, in one or more embodiments. The microprojector of the array of micropojectors is mechanically coupled to a lattice, in one or more embodiments.

[00159] In yet another embodiment, a contact lens to interface with a cornea of an eye of a user of a virtual or augmented reality display comprises a partially hemispherical substrate and a selective filter. The selective filter is configured to selectively pass light beams to a user's eye, in one or more embodiments. The selective filter is a notch filter, in one or more embodiments. The notch filter substantially blocks wavelengths at approximately 450nm (peak blue) and substantially passes other wavelengths in a visible portion of the electromagnetic spectrum, in one or more embodiments. The notch filter substantially blocks wavelengths at approximately 530nm (green) and substantially passes other wavelengths in a visible portion of the electromagnetic spectrum, in one or more embodiments. The notch filter substantially blocks wavelengths at approximately 650nm and substantially passes other wavelengths in a visible portion of the electromagnetic spectrum, in one or more embodiments.

[00160] The notch filter comprises a plurality of layers of dielectric materials carried by the substrate, in one or more embodiments. The filter has a pinhole opening of less than 1.5mm diameter, in one or more embodiments. The pinhole opening allows light beams of a plurality of wavelengths to pass through, in one or more embodiments. A size of the pinhole is varied based at least in part on a desired depth of focus of the display, in one or more embodiments. The contact lens further comprises a plurality of modes of operation, in one or more embodiments. The contact lens further comprises a multi-depth of focus display configuration of the virtual content, in one or more embodiments.

[00161] The contact lens further comprises an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of the user's eye, in one or more embodiments. A depth of focus of a particular display object is varied based at least in part on the determined accommodation, in one or more embodiments. The image is relayed through a waveguide, the relayed image associated with a particular depth of focus, in one or more embodiments.

[00162] In another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises providing one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user, projecting light associated with the one or more frames of image data, and receiving, through a partially hemispherical substrate coupled to the user's pupil, the projected light and selectively filtering out the light beams to the user's pupil.

[00163] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a light projection system to project light associated with one or more frames of image data to a user's eyes, the light project system configured to project light corresponding to a plurality of pixels associated with the image data, and a processor to modulate a depth of focus of the plurality of pixels displayed to the user.

[00164] The depth of focus is modulated spatially, in one or more embodiments. The depth of focus is modulated over time, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises an image-generating source to provide the one or more frames of image data in a time- sequential manner, in one or more embodiments. The depth of focus is modulated on a frame- to-frame basis, in one or more embodiments. The light projection system comprises a plurality of optical fibers, and wherein the depth of focus is modulated across the plurality of optical fibers such that a portion of the optical fibers is associated with a first depth of focus, and another portion of the optical fibers is associated with a second depth of focus, wherein the first depth of focus is different from the second depth of focus , in one or more embodiments.

[00165] A first display object of a particular frame is displayed through a first depth of focus, and a second display object of the particular frame is displayed through a second depth of focus, wherein the first depth of focus is different from the second depth of focus, in one or more embodiments. A first pixel of a particular frame is associated with a first depth of focus, and a second pixel of the particular frame is associated with a second depth of focus, wherein the first depth of focus is different from the second depth of focus, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises an accommodation tracking module to determine an accommodation of the user's eyes, wherein the depth of focus is modulated based at least in part on the determined accommodation, in one or more embodiments.

[00166] A pattern of light generation associated with the light generation system is dynamically slaved to the determined accommodation, in one or more embodiments. The pattern is scanning pattern of a plurality of optical fibers, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a blurring module to blur one or more portions of the image data, wherein the blurring is created to smooth a transition between a first scan pattern and a second scan pattern or a first resolution scan pitch to a second resolution scan pitch, in one or more embodiments.

[00167] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a light projection system to project light associated with one or more frames of image data to a user's eyes, the light project system configured to project light corresponding to a plurality of pixels associated with the image data, a processor to modulate a size of the plurality of pixels displayed to the user.

[00168] The light projection system is a fiber scanning display, in one or more embodiments. The projected light is displayed through a scanning pattern, in one or more embodiments. The processor modulates the size of a particular pixel based at least in part on a type of scanning pattern, in one or more embodiments. The size of the one or more pixels may be modulated based at least in part on a distance between scan lines of the scanning pattern, in one or more embodiments. The size of a first pixel is different from the size of a second pixel in the same frame, in one or more embodiments.

[00169] In another aspect, a method for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein one or more light beams of the projected light correspond to one or more pixels, wherein light is projected through a fiber scanning display, and modulating a size of the one or more pixels displayed to the user, in one or more embodiments.

[00170] The size of a particular pixel is varied based at least in part on a scanning pattern of the fiber scanning display, in one or more embodiments. The size of the one or more pixels is modulated based at least in part on a distance between scan lines of the scanning pattern, in one or more embodiments. The size of the one or more pixels is variable, in one or more embodiments.

[00171] In yet another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a display system that delivers light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the display system comprises a plurality of pixels, wherein the display system scans light having variable line pitch, a blurring module to variably blur one or more pixels of the plurality of pixels to modify a size of the one or more pixels, and a processor to control the blurring module in a manner such pixel size is varied based at least in part on the line pitch of the display system, in one or more embodiments. The display system is a fiber scanning system, in one or more embodiments. The pixel size is enlarged, in one or more embodiments. The pixel size is reduced, in one or more embodiments. The pitch line is sparse, in one or more embodiments. The pitch line is dense, in one or more embodiments.

[00172] In another aspect, a method of displaying virtual content to a user, the method comprises projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data to be presented to the user, selectively attenuating at least a portion of the projected light beams based at least in part on a characteristic of the image data, and delivering the attenuated light beams to the user's eyes.

[00173] The light beam is selectively attenuated based at least in part on angle of incidence of the light beam, in one or more embodiments. Different portions of the frame are attenuated to different amounts, in one or more embodiments. A depth of focus of the attenuated light beams is varied, in one or more embodiments.

[00174] In one or more embodiments, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data, a stack of two or more spatial light modulators (SLMs) positioned such that the stack delivers light associated with the one or more frames of image data to the user, wherein the SLM spatially attenuates light from an outside environment, and a processor to control the stack of SLMs in a manner such that an angle at which light beams pass through one or more cells of the SLM is modulated.

[00175] The system further comprises a set of display optics, wherein the set of display optics is positioned between the user's eye and the outside environment, in one or more embodiments. The SLMs of the stack of SLMs are cholesteric LCDs. The at least one of the SLMs is a cholesteric LCD, in one or more embodiments. The stack of SLMs is positioned such that the user views an outside world through the stack of SLMs, wherein the SLMs is at least semi-transparent, in one or more embodiments.

[00176] The spatial light modulator arrays comprise at least one of a number or liquid crystal arrays, a number of digital mirror device elements of digital light processing systems, a number of micro-electro-mechanical system (MEMS) arrays, or a number of MEMS shutters, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises an occluder comprising at least one optical component, and wherein the processor controls the at least one optical component of the occluder to produce a darkfield representation of a dark virtual object. , in one or more embodiments

[00177] In another aspect, a system for displaying virtual content, the system comprises an array of spatial light modulators, the array of spatial light modulators configured to generate light patterns, and wherein the array of spatial light modulators comprises at least two modulators, and a processor to control the array of spatial modulators in a manner such that the at least two spatial modulators form a Moire pattern, wherein the Moire pattern is a periodic spatial pattern attenuates light at a different period than a period of the light patterns forms on the at least two spatial light modulators.

[00178] The spatial light modulator arrays comprise at least two spatial light modulator arrays optically coupled to one another, and which are control passage of light via moire effects, in one or more embodiments. The at least two spatial light modulator arrays each bear a respective attenuation pattern, in one or more embodiments. The at least two spatial light modulator arrays each bear a respective fine-pitch sine wave pattern printed, etched, or other inscribed thereon or therein, in one or more embodiments. The at least two spatial light modulator arrays are in registration with one another, in one or more embodiments. The at least two spatial light modulator arrays each bear a respective attenuation pattern, in one or more embodiments.

[00179] In yet another embodiment, a system for display virtual content to a user, comprises a light generating source to provide light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light generating source is a spatial light modulator, a pinhole array positioned in a manner relative to the spatial light modulator such that a pinhole of the pinhole array receives light from a plurality of cells of the spatial light modulator, and wherein a first light beam passing through the pinhole corresponds to a different angle than a second light beam passing through the pinhole, and wherein the cell of spatial light modulator selectively attenuate light.

[00180] An outside environment is viewed through the pinhole array and the SLMs, and wherein light beams are selectively attenuated based at least in part on the angle of incidence of the light beams, in one or more embodiments. The light from different portions of a visual field is selectively attenuated, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a selective attenuation layer selectively operable to attenuation transmission of light therethrough, the selective attenuation layer optically in series with the pinhole layer, in one or more embodiments.

[00181] The selective attenuation layer comprises a liquid crystal array, digital light projector system, or spatial light modulator arrays which bear respective attenuation patterns, in one or more embodiments. The pinhole array placed at a distance of approximately 30mm from a cornea of an eye of the user, and the selective attenuation panel is located opposite the pinhole array from the eye, in one or more embodiments. The pinhole array comprises a plurality of pinholes, and wherein the process controls the SLMs in a manner such light is attenuated as a function of the angles at which light beams pass through the plurality of pinholes, thereby producing an aggregate light field, in one or more embodiments. The aggregate light field causes occlusion at a desired focal distance, in one or more embodiments.

[00182] In another embodiment, a system comprises a light generating source to provide light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light generating source is a spatial light modulator, a lens array positioned in a manner relative to the spatial light modulator such that a lens of the lens array receives light from a plurality of cells of the spatial light modulator, and wherein a first light beam received at the lens corresponds to a different angle than a second light beam received at the lens, and wherein the cells of spatial light modulator selectively attenuate light, in one or more embodiments.

[00183] The outside environment is viewed through the lens array and the SLMs, and wherein light beams are selectively attenuated based at least in part on the angle of incidence of the light beams, in one or more embodiments. The light from different portions of a visual field is selectively attenuated, in one or more embodiments. The lens array comprises a plurality of lenses, and wherein the process controls the SLMs in a manner such light is attenuated as a function of the angles at which light beams are received at the plurality of lenses, thereby producing an aggregate light field, in one or more embodiments. The aggregate light field causes occlusion at a desired focal distance, in one or more embodiments.

[00184] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a light projector to project light associated with one or more frames of an image data, at least one polarization sensitive layer to receive the light and rotate a polarization of the light, and an array of polarization modulators to modulate the polarization of the polarization sensitive layer, and wherein a state of the cell in the array determines how much light passes through the polarization sensitive layer. The system is placed in a near-to-eye configuration, in one or more embodiments. The polarization modulator is a liquid crystal array, in one or more embodiments.

[00185] The system further comprises a parallax barrier to offset the polarizer such that different exit pupils have different paths through the polarizer, in one or more embodiments. The polarizer is an xpol polarizer, in one or more embodiments. The polarizer is a multiPol polarizer, in one or more embodiments. The polarizer is a patterned polarizer, in one or more embodiments. The light interacts with one or more MEMs arrays, in one or more embodiments.

[00186] The system further comprises SLMs to project light, wherein the SLMs are positioned between one or more optical elements, wherein the optical elements correspond to a zero magnification telescope, in one or more embodiments. The user views an outside environment through the zero-magnification telescope, in one or more embodiments. The at least one SLM is positioned at an image plane within the zero-magnification telescope, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a DMD, wherein the DMD corresponds to a transparent substrate, in one or more embodiments.

[00187] The system further comprises an occluder comprising at least one optical component, and wherein the processor controls the at least one optical component of the occluder to produce a darkfield representation of a dark virtual object, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises one or more LCDs, wherein the one or more LCDs selectively attenuate light beams, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises one or more LCDs, wherein the one or more LCDs serve as polarization rotators, in one or more embodiments. The occluder is a louver MEMs device, in one or more embodiments. [00188] The louver MEMs device is opaque, and wherein the louver MEMs device changes an angle of incidence on a pixel-by-pixel basis, in one or more embodiments. The occluder is a sliding panel MEMs device, wherein the sliding panel MEMs device slides back and forth to modify a region of occlusion, in one or more embodiments.

[00189] In another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content comprises projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data, rotating a polarization of light through a polarization sensitive layer at a substrate which receives the projected light, and modulating a polarization of light to selectively attenuate light passing through the polarization layer.

[00190] The polarization modulator is a liquid crystal array, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises creating a parallax barrier to offset the polarizer such that different exit pupils have different paths through the polarizer, in one or more embodiments. The polarizer is an xpol polarizer, in one or more embodiments. The polarizer is a multiPol polarizer, in one or more embodiments. The polarizer is a patterned polarizer, in one or more embodiments.

[00191] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content, comprises a light generating source to provide light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light generating source is a spatial light modulator, an array of micro-electro-mechanical (MEMs) louvers, wherein the MEMs louvers are housed in a substantially transparent substrate, and wherein the MEMs louvers are configurable to change an angle at which light is delivered to a pixel, and wherein the angle of a first pixel delivered to the user is different from a second pixel delivered to the user.

[00192] The at least one optical component comprises a first array of micro-electromechanical system (MEMS) louvers, in one or more embodiments. The array of MEMS louvers comprises a plurality of substantially opaque louvers carried by an optically transparent substrate, in one or more embodiments. The array of micro-electro-mechanical system (MEMS) louvers has a louver pitch sufficiently fine to selectably occlude light on a pixel-by- pixel basis, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises at least one optical component of the occluder comprises a second array of MEMS louvers, the second array of MEMS louvers in a stack configuration with the first array of MEMS louvers, in one or more embodiments.

[00193] The array of MEMS louvers comprises a plurality of polarizing louvers carried by an optically transparent substrate, a respective polarization state of each of the louvers selectively controllable, in one or more embodiments. The louvers of the first and the second arrays of MEMS panels are polarizers, in one or more embodiments. The at least one optical component of the occluder comprises a first array of micro-electro-mechanical system (MEMS) panels mounted for movement in a frame, in one or more embodiments.

[00194] The panels of the first array of MEMS panels are slidably mounted for movement in the frame, in one or more embodiments. The panels of the first array of MEMS panels are pivotably mounted for movement in the frame, in one or more embodiments. The panels of the first array of MEMS panels are both translationally and pivotably mounted for movement in the frame, in one or more embodiments. The panels of moveably to produce a moire pattern, in one or more embodiments. The at least one optical component of the occluder further comprises a second array of MEMS panels mounted for movement in a frame, the second array in a stack configuration with the first array, in one or more embodiments. The panels of the first and the second arrays of MEMS panels are polarizers. The at least one optical component of the occluder comprises a reflector array, in one or more embodiments.

[00195] In another embodiment, a system comprises at least one waveguide to receive light from an outside environment and direct the light to one or more spatial light modulators, wherein the one or more spatial light modulators selectively attenuate the received light in different portions of a visual field of the user. The at least one waveguide comprises a first and second waveguides, and wherein the second waveguide is configured to deliver light exiting the SLMs to the user's eye, in one or more embodiments.

[00196] In another embodiment, a method comprises receiving light from an outside environment, directing the light to a selective attenuator, and selectively attenuating, through the selective attenuator, the received light in different portions of a visual field of the user.

[00197] The at least one waveguide comprises a first and second waveguides, and wherein the second waveguide is configured to deliver light exiting the SLMs to the user's eye, in one or more embodiments. The selective attenuator is a spatial light modulator, in one or more embodiments. The spatial light modulator is a DMD array, in one or more embodiments. The light is directed to the one or more spatial light modulators through one or more waveguides, in one or more embodiments. The method further comprises recoupling light back to the waveguide, causing light to partially exit toward the user's eye, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide is oriented substantially perpendicular to the selective attenuator, in one or more embodiments.

[00198] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a light generating source to provide light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light generating source comprises a plurality of microprojectors, and a waveguide configured to receive light from the plurality of microprojectors and transmit light to a user's eye. [00199] The microprojectors are placed in a linear array, in one or more embodiments. The microprojectors are placed in one edge of the waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The microprojectors are placed in multiple edges of the waveguide. The microprojectors are placed in a two dimensional array, in one or more embodiments. The microprojectors are placed in a three-dimensional array, in one or more embodiments. The microprojectors are placed at multiple edges of the substrate, in one or more embodiments. The microprojectors are placed at multiple angles, in one or more embodiments.

[00200] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content, comprises an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data, wherein the image data comprises one or more virtual objects to be presented to a user, and a rendering engine to render the one or more virtual objects in a manner such that a halo is perceived by the user around the one or more virtual objects.

[00201] The system further comprises a light attenuator, wherein the light attenuator balances a light intensity of the halo across the visual field of the user, in one or more embodiments.

[00202] In another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content, comprises providing one or more frames of image data, wherein the image data comprises one or more virtual objects to be presented to a user, and rendering the one or more virtual objects in a manner such that a halo is perceived by the user around the one or more virtual objects, thereby making it easier for the user to view the virtual object, wherein the virtual object is a dark virtual object.

[00203] The method further comprises selectively attenuating light receiving from an outside environment, through a light attenuator, wherein the light attenuator balances a light intensity of the halo across a visual field of the user, in one or more embodiments.

[00204] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content, comprises a camera system to capture a view of a real environment, an optical see-through system that displays one or more virtual objects superimposed over the view of the real environment, wherein the captured view is used to render the one or more virtual objects presented to the user, and a light intensity module to modulate a light intensity of the view of the real environment, based at least on a correlation between one or more real objects, and the one or more virtual objects, such that a dark virtual object is visible in contrast with the one or more real objects, in one or more embodiments.

[00205] The captured view is used to generate a halo around one or more virtual objects, wherein the halo fades across space, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises a light attenuator, wherein the light attenuator balances a light intensity of the halo across the visual field of the user, in one or more embodiments. [00206] In yet another embodiment, a method of driving an augmented reality display system, the method comprises rendering a first virtual object at a location on a field of view of a user, and rendering a visual emphasis at least spatially proximate the rendered first virtual object in the field of view of the user substantially concurrently with the rendering of the first virtual object.

[00207] The rendering a visual emphasis includes rendering the visual emphasis with an intensity gradient, in one or more embodiments. The rendering a visual emphasis includes rendering the visual emphasis with blurring proximate a perimeter of the visual emphasis, in one or more embodiments.

[00208] The rendering a visual emphasis at least spatially proximate the rendered first virtual object includes rendering a halo visual effect spatially proximate the rendered first virtual object, in one or more embodiments. The rendering a halo visual effect spatially proximate the rendered first virtual object includes rendering the halo visual effect to be brighter than the rendered first virtual object, in one or more embodiments.

[00209] The rendering the halo visual effect to be brighter than the rendered first virtual object is in response to a determination that the rendered first virtual object is darker than a threshold value of darkness, in one or more embodiments. The rendering a halo visual effect includes rendering the halo visual effect in a separate focal plane from the rendered first virtual object in a perceived three-dimensional space, in one or more embodiments. The rendering a halo visual effect includes rendering the halo visual effect with an intensity gradient, in one or more embodiments. The rendering a halo visual effect includes rendering the halo visual effect with an intensity gradient that matches a dark halo resulting from occlusion applied to the rendering of the first virtual object to compensate for a darkfield effect of the occlusion, in one or more embodiments.

[00210] The rendering a halo visual effect includes rendering the halo visual effect with blurring proximate a perimeter of the halo visual effect, in one or more embodiments. The rendered first visual object has a non-circular perimeter and the rendered halo visual effect conforms to the non-circular perimeter, in one or more embodiments. The rendering a visual emphasis at least spatially proximate the rendered first virtual object includes rendering the visual effect in a separate focal plane from the rendered first virtual object in a perceived three- dimensional space, in one or more embodiments. The rendering the visual effect in a separate focal plane from the rendered first virtual object in a perceived three-dimensional space includes rendering the visual effect in a focal plane spaced relative away from the user with respect to a focal plane in which the rendered first virtual object is rendered, in one or more embodiments. [00211] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content, comprises an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user, wherein the one or more frames of image data comprises at least one black virtual object, and a rendering image to render the one or more frames of image data, and wherein the rendering engine renders the black virtual object as a blue virtual object, such that the black virtual object is visible to the user.

[00212] The rendering a first virtual object at a location on a field of view of a user includes, first changing any black intonations of the first virtual object to a dark blue color, in one or more embodiments.

[00213] In yet another embodiment, a system for transmitting light beams for display of virtual content, comprises at least one waveguide, the at least one waveguide having a first end, a second end spaced from the first end across a length of the at least one waveguide, the length along which light entering the respective waveguide at defined angles propagates via total internal reflection, at least one edge reflector positioned at least proximate a first end of the at least one waveguide to optically reflectively couple light back to the first end of the at least one waveguide, and at least one edge reflector positioned at least proximate a second end of the at least one waveguide to optically reflectively couple light back to the second end of the at least one waveguide.

[00214] The at least one waveguide has a number of transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces internal to the waveguide that redirect at least a portion of the light transversely outward of the waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces are low diffraction efficiency diffractive optical elements (DOEs) , in one or more embodiments. The at least one edge reflector positioned at least proximate a first end of the at least one waveguide comprises a plurality of reflectors positioned at least proximate the first end of the at least one waveguide, in one or more embodiments.

[00215] The at least one edge reflector positioned at least proximate a second end of the at least one waveguide comprises a plurality of reflectors positioned at least proximate the second end of the at least one waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The at least one waveguide is a single waveguide, in one or more embodiments.

[00216] In yet another embodiment, a system for transmitting light beams for display of virtual content, comprises a waveguide assembly comprising a plurality of planar waveguides, each of the planar waveguides respectively having at least two flat parallel major faces opposed from one another across a thickness of the planar waveguide, a first end, and a second opposed to the first end across a length of the waveguide, the length along which light entering the respective waveguide at defined angles propagates via total internal reflection, and two flat major edges opposed to one another across a width of the waveguide, the plurality of planar waveguides in a stacked configuration along a first axis that is parallel with a direction of the thicknesses of planar waveguides and along a second axis that is parallel with the widths of the planar waveguides to form a three-dimensional array of planar waveguides.

[00217] There are at least three planar waveguides stacked in the direction of the first axis, in one or more embodiments. There are at least three planar waveguides stacked in the direction of the second axis, in one or more embodiments. There are at least three planar waveguides stacked in the direction of the second axis, in one or more embodiments. The successive planar waveguides in the stack along the first axis are immediately adjacent one another, and successive planar waveguides in the stack along the second axis are immediately adjacent one another, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide assembly further comprises a plurality of reflective layers carried on at least one surface of at least one of the planar waveguides, in one or more embodiments.

[00218] The reflective layers include a completely reflective metalized coating. The reflective layers include a wavelength specific reflector, in one or more embodiments. The reflective layers separate the planar waveguides in each successive pair of the planar waveguides along at least one of the first or the second axes, in one or more embodiments. The reflective layers separate the planar waveguides in each successive pair of the planar waveguides along both the first and the second axes, in one or more embodiments.

[00219] Each of a number of the planar waveguides respectively includes a number of transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces that redirect at least a portion of the light received by the respective planar waveguide transversely outward of the planar waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces comprise diffractive optical elements sandwiched in the respective planar waveguides between the major faces of the respective planar waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The diffractive optical elements are selectively operable to vary a focal distance, in one or more embodiments.

[00220] The first axis is a curved axis, and at least one of the major edges of each of the planar waveguides in at least one set in the waveguide assembly is oriented to focus on a single line, the single line parallel to the lengths of the planar waveguides, in one or more embodiments.

[00221] In one or more embodiments, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, the system comprises a light projector to project light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the light projector is a fiber scanning display, a waveguide assembly to variably deflect light to a user's eye, wherein the waveguide is curved concavely toward the eye, in one or more embodiments. [00222] The curved waveguide expands a field of view, in one or more embodiments. The curved waveguide efficiently directs light to the user's eye, in one or more embodiments. The curved waveguide comprises a time-varying grating, thereby creating an axis for scanning the light for the fiber scanning display, in one or more embodiments.

[00223] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a transmissive beam splitter substrate having an entrance to receive light and a number of internal reflective or diffractive surfaces angled with respect to the entrance to redirect at least a portion of the light received at the entrance transversely outward of the transmissive beam splitter substrate toward an eye of the user, wherein the number of internal reflective or diffractive surfaces includes a plurality of transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces spaced along a longitudinal axis of the transmissive beam splitter substrate, each of the transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces angled or angleable with respect to the entrance to redirect at least a portion of the light received at the entrance transversely outward of the transmissive beam splitter substrate along an optical path toward an eye of the user, a light generating system to transmit light to the transmissive beam splitter, and a local controller communicatively coupled to the display system to provide image information to the display system, the local controller comprising at least one processor, and at least one nontransitory processor readable media communicatively coupled to the at least one processor, the at least one nontransitory processor readable media which stores at last one of processor-executable instructions or data, which when executed by the at least one processor causes the at least one processor to at least one of process, cache, and store data and provide the image information to the display to produce at least one of a virtual or an augment reality visual experience to the user, in one or more embodiments.

[00224] The transverse reflective and/or diffractive surfaces comprise at least one diffractive optical element (DOE), where a collimated beam that enters the beam splitter at a number of defined angles is totally internally reflected along the length of thereof, and intersects the DOE at one or more locations, in one or more embodiments. The at least one diffractive optical element (DOE) comprises a first grating, in one or more embodiments. The first grating is a first Bragg grating, in one or more embodiments.

[00225] The DOE comprises a second grating, the first grating on a first plane and the second grating on a second plane, the second plane spaced from the first plane such that the first and the second gratings interact to produce a moire beat pattern, in one or more embodiments. The first grating has a first pitch and the second grating has a second pitch, the first pitch the same as the second pitch, in one or more embodiments. The first grating has a first pitch and the second grating has a second pitch, the first pitch the different from the second pitch, in one or more embodiments. The first grating pitch is controllable to change the first grating pitch over time, in one or more embodiments. The first grating comprises an elastic material and is subject to mechanical deformation , in one or more embodiments.

[00226] The first grating is carried by an elastic material which is subject to mechanical deformation, in one or more embodiments. The first grating pitch is controllable to change the first grating pitch over time, in one or more embodiments. The second grating pitch is controllable to change the second grating pitch over time, in one or more embodiments. The first grating is an electro-active grating, having at least one ON state and an OFF state, in one or more embodiments. The first grating comprises a polymer dispersed liquid crystal, a plurality of liquid crystal droplets of the polymer dispersed liquid crystal controllably activated to change a refractive index of the first grating, in one or more embodiments.

[00227] The first grating is a time-varying grating wherein the first grating is a time-varying grating, and the local controller controls at least the first grating to expand a field of view of the display, in one or more embodiments. The first grating is a time-varying grating, and the local controller employs time-varying control of at least the first grating to correction for a chromatic aberration, in one or more embodiments. The local controller drives at least the first grating to vary a placement of a red sub-pixel of a pixel of an image with respect to at least one of a blue or a green sub-pixel of corresponding pixel of the image, in one or more embodiments. The local controller drives at least the first grating to laterally shift an exit pattern to fill a gap in an outbound image pattern, in one or more embodiments.

[00228] The at least one DOE element has a first circularly-symmetric term, in one or more embodiments. The at least one DOE element has a first linear term, the first linear term summed with the first circularly-symmetric term, in one or more embodiments. The circularly- symmetric term is controllable, in one or more embodiments. The at least one DOE element has a second first circularly-symmetric term, in one or more embodiments. The at least one diffractive optical (DOE) element comprises a first DOE, in one or more embodiments. The first DOE is a circular DOE, in one or more embodiments.

[00229] The circular DOE is a time-varying DOE, in one or more embodiments. The circular DOE is layered in relation to a waveguide for focus modulation, in one or more embodiments. A diffraction pattern of the circular DOE is static, in one or more embodiments. A diffraction pattern of the circular DOE is dynamic, in one or more embodiments. The system comprises additional circular DOEs, wherein the additional circular DOEs are positioned in relation to the circular DOE, such that many focus levels are achieved through a small number of switchable DOEs, in one or more embodiments.

[00230] The system further comprises a matrix of switchable DOE elements, in one or more embodiments. The matrix is utilized to expand a field of view, in one or more embodiments. The matrix is utilized to expand a size of an exit pupil, in one or more embodiments.

[00231] In one or more embodiments, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a light projecting system to project light beams associated with one or more frames of image data, a diffractive optical element (DOE) to receive the projected light beams and deliver the light beams at a desired focus, wherein the DOE is a circular DOE, in one or more embodiments.

[00232] The DOE is stretchable along a single axis to adjust an angle of a linear DOE term, in one or more embodiments. The DOE comprises a membrane, and at least one transducer operable to selectively vibrate the membrane with an oscillatory motion in a Z-axis to provide Z-axis control and change of focus over time, in one or more embodiments. The DOE is embedded in a stretchable medium, such that a pitch of the DOE can be adjusted by physically stretching the medium, in one or more embodiments. The DOE is stretched biaxially, and wherein the stretching of the DOE affects a focal length of the DOE, in one or more embodiments. The system of claim 762, further comprising a plurality of circular DOEs, wherein the DOEs are stacked along a Z axis, in one or more embodiments. A circular DOE is layered in front of an waveguide for focus modulation. The system of claim 768, wherein the DOE is static, in one or more embodiments.

[00233] In one or more embodiments, a system for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises a light projecting system to project light beams associated with one or more frames of image data, a first waveguide without any diffractive optical elements (DOEs), the first waveguide which propagates light received by the first waveguide at a number of defined angles along at least a portion of a length of the first waveguide via total internal reflection and which provides the light externally from the first waveguide as collimated light, a second waveguide with at least a first circularly-symmetric diffractive optical element (DOE), the second waveguide optically coupled to receive the collimated light from the first waveguide, and a processor to control the gratings of the DOE, in one or more embodiments.

[00234] The first DOE is selectively controllable, in one or more embodiments. The display comprises a plurality of additional DOEs in addition to the first DOE, the DOEs arranged in a stack configuration, in one or more embodiments. Each of the DOEs of the plurality of additional DOEs is selectively controllable, in one or more embodiments. The local controller controls the first DOE and the plurality of additional DOEs to dynamically modulate a focus of light passing through the display, in one or more embodiments. The processor selectively respectively switches the first DOE and the plurality of additional DOEs to realize a number of focus levels, the number of realizable focus levels greater than a total number of the DOEs in the stack, in one or more embodiments. [00235] Each of the DOEs in the stack has a respective optical power, the optical power of the DOEs in the static controllable additive to one another, in one or more embodiments. The respective optical power of at least one of the DOEs in the stack is twice the respective optical power of at least one other of the DOEs in the stack, in one or more embodiments. The processor selectively respectively switches the first DOE and the plurality of additional DOEs to modulate respective linear and radial terms of the DOEs over time, in one or more embodiments. The processor selectively respectively switches the first DOE and the plurality of additional DOEs on a frame sequential basis, in one or more embodiments.

[00236] The stack of DOEs comprises a stack of polymer dispersed liquid crystal elements. In absence of an applied voltage, a host medium refraction index matches that of a set of dispersed molecules of the polymer dispersed liquid crystal elements, in one or more embodiments. The polymer dispersed liquid crystal elements comprise molecules of lithium niobate, and a number of transparent indium tin oxide layer electrode on either side of a host medium, wherein the dispersed molecules of lithium niobate controllably change index of refraction and functionally form a diffraction pattern within the host medium, in one or more embodiments.

[00237] In another embodiment, a method for displaying virtual content, comprises projecting light associated with one or more frames of image data to a user, receiving light at a first waveguide, the first waveguide without any diffractive optical elements, and propagating the light through internal reflection, receiving collimated light at a second waveguide with at least a first circularly-symmetric diffractive optical element (DOE), the second waveguide optically coupled to receive the collimated light from the first waveguide, wherein a grating of the circularly symmetric DOE is varied, and wherein the first waveguide and second waveguide are assembled in a stack of DOEs, in one or more embodiments.

[00238] In one or more embodiments, an optical element for displaying virtual content to a user, comprises at least one diffractive optical element (DOE) positioned to receive light, the at least one DOE comprising a first array of a plurality of separately addressable sections, with at least one electrode for each of the separately addressable subsection, each of the separately addressable subsections responsive to at least one respective single received via the respective at least one electrode to selectively switch between at least a first state and a section state, the second state different from the first state, in one or more embodiments.

[00239] A field of view is expanded by multiplexing adjacently addressable subsections, in one or more embodiments. The first state is an ON state and the second state is an OFF state, in one or more embodiments. The each of the separately addressable subsections has a respective set of at least two indium tin oxide electrodes, in one or more embodiments. The first array of a plurality of separately addressable sections of the at least one DOE is a one- dimensional array, in one or more embodiments. The first array of a plurality of separately addressable sections of the at least one DOE is a two-dimensional array, in one or more embodiments. The first array of separately addressable sections are sections of a first DOE that resides on a first planar layer, in one or more embodiments.

[00240] The at least one DOE comprises at least second DOE, the second DOE comprising a second array of a plurality of separately addressable sections, with at least one electrode for each of the separately addressable subsection, each of the separately addressable subsections responsive to at least one respective single received via the respective at least one electrode to selectively switch between at least a first state and a section state, the second state different from the first state, the second array of DOEs residing on a second planar layer, the second planar layer in a stacked configuration with the first planar layer, in one or more embodiments.

[00241] The at least one DOE comprises at least third DOE, the third DOE comprising a third array of a plurality of separately addressable sections, with at least one electrode for each of the separately addressable subsection, each of the separately addressable subsections responsive to at least one respective single received via the respective at least one electrode to selectively switch between at least a first state and a section state, the second state different from the first state, the third array of DOEs residing on a third planar layer, the third planar layer in a stacked configuration with the first and the second planar layers, in one or more embodiments.

[00242] The first array of separately addressable sections are embedded in a single planar waveguide, in one or more embodiments. The local controller controls the separately addressable subsections to selectively emit collimated light from the planar waveguide at a first time and to emit a diverging light from the planar waveguide at a second time, the second time different from the first time, in one or more embodiments. The local control controls the separately addressable subsections to selectively emit light in a first direction from the planar waveguide at a first time and to emit light in a second direction from the planar waveguide at the first time, the second direction different from the first direction, in one or more embodiments.

[00243] The local control controls the separately addressable subsections to selectively scan light across a direction over time, in one or more embodiments. The local control controls the separately addressable subsections to selectively focus light over time, in one or more embodiments. The local control controls the separately addressable subsections to selectively vary a field of view of an exit pupil over time, in one or more embodiments.

[00244] In one or more embodiments, a system comprises a first freeform reflective and lens optical component to increase a size of a field-of-view for a defined set of optical parameters, the first freeform reflective and lens optical component comprising: a first curved surface, a second curved surface, and a third curved surface, the first curved surface at least partially optically transmissive and refractive and which imparts a focal change to the light received by the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first curved surface, the second curved surface which at least partially reflects light received by the second curved surface from the first curved surface toward the third curved surface and which passes light received by the second curved surface from the third curved surface, the third curved surface which at least partially reflects light out of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the second curved surface, in one or more embodiments.

[00245] The first curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component is a respective freeform curved surface, in one or more embodiments. The first curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component adds a stigmatism to the light, in one or more embodiments. The third curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component adds an opposite stigmatism to cancel the stigmatism added by the first curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component, in one or more embodiments. The second curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component is a respective freeform curved surface, in one or more embodiments. The second curved surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component reflects defined angles of light to be reflected by total internal reflection toward the third curved surface, in one or more embodiments.

[00246] In one or more embodiments, a system comprises a fiber scanning display to project light associated with one or more frames of image data, wherein the fiber scanning display is configured to deliver the light to a first free form optical element, and a first freeform reflective and lens optical component to increase a size of a field-of-view for a defined set of optical parameters, the first freeform reflective and lens optical component comprising: a first curved surface, a second curved surface, and a third curved surface, the first curved surface at least partially optically transmissive and refractive and which imparts a focal change to the light received by the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first curved surface, the second curved surface which at least partially reflects light received by the second curved surface from the first curved surface toward the third curved surface and which passes light received by the second curved surface from the third curved surface, the third curved surface which at least partially reflects light out of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the second curved surface, in one or more embodiments.

[00247] The freeform optic is a TIR freeform optic, in one or more embodiments. The freeform optic has non-uniform thickness, in one or more embodiments. The freeform optic is a wedge optic, in one or more embodiments. The freeform optic is a conic, in one or more embodiments. The freeform optic corresponds to arbitrary curves, in one or more embodiments.

[00248] In one or more embodiments, a system comprises an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user, a display system to provide light associated with the one or more frames of image data; and a free form optical element to modify the provided light and deliver the light to the user, wherein the freeform optic includes reflective coating, wherein the display system is configured to illuminate the freeform optical element with light such that a wavelength of the light matches a corresponding wavelength of the reflective coating, in one or more embodiments.

[00249] The one or more freeform optical elements are tiled in relation to one another. The one or more freeform optical elements are tiled along a z axis, in one or more embodiments.

[00250] In one or more embodiments, a system comprises an image generating source to provide one or more frames of image data to be presented to a user; a display system to provide light associated with the one or more frames of image data, wherein the display system comprises a plurality of microdisplays; and a free form optical element to modify the provided light and deliver the light to the user, in one or more embodiments.

[00251] The one or more freeform optics are tiled in relation to one another. The light projected by the plurality of microdisplays increases a field of view, in one or more embodiments. The freeform optical elements are configured such that only one color is delivered by a particular freeform optical element, in one or more embodiments. The tiled freeform is a star shape, in one or more embodiments. The tiled freeform optical elements increase a size of an exit pupil, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises another free form optical element, wherein the freeform optical element and stacked together in a manner to create a uniform material thickness, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises another free form optical element, wherein the other optical element is configured to capture light corresponding to an outside environment, in one or more embodiments.

[00252] The system further comprises a DMD, wherein the DMD is configured to occlude one or more pixels, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises one or more LCDs. The system further comprises a contact lens substrate, wherein the freeform optics is coupled to the contact lens substrate, in one or more embodiments. The plurality of microdisplays provides an array of small exit pupils that in an aggregate form a functional equivalent of a large exit pupil, in one or more embodiments.

[00253] The at least one image source includes at least a first monochromatic image source that provides light of a first color, at least a second monochromatic image source that provides light of a second color, the second color different from the first color, and at least a third monochromatic image source that provides light of a third color, the third color different from the first and the second colors, in one or more embodiments. The at least a first monochromatic image source comprises a first subgroup of scanning fibers, the at least a second monochromatic image source comprises a second subgroup of scanning fibers, and the at least a third monochromatic image source comprises a third subgroup of scanning fibers, in one or more embodiments.

[00254] The system further comprises an occluder positioned in an optical path between the first freeform reflective and lens optical component and the at least one reflector, the occluder operable to selective occlude light on a pixel-by-pixel basis. The first freeform reflective and lens optical component forms at least a portion of a contact lens. The system further comprises a compensator lens optically coupled to a portion of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component, in one or more embodiments.

[00255] In one or more embodiments, a system comprises a first freeform reflective and lens optical component to increase a size of a field-of-view for a defined set of optical parameters, the first freeform reflective and lens optical component comprising: a first surface, a second surface, and a third surface, the first surface at least partially optically transmissive to light received by the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first surface, the second surface which is curved and at least partially reflects light received by the second surface from the first surface toward the third surface and which passes light received by the second surface from the curved surface, the third surface which is curved and at least partially reflects light out of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the second surface, and a second freeform reflective and lens optical component, the second freeform reflective and lens optical component comprising: a first surface, a second surface, and a third surface, the first surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component at least partially optically transmissive to light received by the second freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first surface, the second surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component which is curved and at least partially reflects light received by the second surface from the first surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component toward the third surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component and which passes light received by the second surface from the third surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component, the third surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component which is curved and at least partially reflects light out of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component via the second surface, wherein the first and the second freeform reflective and lens optical components are in an oppositely oriented stacked configuration along a Z-axis, in one or more embodiments. [00256] The second surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component is adjacent the third surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component, in one or more embodiments. The second surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component is concave and the third surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component is convex, that the third surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component closely receives the second surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component, in one or more embodiments. The first surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component is flat and the first surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component is flat, and further comprises at least a first projector optically coupled to the first freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first surface of the first freeform reflective and lens optical component; and at least a second projector optically coupled to the second freeform reflective and lens optical component via the first surface of the second freeform reflective and lens optical component, in one or more embodiments.

[00257] The system further comprises at least one wavelength selective material carried by at least one of the first or the second freeform reflective and lens optical components, in one or more embodiments. The system further comprises at least a first wavelength selective material carried by the first freeform reflective and lens optical components, at least a second wavelength selective material carried by the second freeform reflective and lens optical components, the first wavelength selective material selective of a first set of wavelengths and the second wavelength selective material selective of a second set of wavelengths, the second set of wavelengths different from the first set of wavelengths, in one or more embodiments.

[00258] The system further comprises at least a first polarizer carried by the first freeform reflective and lens optical components, at least a second polarizer carried by the second freeform reflective and lens optical components, the first polarizer having a different polarization orientation than the second polarizer, in one or more embodiments.

[00259] The optical fiber cores are in the same fiber cladding, in one or more embodiments. The optical fiber cores are in separate fiber claddings, in one or more embodiments. The accommodation module tracks accommodation indirectly, by tracking the vergence or gaze of the user's eyes, in one or more embodiments. The partially reflective mirror has relatively high reflectance for the polarization of light provided by the light source, and relative low reflectance for the other polarization states of light provided by the outside world, in one or more embodiments. The plurality of partially reflective mirrors comprises a dielectric coating, in one or more embodiments. The plurality of reflective mirrors has relatively high reflectance for the waveguides for the wavelengths of light provided by the light source, and relatively low reflectance for the other waveguides of light provided by the outside world, in one or more embodiments. The VFE is a deformable mirror, the surface shape of which can be varied over time, in one or more embodiments. The VFE is an electrostatically actuated membrane mirror, and wherein the waveguide or an additional transparent layer comprises one or more substantially transparent electrodes, and wherein a voltage applied to the one or more electrodes electrostatically deforms the membrane mirror, in one or more embodiments, in one or more embodiments. The light source is a scanned light display, and wherein the VFE varies the focus on a line segment basis, in one or more embodiments. The waveguide comprises an exit pupil expansion function, wherein an input ray of light is split and outcoupled as multiple rays of light exiting the waveguide at multiple locations, in one or more embodiments. The image data is scaled by a processor in accordance with and to compensate for changing optical image magnification, before the waveguide receives the one or more light patterns, such that the image magnification appears to remain substantially fixed while adjusting focus level, in one or more embodiments.

[00260] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content comprises an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data in a time-sequential manner, a display assembly to project light rays associated with the one or more frames of image data, the display assembly comprises a first display element corresponding to a first frame-rate and a first bit depth, and a second display element corresponding to a second frame-rate and a second bit depth, and a variable focus element (VFE) configurable to vary a focus of the projected light and transmit the light to the user's eye.

[00261] In yet another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content comprises an array of optical fibers to transmit light beams associated with an image to be presented to a user, and a lens coupled to the array of the optical fibers to deflect a plurality of light beams output by the array of optical fibers through a single nodal point, wherein the lens is physically attached to the optical fibers such that a movement of the optical fiber causes the lens to move, and wherein the single nodal point is scanned.

[00262] In another embodiment, a virtual reality display system comprises a plurality of optical fibers to generate light beams associated with one or more images to be presented to a user, and a plurality of phase modulators coupled to the plurality of optical fibers to modulate the light beams, wherein the plurality of phase modulators modulate the light in a manner that affects a wavefront generated as a result of the plurality of light beams.

[00263] In one embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user comprises a light projection system to project light associated with one or more frames of image data to a user's eyes, the light project system configured to project light corresponding to a plurality of pixels associated with the image data and a processor to modulate a size of the plurality of pixels displayed to the user. [00264] In one embodiment, a system of displaying virtual content to a user, comprises an image-generating source to provide one or more frames of image data, a multicore assembly comprising a plurality of multicore fibers to project light associated with the one or more frames of image data, a multicore fiber of the plurality of multicore fibers emitting light in a wavefront, such that the multicore assembly produces an aggregate wavefront of the projected light, and a phase modulator to induce phase delays between the multicore fibers in a manner such that the aggregate wavefront emitted by the multicore assembly is varied, thereby varying a focal distance at which the user perceives the one or more frames of image data.

[00265] In another embodiment, a system for displaying virtual content to a user comprises an array of microprojectors to project light beams associated with one or more frames of image data to be presented to the user, wherein the microprojector is configurable to be movable relative to one or more microprojectors of the array of the microprojectors,

a frame to house the array of microprojectors, a processor operatively coupled to the one or more microprojectors of the array of microprojectors to control one or more light beams transmitted from the one or more projectors in a manner such that the one or more light beams are modulated as a function of a position of the one or more microprojectors relative to the array of microprojectors, thereby enabling delivery of a lightfield image to the user.

[00266] Additional and other objects, features, and advantages of the invention are described in the detail description, figures and claims.

BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS

[00267] Fig. 1 illustrates a user's view of augmented reality (AR) through a wearable AR user device, in one illustrated embodiment.

[00268] Figs. 2A-2E illustrates various embodiments of wearable AR devices.

[00269] Fig. 3 illustrates a cross-sectional view of the human eye, in one illustrated embodiment.

[00270] Figs. 4A -4D illustrate one or more embodiments of various internal processing components of the wearable AR device.

[00271] Figs. 5A-5H illustrate embodiments of transmitting focused light to a user through a transmissive beamsplitter substrate.

[00272] Figs. 6A and 6B illustrate embodiments of coupling a lens element with the transmissive beamsplitter substrate of Figs. 5A-5H.

[00273] Figs. 7A and 7B illustrate embodiments of using one or more waveguides to transmit light to a user.

[00274] Figs. 8A-8Q illustrate embodiments of a diffractive optical element (DOE). [00275] Figs 9A and 9B illustrate a wavefront produced from a light projector, according to one illustrated embodiment.

[00276] Fig. 10 illustrates an embodiment of a stacked configuration of multiple transmissive beamsplitter substrate coupled with optical elements, according to one illustrated embodiment.

[00277] Figs 1 1A-1 1 C illustrate a set of beamlets projected into a user's pupil, according to the illustrated embodiments.

[00278] Figs. 12A and 12B illustrate configurations of an array of microprojectors, according to the illustrated embodiments.

[00279] Figs. 13A-13M illustrate embodiments of coupling microprojectors with optical elements, according to the illustrated embodiments.

[00280] Figs. 14A- 14F illustrate embodiments of spatial light modulators coupled with optical elements, according to the illustrated embodiments.

[00281] Figs. 15A-15C illustrate the use of a wedge type waveguides along with a plurality of light sources, according to the illustrated embodiments.

[00282] Figs. 16A-160 illustrate embodiments of coupling optical elements to optical fibers, according to the illustrated embodiments.

[00283] Fig. 17 illustrates a notch filter, according to one illustrated embodiment.

[00284] Fig. 18 illustrates a spiral pattern of a fiber scanning display, according to one illustrated embodiment.

[00285] Figs. 19A-19N illustrate occlusion effects in presenting a darkfield to a user, according to the illustrated embodiments.

[00286] Figs. 20A-20O illustrate embodiments of various waveguide assemblies, according to the illustrated embodiments.

[00287] Figs. 21 A-21 N illustrate various configurations of DOEs coupled to other optical elements, according to the illustrated embodiments.

[00288] Figs. 22A-22Y illustrate various configurations of freeform optics, according to the illustrated embodiments.

DETAILED DESCRIPTION

[00289] Referring to Figures 4A-4D, some general componentry options are illustrated. In the portions of the detailed description which follow the discussion of Figures 4A-4D, various systems, subsystems, and components are presented for addressing the objectives of providing a high-quality, comfortably-perceived display system for human VR and/or AR. [00290] As shown in Figure 4A, an AR system user (60) is depicted wearing a frame (64) structure coupled to a display system (62) positioned in front of the eyes of the user. A speaker (66) is coupled to the frame (64) in the depicted configuration and positioned adjacent the ear canal of the user (in one embodiment, another speaker, not shown, is positioned adjacent the other ear canal of the user to provide for stereo / shapeable sound control). The display (62) is operatively coupled (68), such as by a wired lead or wireless connectivity, to a local processing and data module (70) which may be mounted in a variety of configurations, such as fixedly attached to the frame (64), fixedly attached to a helmet or hat (80) as shown in the embodiment of Figure 4B, embedded in headphones, removably attached to the torso (82) of the user (60) in a backpack-style configuration as shown in the embodiment of Figure 4C, or removably attached to the hip (84) of the user (60) in a belt-coupling style configuration as shown in the embodiment of Figure 4D.

[00291] The local processing and data module (70) may comprise a power-efficient processor or controller, as well as digital memory, such as flash memory, both of which may be utilized to assist in the processing, caching, and storage of data a) captured from sensors which may be operatively coupled to the frame (64), such as image capture devices (such as cameras), microphones, inertial measurement units, accelerometers, compasses, GPS units, radio devices, and/or gyros; and/or b) acquired and/or processed using the remote processing module (72) and/or remote data repository (74), possibly for passage to the display (62) after such processing or retrieval. The local processing and data module (70) may be operatively coupled (76, 78), such as via a wired or wireless communication links, to the remote processing module (72) and remote data repository (74) such that these remote modules (72, 74) are operatively coupled to each other and available as resources to the local processing and data module (70). In one embodiment, the remote processing module (72) may comprise one or more relatively powerful processors or controllers configured to analyze and process data and/or image information. In one embodiment, the remote data repository (74) may comprise a relatively large-scale digital data storage facility, which may be available through the internet or other networking configuration in a "cloud" resource configuration. In one embodiment, all data is stored and all computation is performed in the local processing and data module, allowing fully autonomous use from any remote modules.

[00292] Referring to Figures 5A through 22Y, various display configurations are presented that are designed to present the human eyes with photon-based radiation patterns that can be comfortably perceived as augmentations to physical reality, with high-levels of image quality and three-dimensional perception, as well as being capable of presenting two-dimensional content. [00293] Referring to Figure 5A, in a simplified example, a transmissive beamsplitter substrate (104) with a 45-degree reflecting surface (102) directs incoming radiation (106), which may be output from a lens (not shown), through the pupil (45) of the eye (58) and to the retina (54). The field of view for such a system is limited by the geometry of the beamsplitter (104). To accommodate the desire to have comfortable viewing with minimal hardware, in one embodiment, a larger field of view can be created by aggregating the outputs/reflections of various different reflective and/or diffractive surfaces and using, e.g., a frame-sequential configuration wherein eye (58) is presented with a sequence of frames at high frequency that provides the perception of a single coherent scene. As an alternative to, or in addition to, presenting different image data via different reflectors in a time-sequential fashion, the reflectors may separate content by other means, such as polarization selectivity or wavelength selectivity. In addition to being capable of relaying two-dimensional images, the reflectors can relay the three-dimensional wavefronts associated with true-three-dimensional viewing of actual physical objects.

[00294] Referring to Figure 5B, a substrate (108) comprising a plurality of reflectors at a plurality of angles (1 10) is shown, with each reflector actively reflecting in the depicted configuration for illustrative purposes. The reflectors may be switchable elements to facilitate temporal selectivity. In one embodiment, the reflective surfaces would intentionally be sequentially activated with frame-sequential input information (106), in which each reflective surface presents a narrow field of view sub-image which is tiled with other narrow field of view sub-images presented by the other reflective surfaces to form a composite wide field of view image. For example, referring to Figures 5C, 5D, and 5E, surface (1 10), about in the middle of substrate (108), is switched "on" to a reflecting state, such that it reflects incoming image information (106) to present a relatively narrow field of view sub-image in the middle of a larger field of view, while the other potential reflective surfaces are in a transmissive state.

[00295] Referring to Figure 5C, incoming image information (106) coming from the right of the narrow field of view sub-image (as shown by the angle of incoming beams 106 relative to the substrate 108 input interface 1 12, and the resultant angle at which they exit the substrate 108) is reflected toward the eye (58) from reflective surface (1 10). Figure 5D illustrates the same reflector (1 10) active, with image information coming from the middle of the narrow field of view sub-image, as shown by the angle of the input information (106) at the input interface (1 12) and its angle as it exits substrate (108). Figure 5E illustrates the same reflector (1 10) active, with image information coming from the left of the field of view, as shown by the angle of the input information (106) at the input interface (1 12) and the resultant exit angle at the surface of the substrate (108). Figure 5F illustrates a configuration wherein the bottom reflector (1 10) is active, with image information (106) coming in from the far right of the overall field of view. For example, Figures 5C, 5D, and 5E can illustrate one frame representing the center of a frame- sequential tiled image, and Figure 5F can illustrate a second frame representing the far right of that tiled image.

[00296] In one embodiment, the light carrying the image information (106) may strike the reflective surface (1 10) directly after entering substrate (108) at input interface (1 12), without first reflecting from the surfaces of substrate (108). In one embodiment, the light carrying the image information (106) may reflect from one or more surfaces of substrate (108) after entering at input interface (1 12) and before striking the reflective surface (1 10); for instance, substrate (108) may act as a planar waveguide, propagating the light carrying image information (106) by total internal reflection. Light may also reflect from one or more surfaces of the substrate (108) from a partially reflective coating, a wavelength-selective coating, an angle-selective coating, and/or a polarization-selective coating.

[00297] In one embodiment, the angled reflectors may be constructed using an electro- active material, such that upon application of a voltage and/or current to a particular reflector, the refractive index of the material comprising such reflector changes from an index substantially matched to the rest of the substrate (108), in which case the reflector is in a transmissive configuration, to a reflective configuration wherein the refractive index of the reflector mismatches the refractive index of the substrate (108) such that a reflection effect is created. Example electro-active material includes lithium niobate and electro-active polymers. Suitable substantially transparent electrodes for controlling a plurality of such reflectors may comprise materials such as indium tin oxide, which is utilized in liquid crystal displays.

[00298] In one embodiment, the electro-active reflectors (1 10) may comprise liquid crystal, embedded in a substrate (108) host medium such as glass or plastic. In some variations, liquid crystal may be selected that changes refractive index as a function of an applied electric signal, so that more analog changes may be accomplished as opposed to binary (from one transmissive state to one reflective state). In an embodiment wherein 6 sub-images are to be presented to the eye frame-sequential to form a large tiled image with an overall refresh rate of 60 frames per second, it is desirable to have an input display that can refresh at the rate of about 360 Hz, with an electro-active reflector array that can keep up with such frequency. In one embodiment, lithium niobate may be utilized as an electro-active reflective material as opposed to liquid crystal; lithium niobate is utilized in the photonics industry for high-speed switches and fiber optic networks and has the capability to switch refractive index in response to an applied voltage at a very high frequency; this high frequency may be used to steer line- sequential or pixel-sequential sub-image information, especially if the input display is a scanned light display, such as a fiber-scanned display or scanning mirror-based display.

[00299] In another embodiment, a variable switchable angled mirror configuration may comprise one or more high-speed mechanically repositionable reflective surfaces, such as a MEMS (micro-electro-mechanical system) device. A MEMS device may include what is known as a "digital mirror device", or "DMD", (often part of a "digital light processing", or "DLP" system, such as those available from Texas Instruments, Inc.). In another electromechanical embodiment, a plurality of air-gapped (or in vacuum) reflective surfaces could be mechanically moved in and out of place at high frequency. In another electromechanical embodiment, a single reflective surface may be moved up and down and re-pitched at very high frequency.

[00300] Referring to Figure 5G, it is notable that the switchable variable angle reflector configurations described herein are capable of passing not only collimated or flat wavefront information to the retina (54) of the eye (58), but also curved wavefront (122) image

information, as shown in the illustration of Figure 5G. This generally is not the case with other waveguide-based configurations, wherein total internal reflection of curved wavefront information causes undesirable complications, and therefore the inputs generally must be collimated. The ability to pass curved wavefront information facilitates the ability of

configurations such as those shown in Figures 5B-5H to provide the retina (54) with input perceived as focused at various distances from the eye (58), not just optical infinity (which would be the interpretation of collimated light absent other cues).

[00301 ] Referring to Figure 5H, in another embodiment, an array of static partially reflective surfaces (1 16) (i.e., always in a reflective mode; in another embodiment, they may be electro- active, as above) may be embedded in a substrate (1 14) with a high-frequency gating layer (1 18) controlling outputs to the eye (58) by only allowing transmission through an aperture (120) which is controllably movable. In other words, everything may be selectively blocked except for transmissions through the aperture (120). The gating layer (1 18) may comprise a liquid crystal array, a lithium niobate array, an array of MEMS shutter elements, an array of DLP DMD elements, or an array of other MEMS devices configured to pass or transmit with relatively high-frequency switching and high transmissibility upon being switched to

transmission mode.

[00302] Referring to Figures 6A-6B, other embodiments are depicted wherein arrayed optical elements may be combined with exit pupil expansion configurations to assist with the comfort of the virtual or augmented reality experience of the user. With a larger "exit pupil" for the optics configuration, the user's eye positioning relative to the display (which, as in Figures 4A-4D, may be mounted on the user's head in an eyeglasses sort of configuration) is not as likely to disrupt his experience - because due to the larger exit pupil of the system, there is a larger acceptable area wherein the user's anatomical pupil may be located to still receive the information from the display system as desired. In other words, with a larger exit pupil, the system is less likely to be sensitive to slight misalignments of the display relative to the user's anatomical pupil, and greater comfort for the user may be achieved through less geometric constraint on his or her relationship with the display/glasses.

[00303] As shown in Figure 6A, the display (140) on the left feeds a set of parallel rays into the substrate (124). In one embodiment, the display may be a scanned fiber display scanning a narrow beam of light back and forth at an angle as shown to project an image through the lens or other optical element (142), which may be utilized to collect the angularly-scanned light and convert it to a parallel bundle of rays. The rays may be reflected from a series of reflective surfaces (126, 128, 130, 132, 134, 136) which may be configured to partially reflect and partially transmit incoming light so that the light may be shared across the group of reflective surfaces (126, 128, 130, 132, 134, 136) approximately equally. With a small lens (138) placed at each exit point from the waveguide (124), the exiting light rays may be steered through a nodal point and scanned out toward the eye (58) to provide an array of exit pupils, or the functional equivalent of one large exit pupil that is usable by the user as he or she gazes toward the display system.

[00304] For virtual reality configurations wherein it is desirable to also be able to see through the waveguide to the real world (144), a similar set of lenses (139) may be presented on the opposite side of the waveguide (124) to compensate for the lower set of lenses; thus creating a the equivalent of a zero-magnification telescope. The reflective surfaces (126, 128, 130, 132, 134, 136) each may be aligned at approximately 45 degrees as shown, or may be configured to have different alignments, akin to the configurations of Figures 5B-5H, for example). The reflective surfaces (126, 128, 130, 132, 134, 136) may comprise wavelength-selective reflectors, band pass reflectors, half silvered mirrors, or other reflective configurations. The lenses (138, 139) shown are refractive lenses, but diffractive lens elements may also be utilized.

[00305] Referring to Figure 6B, a somewhat similar configuration is depicted wherein a plurality of curved reflective surfaces (148, 150, 152, 154, 156, 158) may be utilized to effectively combine the lens (element 138 of Figure 6A) and reflector (elements 126, 128, 130, 132, 134, 136 of Figure 6A) functionality of the embodiment of Figure 6A, thereby obviating the need for the two groups of lenses (element 138 of Figure 6A). The curved reflective surfaces (148, 150, 152, 154, 156, 158) may be various curved configurations selected to both reflect and impart angular change, such as parabolic or elliptical curved surfaces. With a parabolic shape, a parallel set of incoming rays will be collected into a single output point; with an elliptical configuration, a set of rays diverging from a single point of origin are collected to a single output point. As with the configuration of Figure 6A, the curved reflective surfaces (148, 150, 152, 154, 156, 158) preferably are configured to partially reflect and partially transmit so that the incoming light is shared across the length of the waveguide (146). The curved reflective surfaces (148, 150, 152, 154, 156, 158) may comprise wavelength-selective notch reflectors, half silvered mirrors, or other reflective configurations. In another embodiment, the curved reflective surfaces (148, 150, 152, 154, 156, 158) may be replaced with diffractive reflectors configured to reflect and also deflect.

[00306] Referring to Figure 7A, perceptions of Z-axis difference (i.e., distance straight out from the eye along the optical axis) may be facilitated by using a waveguide in conjunction with a variable focus optical element configuration. As shown in Figure 7A, image information from a display (160) may be collimated and injected into a waveguide (164) and distributed in a large exit pupil manner using, e.g., configurations such as those described in reference to Figures 6A and 6B, or other substrate-guided optics methods known to those skilled in the art - and then variable focus optical element capability may be utilized to change the focus of the wavefront of light emerging from the waveguide and provide the eye with the perception that the light coming from the waveguide (164) is from a particular focal distance. In other words, since the incoming light has been collimated to avoid challenges in total internal reflection waveguide configurations, it will exit in collimated fashion, requiring a viewer's eye to accommodate to the far point to bring it into focus on the retina, and naturally be interpreted as being from optical infinity - unless some other intervention causes the light to be refocused and perceived as from a different viewing distance; one suitable such intervention is a variable focus lens.

[00307] In the embodiment of Figure 7A, collimated image information is injected into a piece of glass (162) or other material at an angle such that it totally internally reflects and is passed into the adjacent waveguide (164). The waveguide (164) may be configured akin to the waveguides of Figures 6A or 6B (124, 146, respectively) so that the collimated light from the display is distributed to exit somewhat uniformly across the distribution of reflectors or diffractive features along the length of the waveguide. Upon exit toward the eye (58), in the depicted configuration the exiting light is passed through a variable focus lens element (166) wherein, depending upon the controlled focus of the variable focus lens element (166), the light exiting the variable focus lens element (166) and entering the eye (58) will have various levels of focus (a collimated flat wavefront to represent optical infinity, more and more beam divergence / wavefront curvature to represent closer viewing distance relative to the eye 58).

[00308] To compensate for the variable focus lens element (166) between the eye (58) and the waveguide (164), another similar variable focus lens element (167) is placed on the opposite side of the waveguide (164) to cancel out the optical effects of the lenses (166) for light coming from the world (144) for augmented reality (i.e., as described above, one lens compensates for the other, producing the functional equivalent of a zero-magnification telescope).

[00309] The variable focus lens element (166) may be a refractive element, such as a liquid crystal lens, an electro-active lens, a conventional refractive lens with moving elements, a mechanical-deformation-based lens (such as a fluid-filled membrane lens, or a lens akin to the human crystalline lens wherein a flexible element is flexed and relaxed by actuators), an electrowetting lens, or a plurality of fluids with different refractive indices. The variable focus lens element (166) may also comprise a switchable diffractive optical element (such as one featuring a polymer dispersed liquid crystal approach wherein a host medium, such as a polymeric material, has microdroplets of liquid crystal dispersed within the material; when a voltage is applied, the molecules reorient so that their refractive indices no longer match that of the host medium, thereby creating a high-frequency switchable diffraction pattern).

[00310] One embodiment includes a host medium in which microdroplets of a Kerr effect- based electro-active material, such as lithium niobate, is dispersed within the host medium, enabling refocusing of image information on a pixel-by-pixel or line-by-line basis, when coupled with a scanning light display, such as a fiber-scanned display or scanning-mirror-based display. In a variable focus lens element (166) configuration wherein liquid crystal, lithium niobate, or other technology is utilized to present a pattern, the pattern spacing may be modulated to not only change the focal power of the variable focus lens element (166), but also to change the focal power of the overall optical system - for a zoom lens type of functionality.

[00311] In one embodiment, the lenses (166) could be telecentric, in that focus of the display imagery can be altered while keeping magnification constant - in the same way that a photography zoom lens may be configured to decouple focus from zoom position. In another embodiment, the lenses (166) may be non-telecentric, so that focus changes will also slave zoom changes. With such a configuration, such magnification changes may be compensated for in software with dynamic scaling of the output from the graphics system in sync with focus changes). [00312] Referring back to the projector or other video display unit (160) and the issue of how to feed images into the optical display system, in a "frame sequential" configuration, a stack of sequential two-dimensional images may be fed to the display sequentially to produce three- dimensional perception over time; in a manner akin to the manner in which a computed tomography system uses stacked image slices to represent a three-dimensional structure. A series of two-dimensional image slices may be presented to the eye, each at a different focal distance to the eye, and the eye/brain would integrate such a stack into a perception of a coherent three-dimensional volume. Depending upon the display type, line-by-line, or even pixel-by-pixel sequencing may be conducted to produce the perception of three-dimensional viewing. For example, with a scanned light display (such as a scanning fiber display or scanning mirror display), then the display is presenting the waveguide (164) with one line or one pixel at a time in a sequential fashion.

[00313] If the variable focus lens element (166) is able to keep up with the high-frequency of pixel-by-pixel or line-by-line presentation, then each line or pixel may be presented and dynamically focused through the variable focus lens element (166) to be perceived at a different focal distance from the eye (58). Pixel-by-pixel focus modulation generally requires an extremely fast / high-frequency variable focus lens element (166). For example, a 1080P resolution display with an overall frame rate of 60 frames per second typically presents around 125 million pixels per second. Such a configuration also may be constructed using a solid state switchable lens, such as one using an electro-active material, e.g., lithium niobate or an electro- active polymer. In addition to its compatibility with the system illustrated in Figure 7A, a frame sequential multi-focal display driving approach may be used in conjunction with a number of the display system and optics embodiments described in this disclosure.

[00314] Referring to Figure 7B, with an electro-active layer (172) (such as one comprising liquid crystal or lithium niobate) surrounded by functional electrodes (170, 174) which may be made of indium tin oxide, a waveguide (168) with a conventional transmissive substrate (176, such as one made from glass or plastic with known total internal reflection characteristics and an index of refraction that matches the on or off state of the electro-active layer 172) may be controlled such that the paths of entering beams may be dynamically altered to essentially create a time-varying light field.

[00315] Referring to Figure 8A, a stacked waveguide assembly (178) may be utilized to provide three-dimensional perception to the eye/brain by having a plurality of waveguides (182, 184, 186, 188, 190) and a plurality of weak lenses (198, 196, 194, 192) configured together to send image information to the eye with various levels of wavefront curvature for each waveguide level indicative of focal distance to be perceived for that waveguide level. A plurality of displays (200, 202, 204, 206, 208), or in another embodiment a single multiplexed display, may be utilized to inject collimated image information into the waveguides (182, 184, 186, 188, 190), each of which may be configured, as described above, to distribute incoming light substantially equally across the length of each waveguide, for exit down toward the eye.

[00316] The waveguide (182) nearest the eye is configured to deliver collimated light, as injected into such waveguide (182), to the eye, which may be representative of the optical infinity focal plane. The next waveguide up (184) is configured to send out collimated light which passes through the first weak lens (192; e.g., a weak negative lens) before it can reach the eye (58); such first weak lens (192) may be configured to create a slight convex wavefront curvature so that the eye/brain interprets light coming from that next waveguide up (184) as coming from a first focal plane closer inward toward the person from optical infinity. Similarly, the third up waveguide (186) passes its output light through both the first (192) and second (194) lenses before reaching the eye (58); the combined optical power of the first (192) and second (194) lenses may be configured to create another incremental amount of wavefront divergence so that the eye/brain interprets light coming from that third waveguide up (186) as coming from a second focal plane even closer inward toward the person from optical infinity than was light from the next waveguide up (184).

[00317] The other waveguide layers (188, 190) and weak lenses (196, 198) are similarly configured, with the highest waveguide (190) in the stack sending its output through all of the weak lenses between it and the eye for an aggregate focal power representative of the closest focal plane to the person. To compensate for the stack of lenses (198, 196, 194, 192) when viewing/interpreting light coming from the world (144) on the other side of the stacked waveguide assembly (178), a compensating lens layer (180) is disposed at the top of the stack to compensate for the aggregate power of the lens stack (198, 196, 194, 192) below. Such a configuration provides as many perceived focal planes as there are available waveguide/lens pairings, again with a relatively large exit pupil configuration as described above. Both the reflective aspects of the waveguides and the focusing aspects of the lenses may be static (i.e., not dynamic or electro-active). In an alternative embodiment they may be dynamic using electro-active features as described above, enabling a small number of waveguides to be multiplexed in a time sequential fashion to produce a larger number of effective focal planes.

[00318] Referring to Figures 8B-8N, various aspects of diffraction configurations for focusing and/or redirecting collimated beams are depicted. Other aspects of diffraction systems for such purposes are disclosed in U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 61/845,907 (U.S Patent Application No. 14/331 ,218), which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. Referring to Figure 8B, passing a collimated beam through a linear diffraction pattern (210), such as a Bragg grating, will deflect, or "steer", the beam. Passing a collimated beam through a radially symmetric diffraction pattern (212), or "Fresnel zone plate", will change the focal point of the beam. Figure 8C illustrates the deflection effect of passing a collimated beam through a linear diffraction pattern (210); Figure 8D illustrates the focusing effect of passing a collimated beam through a radially symmetric diffraction pattern (212).

[00319] Referring to Figures 8E and 8F, a combination diffraction pattern that has both linear and radial elements (214) produces both deflection and focusing of a collimated input beam. These deflection and focusing effects can be produced in a reflective as well as transmissive mode. These principles may be applied with waveguide configurations to allow for additional optical system control, as shown in Figures 8G-8N, for example. As shown in Figures 8G-8N, a diffraction pattern (220), or "diffractive optical element" (or "DOE") has been embedded within a planar waveguide (216) such that as a collimated beam is totally internally reflected along the planar waveguide (216), it intersects the diffraction pattern (220) at a multiplicity of locations.

[00320] Preferably, the DOE (220) has a relatively low diffraction efficiency so that only a portion of the light of the beam is deflected away toward the eye (58) with each intersection of the DOE (220) while the rest continues to move through the planar waveguide (216) via total internal reflection; the light carrying the image information is thus divided into a number of related light beams that exit the waveguide at a multiplicity of locations and the result is a fairly uniform pattern of exit emission toward the eye (58) for this particular collimated beam bouncing around within the planar waveguide (216), as shown in Figure 8H. The exit beams toward the eye (58) are shown in Figure 8H as substantially parallel, because, in this case, the DOE (220) has only a linear diffraction pattern. As shown in the comparison between Figures 8L, 8M, and 8N, changes to this linear diffraction pattern pitch may be utilized to controllably deflect the exiting parallel beams, thereby producing a scanning or tiling functionality.

[00321] Referring back to Figure 8I, with changes in the radially symmetric diffraction pattern component of the embedded DOE (220), the exit beam pattern is more divergent, which would require the eye to accommodation to a closer distance to bring it into focus on the retina and would be interpreted by the brain as light from a viewing distance closer to the eye than optical infinity. Referring to Figure 8J, with the addition of another waveguide (218) into which the beam may be injected (by a projector or display, for example), a DOE (221 ) embedded in this other waveguide (218), such as a linear diffraction pattern, may function to spread the light across the entire larger planar waveguide (216), which functions to provide the eye (58) with a very large incoming field of incoming light that exits from the larger planar waveguide (216), i.e., a large eye box, in accordance with the particular DOE configurations at work.

[00322] The DOEs (220, 221 ) are depicted bisecting the associated waveguides (216, 218) but this need not be the case; they could be placed closer to, or upon, either side of either of the waveguides (216, 218) to have the same functionality. Thus, as shown in Figure 8K, with the injection of a single collimated beam, an entire field of cloned collimated beams may be directed toward the eye (58). In addition, with a combined linear diffraction pattern / radially symmetric diffraction pattern scenario such as that depicted in Figures 8F (214) and 8I (220), a beam distribution waveguide optic (for functionality such as exit pupil functional expansion; with a configuration such as that of Figure 8K, the exit pupil can be as large as the optical element itself, which can be a very significant advantage for user comfort and ergonomics) with Z-axis focusing capability is presented, in which both the divergence angle of the cloned beams and the wavefront curvature of each beam represent light coming from a point closer than optical infinity.

[00323] In one embodiment, one or more DOEs are switchable between "on" states in which they actively diffract, and "off" states in which they do not significantly diffract. For instance, a switchable DOE may comprise a layer of polymer dispersed liquid crystal, in which microdroplets comprise a diffraction pattern in a host medium, and the refractive index of the microdroplets can be switched to substantially match the refractive index of the host material (in which case the pattern does not appreciably diffract incident light) or the microdroplet can be switched to an index that does not match that of the host medium (in which case the pattern actively diffracts incident light). Further, with dynamic changes to the diffraction terms, such as the linear diffraction pitch term as in Figures 8L-8N, a beam scanning or tiling functionality may be achieved. As noted above, it is desirable to have a relatively low diffraction grating efficiency in each of the DOEs (220, 221 ) because it facilitates distribution of the light, and also because light coming through the waveguides that is desirably transmitted (for example, light coming from the world 144 toward the eye 58 in an augmented reality configuration) is less affected when the diffraction efficiency of the DOE that it crosses (220) is lower - so a better view of the real world through such a configuration is achieved.

[00324] Configurations such as those illustrated in Figure 8K preferably are driven with injection of image information in a time sequential approach, with frame sequential driving being the most straightforward to implement. For example, an image of the sky at optical infinity may be injected at timel and the diffraction grating retaining collimation of light may be utilized; then an image of a closer tree branch may be injected at time2 while a DOE controllably imparts a focal change, say one diopter or 1 meter away, to provide the eye/brain with the perception that the branch light information is coming from the closer focal range. This kind of paradigm can be repeated in rapid time sequential fashion such that the eye/brain perceives the input to be all part of the same image. This is just a two focal plane example; preferably the system will be configured to have more focal planes to provide a smoother transition between objects and their focal distances. This kind of configuration generally assumes that the DOE is switched at a relatively low speed (i.e., in sync with the frame-rate of the display that is injecting the images - in the range of tens to hundreds of cycles/second).

[00325] The opposite extreme may be a configuration wherein DOE elements can shift focus at tens to hundreds of MHz or greater, which facilitates switching of the focus state of the DOE elements on a pixel-by-pixel basis as the pixels are scanned into the eye (58) using a scanned light display type of approach. This is desirable because it means that the overall display frame-rate can be kept quite low; just low enough to make sure that "flicker" is not a problem (in the range of about 60-120 frames/sec).

[00326] In between these ranges, if the DOEs can be switched at KHz rates, then on a line- by-line basis the focus on each scan line may be adjusted, which may afford the user with a visible benefit in terms of temporal artifacts during an eye motion relative to the display, for example. For instance, the different focal planes in a scene may, in this manner, be interleaved, to minimize visible artifacts in response to a head motion (as is discussed in greater detail later in this disclosure). A line-by-line focus modulator may be operatively coupled to a line scan display, such as a grating light valve display, in which a linear array of pixels is swept to form an image; and may be operatively coupled to scanned light displays, such as fiber-scanned displays and mirror-scanned light displays.

[00327] A stacked configuration, similar to those of Figure 8A, may use dynamic DOEs (rather than the static waveguides and lenses of the embodiment of Figure 8A) to provide multiplanar focusing simultaneously. For example, with three simultaneous focal planes, a primary focus plane (based upon measured eye accommodation, for example) could be presented to the user, and a + margin and - margin (i.e., one focal plane closer, one farther out) could be utilized to provide a large focal range in which the user can accommodate before the planes need be updated. This increased focal range can provide a temporal advantage if the user switches to a closer or farther focus (i.e., as determined by accommodation measurement); then the new plane of focus could be made to be the middle depth of focus, with the + and - margins again ready for a fast switchover to either one while the system catches up. [00328] Referring to Figure 80, a stack (222) of planar waveguides (244, 246, 248, 250, 252) is shown, each having a reflector (254, 256, 258, 260, 262) at the end and being configured such that collimated image information injected in one end by a display (224, 226, 228, 230, 232) bounces by total internal reflection down to the reflector, at which point some or all of the light is reflected out toward an eye or other target. Each of the reflectors may have slightly different angles so that they all reflect exiting light toward a common destination such as a pupil. Such a configuration is somewhat similar to that of Figure 5B, with the exception that each different angled reflector in the embodiment of Figure 80 has its own waveguide for less interference when projected light is travelling to the targeted reflector. Lenses (234, 236, 238, 240, 242) may be interposed between the displays and waveguides for beam steering and/or focusing.

[00329] Figure 8P illustrates a geometrically staggered version wherein reflectors (276, 278, 280, 282, 284) are positioned at staggered lengths in the waveguides (266, 268, 270, 272, 274) so that exiting beams may be relatively easily aligned with objects such as an anatomical pupil. With knowledge of how far the stack (264) is going to be from the eye (such as 28mm between the cornea of the eye and an eyeglasses lens, a typical comfortable geometry), the geometries of the reflectors (276, 278, 280, 282, 284) and waveguides (266, 268, 270, 272, 274) may be set up to fill the eye pupil (typically about 8mm across or less) with exiting light. By directing light to an eye box larger than the diameter of the eye pupil, the viewer may make eye movements while retaining the ability to see the displayed imagery. Referring back to the discussion related to Figure 5A and 5B about field of view expansion and reflector size, an expanded field of view is presented by the configuration of Figure 8P as well, and it does not involve the complexity of the switchable reflective elements of the embodiment of Figure 5B.

[00330] Figure 8Q illustrates a version wherein many reflectors (298) form a relatively continuous curved reflection surface in the aggregate or discrete flat facets that are oriented to align with an overall curve. The curve could a parabolic or elliptical curve and is shown cutting across a plurality of waveguides (288, 290, 292, 294, 296) to minimize any crosstalk issues, although it also could be utilized with a monolithic waveguide configuration.

[00331] In one implementation, a high-frame-rate and lower persistence display may be combined with a lower-frame-rate and higher persistence display and a variable focus element to comprise a relatively high-frequency frame sequential volumetric display. In one

embodiment, the high-frame-rate display has a lower bit depth and the lower-frame-rate display has a higher bit depth, and are combined to comprise an effective high-frame-rate and high bit depth display, that is well suited to presenting image slices in a frame sequential fashion. With such an approach, a three-dimensional volume that is desirably represented is functionally divided into a series of two-dimensional slices. Each of those two-dimensional slices is projected to the eye frame sequentially, and in sync with this presentation, the focus of a variable focus element is changed.

[00332] In one embodiment, to get enough frame rate to support such a configuration, two display elements may be integrated: a full-color, high-resolution liquid crystal display ("LCD"; a backlighted ferroelectric panel display also may be utilized in another embodiment; in a further embodiment a scanning fiber display may be utilized) operating at 60 frames per second, and aspects of a higher-frequency DLP system. Instead of illuminating the back of the LCD panel in a conventional manner (i.e., with a full size fluorescent lamp or LED array), the conventional lighting configuration may be removed to accommodate using the DLP projector to project a mask pattern on the back of the LCD (in one embodiment, the mask pattern may be binary in that the DLP either projects illumination, or not-illumination; in another embodiment described below, the DLP may be utilized to project a grayscale mask image).

[00333] DLP projection systems can operate at very high frame rates; in one embodiment for 6 depth planes at 60 frames per second, a DLP projection system is operated against the back of the LCD display at 360 frames/second. Then the DLP projector is utilized to selectively illuminate portions of the LCD panel in sync with a high-frequency variable focus element (such as a deformable membrane mirror) that is disposed between the viewing side of the LCD panel and the eye of the user, the variable focus element being used to change the global display focus on a frame by frame basis at 360 frames/second. In one embodiment, the variable focus element is positioned to be optically conjugate to the exit pupil, to enable adjustments of focus without simultaneously affecting image magnification or "zoom." In another embodiment, the variable focus element is not conjugate to the exit pupil, such that image magnification changes accompany focus adjustments, and software is used to compensate for these optical magnification changes and any distortions by pre-scaling or warping the images to be presented.

[00334] Operationally, it's useful to consider an example again wherein a three-dimensional scene is to be presented to a user wherein the sky in the background is to be at a viewing distance of optical infinity, and wherein a branch coupled to a tree located at a certain location closer to the user than optical infinity extends from the tree trunk in a direction toward the user, so that the tip of the branch is closer to the user than is the proximal portion of the branch that joins the tree trunk. [00335] In one embodiment, for a given global frame, the system may be configured to present on an LCD a full-color, all in-focus image of the tree branch in front the sky. Then at subframel , within the global frame, the DLP projector in a binary masking configuration (i.e., illumination or absence of illumination) may be used to only illuminate the portion of the LCD that represents the cloudy sky while functionally black-masking (i.e., failing to illuminate) the portion of the LCD that represents the tree branch and other elements that are not to be perceived at the same focal distance as the sky, and the variable focus element (such as a deformable membrane mirror) may be utilized to position the focal plane at optical infinity so that the eye sees a sub-image at subframel as being clouds that are infinitely far away.

[00336] Then at subframe2, the variable focus element may be switched to focusing on a point about 1 meter away from the user's eyes (or whatever distance is required; here 1 meter for the branch location is used for illustrative purposes), the pattern of illumination from the DLP can be switched so that the system only illuminates the portion of the LCD that represents the tree branch while functionally black-masking (i.e., failing to illuminate) the portion of the LCD that represents the sky and other elements that are not to be perceived at the same focal distance as the tree branch. Thus the eye gets a quick flash of cloud at optical infinity followed by a quick flash of tree at 1 meter, and the sequence is integrated by the eye/brain to form a three-dimensional perception. The branch may be positioned diagonally relative to the viewer, such that it extends through a range of viewing distances, e.g., it may join with the trunk at around 2 meters viewing distance while the tips of the branch are at the closer position of 1 meter.

[00337] In this case, the display system can divide the 3-D volume of the tree branch into multiple slices, rather than a single slice at 1 meter. For instance, one focus slice may be used to represent the sky (using the DLP to mask all areas of the tree during presentation of this slice), while the tree branch is divided across 5 focus slices (using the DLP to mask the sky and all portions of the tree except one, for each part of the tree branch to be presented). Preferably, the depth slices are positioned with a spacing equal to or smaller than the depth of focus of the eye, such that the viewer will be unlikely to notice the transition between slices, and instead perceive a smooth and continuous flow of the branch through the focus range.

[00338] In another embodiment, rather than utilizing the DLP in a binary (illumination or darkfield only) mode, it may be utilized to project a grayscale (for example, 256 shades of grayscale) mask onto the back of the LCD panel to enhance three-dimensional perception. The grayscale shades may be utilized to impart to the eye/brain a perception that something resides in between adjacent depth or focal planes. Back to the branch and clouds scenario, if the leading edge of the branch closest to the user is to be in focalplanel , then at subframel , that portion branch on the LCD may be lit up with full intensity white from the DLP system with the variable focus element at focalplanel .

[00339] Then at subframe2, with the variable focus element at focalplane2 right behind the part that was lit up, there would be no illumination. These are similar steps to the binary DLP masking configuration above. However, if there is a portion of the branch that is to be perceived at a position between focalplanel and focalplanel , e.g., halfway, grayscale masking can be utilized. The DLP can project an illumination mask to that portion during both subframel and subframe2, but at half-illumination (such as at level 128 out of 256 grayscale) for each subframe. This provides the perception of a blending of depth of focus layers, with the perceived focal distance being proportional to the illuminance ratio between subframel and subframe2. For instance, for a portion of the tree branch that should lie 3/4ths of the way between focalplanel and focalplane2, an about 25% intensity grayscale mask can be used to illuminate that portion of the LCD at subframel and an about 75% grayscale mask can be used to illuminate the same portion of the LCD at subframe2.

[00340] In one embodiment, the bit depths of both the low-frame-rate display and the high- frame-rate display can be combined for image modulation, to create a high dynamic range display. The high dynamic range driving may be conducted in tandem with the focus plane addressing function described above, to comprise a high dynamic range multi-focal 3-D display.

[00341] In another embodiment that may be more efficient on computation resources, only a certain portion of the display (i.e., LCD) output may be mask-illuminated by the DMD and variably focused en route to the user's eye. For example, the middle portion of the display may be mask illuminated, with the periphery of the display not providing varying accommodation cues to the user (i.e. the periphery could be uniformly illuminated by the DLP DMD, while a central portion is actively masked and variably focused en route to the eye).

[00342] In the above described embodiment, a refresh rate of about 360 Hz allows for 6 depth planes at about 60 frames/second each. In another embodiment, even higher refresh rates may be achieved by increasing the operating frequency of the DLP. A standard DLP configuration uses a MEMS device and an array of micro-mirrors that toggle between a mode of reflecting light toward the display or user to a mode of reflecting light away from the display or user, such as into a light trap— thus they are inherently binary. DLPs typically create grayscale images using a pulse width modulation schema wherein the mirror is left in the "on" state for a variable amount of time for a variable duty cycle in order to create a brighter pixel, or pixel of interim brightness. Thus, to create grayscale images at moderate frame rate, they are running at a much higher binary rate.

[00343] In the above described configurations, such setup works well for creating grayscale masking. However, if the DLP drive scheme is adapted so that it is flashing subimages in a binary pattern, then the frame rate may be increased significantly - by thousands of frames per second, which allows for hundreds to thousands of depth planes being refreshed at 60 frames/second, which may be utilized to obviate the between-depth-plane grayscale interpolating as described above. A typical pulse width modulation scheme for a Texas Instruments DLP system has an 8-bit command signal (first bit is the first long pulse of the mirror; second bit is a pulse that is half as long as the first; third bit is half as long again; and so on) - so that the configuration can create 2 to the 8th power different illumination levels. In one embodiment, the backlighting from the DLP may have its intensity varied in sync with the different pulses of the DMD to equalize the brightness of the subimages that are created, which is a practical workaround to get existing DMD drive electronics to produce significantly higher frame rates.

[00344] In another embodiment, direct control changes to the DMD drive electronics and software may be utilized to have the mirrors always have an equal on-time instead of the variable on-time configuration that is conventional, which would facilitate higher frame rates. In another embodiment, the DMD drive electronics may be configured to present low bit depth images at a frame rate above that of high bit depth images but lower than the binary frame rate, enabling some grayscale blending between focus planes, while moderately increasing the number of focus planes.

[00345] In another embodiment, when limited to a finite number of depth planes, such as 6 in the example above, it is desirable to functionally move these 6 depth planes around to be maximally useful in the scene that is being presented to the user. For example, if a user is standing in a room and a virtual monster is to be placed into his augmented reality view, the virtual monster being about 2 feet deep in the Z axis straight away from the user's eyes, then it makes sense to cluster all 6 depth planes around the center of the monster's current location (and dynamically move them with him as he moves relative to the user) - so that more rich accommodation cues may be provided for the user, with all six depth planes in the direct region of the monster (for example, 3 in front of the center of the monster, 3 in back of the center of the monster). Such allocation of depth planes is content dependent.

[00346] For example, in the scene above the same monster is to be presented in the same room, but also to be presented to the user is a virtual window frame element, and then a virtual view to optical infinity out of the virtual window frame, it will be useful to spend at least one depth plane on optical infinity, one on the depth of the wall that is to house the virtual window frame, and then perhaps the remaining four depth planes on the monster in the room. If the content causes the virtual window to disappear, then the two depth planes may be dynamically reallocated to the region around the monster, and so on - content-based dynamic allocation of focal plane resources to provide the most rich experience to the user given the computing and presentation resources.

[00347] In another embodiment, phase delays in a multicore fiber or an array of single-core fibers may be utilized to create variable focus light wavefronts. Referring to Figure 9A, a multicore fiber (300) may comprise the aggregation of multiple individual fibers (302); Figure 9B shows a close-up view of a multicore assembly, which emits light from each core in the form of a spherical wavefront (304) from each. If the cores are transmitting coherent light, e.g., from a shared laser light source, these small spherical wavefronts ultimately constructively and destructively interfere with each other, and if they were emitted from the multicore fiber in phase, they will develop an approximately planar wavefront (306) in the aggregate, as shown. However, if phase delays are induced between the cores (using a conventional phase modulator such as one using lithium niobate, for example, to slow the path of some cores relative to others), then a curved or spherical wavefront may be created in the aggregate, to represent at the eyes/brain an object coming from a point closer than optical infinity, which presents another option that may be used in place of the variable focus elements described above. In other words, such a phased multicore configuration, or phased array, may be utilized to create multiple optical focus levels from a light source.

[00348] In another embodiment related to the use of optical fibers, a known Fourier transform aspect of multi-mode optical fiber or light guiding rods or pipes may be utilized for control of the wavefronts that are output from such fiber. Optical fibers typically are available in two categories: single mode and multi-mode. Multi-mode optical fiber typically has larger core diameters and allows light to propagate along multiple angular paths, rather than just the one of single mode optical fiber. It is known that if an image is injected into one end of a multi-mode fiber, that angular differences that are encoded into that image will be retained to some degree as it propagates through the multi-mode fiber, and for some configurations the output from the fiber will be significantly similar to a Fourier transform of the image that was input.

[00349] Thus in one embodiment, the inverse Fourier transform of a wavefront (such as a diverging spherical wavefront to represent a focal plane nearer to the user than optical infinity) may be input so that, after passing through the fiber that optically imparts a Fourier transform, the output is the desired shaped, or focused, wavefront. Such output end may be scanned about to be used as a scanned fiber display, or may be used as a light source for a scanning mirror to form an image, for instance. Thus such a configuration may be utilized as yet another focus modulation subsystem. Other kinds of light patterns and wavefronts may be injected into a multi-mode fiber, such that on the output end, a certain spatial pattern is emitted. This may be utilized to have the equivalent of a wavelet pattern (in optics, an optical system may be analyzed in terms of what are called the Zernicke coefficients; images may be similarly characterized and decomposed into smaller principal components, or a weighted combination of comparatively simpler image components). Thus if light is scanned into the eye using the principal components on the input side, a higher resolution image may be recovered at the output end of the multi-mode fiber.

[00350] In another embodiment, the Fourier transform of a hologram may be injected into the input end of a multi-mode fiber to output a wavefront that may be used for three-dimensional focus modulation and/or resolution enhancement. Certain single fiber core, multi-core fibers, or concentric core + cladding configurations also may be utilized in the aforementioned inverse Fourier transform configurations.

[00351] In another embodiment, rather than physically manipulating the wavefronts approaching the eye of the user at a high frame rate without regard to the user's particular state of accommodation or eye gaze, a system may be configured to monitor the user's

accommodation and rather than presenting a set of multiple different light wavefronts, present a single wavefront at a time that corresponds to the accommodation state of the eye.

Accommodation may be measured directly (such as by infrared autorefractor or eccentric photorefraction) or indirectly (such as by measuring the convergence level of the two eyes of the user; as described above, vergence and accommodation are strongly linked neurologically, so an estimate of accommodation can be made based upon vergence geometry). Thus with a determined accommodation of, say, 1 meter from the user, then the wavefront presentations at the eye may be configured for a 1 meter focal distance using any of the above variable focus configurations. If an accommodation change to focus at 2 meters is detected, the wavefront presentation at the eye may be reconfigured for a 2 meter focal distance, and so on.

[00352] Thus in one embodiment incorporating accommodation tracking, a variable focus element may be placed in the optical path between an outputting combiner (e.g., a waveguide or beamsplitter) and the eye of the user, so that the focus may be changed along with (i.e., preferably at the same rate as) accommodation changes of the eye. Software effects may be utilized to produce variable amounts blur (e.g., Gaussian) to objects which should not be in focus to simulate the dioptric blur expected at the retina if an object were at that viewing distance and enhance the three-dimensional perception by the eyes/brain.

[00353] A simple embodiment is a single plane whose focus level is slaved to the viewer's accommodation level, however the performance demands on the accommodation tracking system can be relaxed if even a low number of multiple planes are used. Referring to Figure 10, in another embodiment, a stack (328) of about 3 waveguides (318, 320, 322) may be utilized to create three focal planes worth of wavefronts simultaneously. In one embodiment, the weak lenses (324, 326) may have static focal distances, and a variable focal lens (316) may be slaved to the accommodation tracking of the eyes such that one of the three waveguides (say the middle waveguide 320) outputs what is deemed to be the in-focus wavefront, while the other two waveguides (322, 318) output a + margin wavefront and a - margin wavefront (i.e., a little farther than detected focal distance, a little closer than detected focal distance) which may improve the three-dimensional perception and also provide enough difference for the brain/eye accommodation control system to sense some blur as negative feedback, which enhances the perception of reality, and allows a range of accommodation before an physical adjustment of the focus levels is necessary.

[00354] A variable focus compensating lens (314) is also shown to ensure that light coming in from the real world (144) in an augmented reality configuration is not refocused or magnified by the assembly of the stack (328) and output lens (316). The variable focus in the lenses (316, 314) may be achieved, as discussed above, with refractive, diffractive, or reflective techniques.

[00355] In another embodiment, each of the waveguides in a stack may contain their own capability for changing focus (such as by having an included electronically switchable DOE) so that the variable focus element need not be centralized as in the stack (328) of the

configuration of Figure 10.

[00356] In another embodiment, variable focus elements may be interleaved between the waveguides of a stack (i.e., rather than fixed focus weak lenses as in the embodiment of Figure 10) to obviate the need for a combination of fixed focus weak lenses plus whole-stack- refocusing variable focus element.

[00357] Such stacking configurations may be used in accommodation tracked variations as described herein, and also in a frame-sequential multi-focal display approach. [00358] In a configuration wherein light enters the pupil with a small exit pupil, such as 1/2 mm diameter or less, one has the equivalent of a pinhole lens configuration wherein the beam is always interpreted as in-focus by the eyes/brain— e.g., a scanned light display using a 0.5 mm diameter beam to scan images to the eye. Such a configuration is known as a Maxwellian view configuration, and in one embodiment, accommodation tracking input may be utilized to induce blur using software to image information that is to be perceived as at a focal plane behind or in front of the focal plane determined from the accommodation tracking. In other words, if one starts with a display presenting a Maxwellian view, then everything theoretically can be in focus, and to provide a rich and natural three-dimensional perception, simulated dioptric blur may be induced with software, and may be slaved to the accommodation tracking status.

[00359] In one embodiment a scanning fiber display is well suited to such configuration because it may be configured to only output small-diameter beams in a Maxwellian form. In another embodiment, an array of small exit pupils may be created to increase the functional eye box of the system (and also to reduce the impact of a light-blocking particle which may reside in the vitreous or cornea of the eye), such as by one or more scanning fiber displays, or by a DOE configuration such as that described in reference to Figure 8K, with a pitch in the array of presented exit pupils that ensure that only one will hit the anatomical pupil of the user at any given time (for example, if the average anatomical pupil diameter is 4mm, one configuration may comprise 1/2 mm exit pupils spaced at intervals of approximate 4mm apart). Such exit pupils may also be switchable in response to eye position, such that only the eye always receives one, and only one, active small exit pupil at a time; allowing a denser array of exit pupils. Such user will have a large depth of focus to which software-based blur techniques may be added to enhance perceived depth perception.

[00360] As discussed above, an object at optical infinity creates a substantially planar wavefront; an object closer, such as 1 m away from the eye, creates a curved wavefront (with about 1 m convex radius of curvature). The eye's optical system needs to have enough optical power to bend the incoming rays of light so that they end up focused on the retina (convex wavefront gets turned into concave, and then down to a focal point on the retina). These are basic functions of the eye.

[00361 ] In many of the embodiments described above, light directed to the eye has been treated as being part of one continuous wavefront, some subset of which would hit the pupil of the particular eye. In another approach, light directed to the eye may be effectively discretized or broken down into a plurality of beamlets or individual rays, each of which has a diameter less than about 0.5mm and a unique propagation pathway as part of a greater aggregated wavefront that may be functionally created with the an aggregation of the beamlets or rays. For example, a curved wavefront may be approximated by aggregating a plurality of discrete neighboring collimated beams, each of which is approaching the eye from an appropriate angle to represent a point of origin that matches the center of the radius of curvature of the desired aggregate wavefront.

[00362] When the beamlets have a diameter of about 0.5mm or less, it is as though it is coming through a pinhole lens configuration, which means that each individual beamlet is always in relative focus on the retina, independent of the accommodation state of the eye— however the trajectory of each beamlet will be affected by the accommodation state. For instance, if the beamlets approach the eye in parallel, representing a discretized collimated aggregate wavefront, then an eye that is correctly accommodated to infinity will deflect the beamlets to all converge upon the same shared spot on the retina, and will appear in focus. If the eye accommodates to, say, 1 m, the beams will be converged to a spot in front of the retina, cross paths, and fall on multiple neighboring or partially overlapping spots on the retina— appearing blurred.

[00363] If the beamlets approach the eye in a diverging configuration, with a shared point of origin 1 meter from the viewer, then an accommodation of 1 m will steer the beams to a single spot on the retina, and will appear in focus; if the viewer accommodates to infinity, the beamlets will converge to a spot behind the retina, and produce multiple neighboring or partially overlapping spots on the retina, producing a blurred image. Stated more generally, the accommodation of the eye determines the degree of overlap of the spots on the retina, and a given pixel is "in focus" when all of the spots are directed to the same spot on the retina and "defocused" when the spots are offset from one another. This notion that all of the 0.5mm diameter or less beamlets are always in focus, and that they may be aggregated to be perceived by the eyes/brain as though they are substantially the same as coherent wavefronts, may be utilized in producing configurations for comfortable three-dimensional virtual or augmented reality perception.

[00364] In other words, a set of multiple narrow beams may be used to emulate what is going on with a larger diameter variable focus beam, and if the beamlet diameters are kept to a maximum of about 0.5mm, then they maintain a relatively static focus level, and to produce the perception of out-of-focus when desired, the beamlet angular trajectories may be selected to create an effect much like a larger out-of-focus beam (such a defocussing treatment may not be the same as a Gaussian blur treatment as for the larger beam, but will create a multimodal point spread function that may be interpreted in a similar fashion to a Gaussian blur).

[00365] In a preferred embodiment, the beamlets are not mechanically deflected to form this aggregate focus effect, but rather the eye receives a superset of many beamlets that includes both a multiplicity of incident angles and a multiplicity of locations at which the beamlets intersect the pupil; to represent a given pixel from a particular viewing distance, a subset of beamlets from the superset that comprise the appropriate angles of incidence and points of intersection with the pupil (as if they were being emitted from the same shared point of origin in space) are turned on with matching color and intensity, to represent that aggregate wavefront, while beamlets in the superset that are inconsistent with the shared point of origin are not turned on with that color and intensity (but some of them may be turned on with some other color and intensity level to represent, e.g., a different pixel).

[00366] Referring to Figure 1 1A, each of a multiplicity of incoming beamlets (332) is passing through a small exit pupil (330) relative to the eye (58) in a discretized wavefront display configuration. Referring to Figure 1 1 B, a subset (334) of the group of beamlets (332) may be driven with matching color and intensity levels to be perceived as though they are part of the same larger-sized ray (the bolded subgroup 334 may be deemed an "aggregated beam"). In this case, the subset of beamlets are parallel to one another, representing a collimated aggregate beam from optical infinity (such as light coming from a distant mountain). The eye is accommodated to infinity, so the subset of beamlets are deflected by the eye's cornea and lens to all fall substantially upon the same location of the retina and are perceived to comprise a single in focus pixel.

[00367] Figure 1 1 C shows another subset of beamlets representing an aggregated collimated beam (336) coming in from the right side of the field of view of the user's eye (58) if the eye (58) is viewed in a coronal-style planar view from above. Again, the eye is shown accommodated to infinity, so the beamlets fall on the same spot of the retina, and the pixel is perceived to be in focus. If, in contrast, a different subset of beamlets were chosen that were reaching the eye as a diverging fan of rays, those beamlets would not fall on the same location of the retina (and be perceived as in focus) until the eye were to shift accommodation to a near point that matches the geometrical point of origin of that fan of rays.

[00368] As regards patterns of points of intersection of beamlets with the anatomical pupil of the eye (i.e., the pattern of exit pupils), they may be organized in configurations such as a cross-sectionally efficient hex-lattice (for example, as shown in Figure 12A) or a square lattice or other two-dimensional array. Further, a three-dimensional array of exit pupils could be created, as well as time-varying arrays of exit pupils.

[00369] Discretized aggregate wavefronts may be created using several configurations, such as an array of microdisplays or microprojectors placed optically conjugate with the exit pupil of viewing optics, microdisplay or microprojector arrays coupled to a direct field of view substrate (such as an eyeglasses lens) such that they project light to the eye directly, without additional intermediate viewing optics, successive spatial light modulation array techniques, or waveguide techniques such as those described in relation to Figure 8K.

[00370] Referring to Figure 12A, in one embodiment, a lightfield may be created by bundling a group of small projectors or display units (such as scanned fiber displays). Figure 12A depicts a hexagonal lattice projection bundle (338) which may, for example, create a 7mm- diameter hex array with each fiber display outputting a sub-image (340). If such an array has an optical system, such as a lens, placed in front of it such that the array is placed optically conjugate with the eye's entrance pupil, this will create an image of the array at the eye's pupil, as shown in Figure 12B, which essentially provides the same optical arrangement as the embodiment of Figure 1 1 A.

[00371] Each of the small exit pupils of the configuration is created by a dedicated small display in the bundle (338), such as a scanning fiber display. Optically, it's as though the entire hex array (338) is positioned right into the anatomical pupil (45). Such embodiments are means for driving different subimages to different small exit pupils within the larger anatomical entrance pupil (45) of the eye, comprising a superset of beamlets with a multiplicity of incident angles and points of intersection with the eye pupil. Each of the separate projectors or displays may be driven with a slightly different image, such that subimages may be created that pull out different sets of rays to be driven at different light intensities and colors.

[00372] In one variation, a strict image conjugate may be created, as in the embodiment of Figure 12B, wherein there is direct 1 -to-1 mapping of the array (338) with the pupil (45). In another variation, the spacing may be changed between displays in the array and the optical system (lens 342, in Figure 12B) so that instead of getting a conjugate mapping of the array to the eye pupil, the eye pupil may be catching the rays from the array at some other distance. With such a configuration, one would still get an angular diversity of beams through which one could create a discretized aggregate wavefront representation, but the mathematics regarding how to drive which ray and at which power and intensity may become more complex (although, on the other hand, such a configuration may be considered simpler from a viewing optics perspective). The mathematics involved with light field image capture may be leveraged for these calculations.

[00373] Referring to Figure 13A, another lightfield creating embodiment is depicted wherein an array of microdisplays or microprojectors (346) may be coupled to a frame (344; such as an eyeglasses frame) to be positioned in front of the eye (58). The depicted configuration is a nonconjugate arrangement wherein there are no large-scale optical elements interposed between the displays (for example, scanning fiber displays) of the array (346) and the eye (58). One can imagine a pair of glasses, and coupled to those glasses are a plurality of displays, such as scanning fiber engines, positioned orthogonal to the eyeglasses surface, and all angled inward so they are pointing at the pupil of the user. Each display may be configured to create a set of rays representing different elements of the beamlet superset.

[00374] With such a configuration, at the anatomical pupil (45) the user is going to receive a similar result as received in the embodiments discussed in reference to Figure 1 1 A, in which every point at the user's pupil is receiving rays with a multiplicity of angles of incidence and points of intersection that are being contributed from the different displays. Figure 13B illustrates a nonconjugate configuration similar to that of Figure 13A, with the exception that the embodiment of Figure 13B features a reflecting surface (348) to facilitate moving the display array (346) away from the eye's (58) field of view, while also allowing views of the real world (144) through the reflective surface (348).

[00375] Thus another configuration for creating the angular diversity necessary for a discretized aggregate wavefront display is presented. To optimize such a configuration, the sizes of the displays may be decreased to the maximum. Scanning fiber displays which may be utilized as displays may have baseline diameters in the range of 1 mm, but reduction in enclosure and projection lens hardware may decrease the diameters of such displays to about 0.5mm or less, which is less disturbing for a user. Another downsizing geometric refinement may be achieved by directly coupling a collimating lens (which may, for example, comprise a gradient refractive index, or "GRIN", lens, a conventional curved lens, or a diffractive lens) to the tip of the scanning fiber itself in a case of a fiber scanning display array. For example, referring to Figure 13D, a GRIN lens (354) is shown fused to the end of a single mode optical fiber. An actuator (350; such as a piezoelectric actuator) is coupled to the fiber (352) and may be used to scan the fiber tip.

[00376] In another embodiment the end of the fiber may be shaped into a hemispherical shape using a curved polishing treatment of an optical fiber to create a lensing effect. In another embodiment a standard refractive lens may be coupled to the end of each optical fiber using an adhesive. In another embodiment a lens may be built from a dab of transmissive polymeric material or glass, such as epoxy. In another embodiment the end of an optical fiber may be melted to create a curved surface for a lensing effect.

[00377] Figure 13C-2 shows an embodiment wherein display configurations (i.e., scanning fiber displays with GRIN lenses; shown in close-up view of Figure 13C-1 ) such as that shown in Figure 13D may be coupled together through a single transparent substrate (356) preferably having a refractive index that closely matches the cladding of the optical fibers (352) so that the fibers themselves are not very visible for viewing of the outside world across the depicted assembly (if the index matching of the cladding is done precisely, then the larger

cladding/housing becomes transparent and only the tiny cores, which preferably are about 3 microns in diameter, will be obstructing the view. In one embodiment the matrix (358) of displays may all be angled inward so they are directed toward the anatomic pupil of the user (in another embodiment, they may stay parallel to each other, but such a configuration is less efficient).

[00378] Referring to Figure 13E, another embodiment is depicted wherein rather than using circular fibers to move cyclically, a thin series of planar waveguides (358) are configured to be cantilevered relative to a larger substrate structure (356). In one variation, the substrate (356) may be moved to produce cyclic motion (i.e., at the resonant frequency of the cantilevered members 358) of the planar waveguides relative to the substrate structure. In another variation, the cantilevered waveguide portions (358) may be actuated with piezoelectric or other actuators relative to the substrate. Image illumination information may be injected, for example, from the right side (360) of the substrate structure to be coupled into the cantilevered waveguide portions (358). In one embodiment the substrate (356) may comprise a waveguide configured (such as with an integrated DOE configuration as described above) to totally internally reflect incoming light (360) along its length and then redirect it to the cantilevered waveguide portions (358). As a person gazes toward the cantilevered waveguide portions (358) and through to the real world (144) behind, the planar waveguides are configured to minimize any dispersion and/or focus changes with their planar shape factors.

[00379] In the context of discussing discretized aggregate wavefront displays, there is value placed in having some angular diversity created for every point in the exit pupil of the eye. In other words, it is desirable to have multiple incoming beams to represent each pixel in a displayed image. Referring to Figures 13F-1 and 13F-2, one way to gain further angular and spatial diversity is to use a multicore fiber and place a lens at the exit point, such as a GRIN lens, so that the exit beams are deflected through a single nodal point (366); that nodal point may then be scanned back and forth in a scanned fiber type of arrangement (such as by a piezoelectric actuator 368). If a retinal conjugate is placed at the plane defined at the end of the GRIN lens, a display may be created that is functionally equivalent to the general case discretized aggregate wavefront configuration described above.

[00380] Referring to Figure 13G, a similar effect may be achieved not by using a lens, but by scanning the face of a multicore system at the correct conjugate of an optical system (372), the goal being to create a higher angular and spatial diversity of beams. In other words, rather than having a bunch of separately scanned fiber displays as in the bundled example of Figure 12A described above, some of this requisite angular and spatial diversity may be created through the use of multiple cores to create a plane which may be relayed by a waveguide. Referring to Figure 13H, a multicore fiber (362) may be scanned (such as by a piezoelectric actuator 368) to create a set of beamlets with a multiplicity of angles of incidence and points of intersection which may be relayed to the eye (58) by a waveguide (370). Thus in one embodiment a collimated lightfield image may be injected into a waveguide, and without any additional refocusing elements, that lightfield display may be translated directly to the human eye.

[00381] Figures 131-13L depict certain commercially available multicore fiber (362) configurations (from vendors such as Mitsubishi Cable Industries, Ltd. of Japan), including one variation (363) with a rectangular cross section, as well as variations with flat exit faces (372) and angled exit faces (374).

[00382] Referring to Figure 13M, some additional angular diversity may be created by having a waveguide (376) fed with a linear array of displays (378), such as scanning fiber displays.

[00383] Referring to Figures 14A-14F, another group of configurations for creating a fixed viewpoint lightfield display is described. Referring back to Figure 1 1 A, if a two-dimensional plane was created that was intersecting all of the tiny beams coming in from the left, each beamlet would have a certain point of intersection with that plane. If another plane was created at a different distance to the left, then all of the beamlets would intersect that plane at a different location. Then going back to Figure 14A, if various positions on each of two or more planes can be allowed to selectively transmit or block the light radiation directed through it, such a multi-planar configuration may be utilized to selectively create a lightfield by independently modulating individual beamlets.

[00384] The basic embodiment of Figure 14A shows two spatial light modulators, such as liquid crystal display panels (380, 382; in other embodiments they may be MEMS shutter displays or DLP DMD arrays) which may be independently controlled to block or transmit different rays on a high-resolution basis. For example, referring to Figure 14A, if the second panel (382) blocks or attenuates transmission of rays at point "a" (384), all of the depicted rays will be blocked; but if only the first panel (380) blocks or attenuates transmission of rays at point "b" (386), then only the lower incoming ray (388) will be blocked/attenuated, while the rest will be transmitted toward the pupil (45). Each of the controllable panels or planes may be deemed a "spatial light modulator" or "fatte". The intensity of each transmitted beam passed through a series of SLMs will be a function of the combination of the transparency of the various pixels in the various SLM arrays. Thus without any sort of lens elements, a set of beamlets with a multiplicity of angles and points of intersection (or a "lightfield") may be created using a plurality of stacked SLMs. Additional numbers of SLMs beyond two provides more opportunities to control which beams are selectively attenuated.

[00385] As noted briefly above, in addition to using stacked liquid crystal displays as SLMs, planes of DMD devices from DLP systems may be stacked to function as SLMs, and may be preferred over liquid crystal systems as SLMs due to their ability to more efficiently pass light (with a mirror element in a first state, reflectivity to the next element on the way to the eye may be quite efficient; with a mirror element in a second state, the mirror angle may be moved by an angle such as 12 degrees to direct the light away from the path to the eye). Referring to Figure 14B, in one DMD embodiment, two DMDs (390, 390) may be utilized in series with a pair of lenses (394, 396) in a periscope type of configuration to maintain a high amount of transmission of light from the real world (144) to the eye (58) of the user. The embodiment of Figure 14C provides six different DMD (402, 404, 406, 408, 410, 412) plane opportunities to intercede from an SLM functionality as beams are routed to the eye (58), along with two lenses (398, 400) for beam control.

[00386] Figure 14D illustrates a more complicated periscope type arrangement with up to four DMDs (422, 424, 426, 428) for SLM functionality and four lenses (414, 420, 416, 418); this configuration is designed to ensure that the image does not become flipped upside down as it travels through to the eye (58). Figure 14E illustrates in embodiment wherein light may be reflected between two different DMD devices (430, 432) without any intervening lenses (the lenses in the above designs are useful in such configurations for incorporating image information from the real world), in a hall-of-mirrors type of arrangement wherein the display may be viewed through the "hall of mirrors" and operates in a mode substantially similar to that illustrated in Figure 14A. Figure 14F illustrates an embodiment wherein a the non-display portions of two facing DMD chips (434, 436) may be covered with a reflective layer to propagate light to and from active display regions (438, 440) of the DMD chips. In other embodiments, in place of DMDs for SLM functionality, arrays of sliding MEMS shutters (such as those available from vendors such as Pixtronics, a division of Qualcomm, Inc.) may be utilized to either pass or block light. In another embodiment, arrays of small louvers that move out of place to present light-transmitting apertures may similarly be aggregated for SLM functionality.

[00387] A lightfield of many small beamlets (say, less than about 0.5mm in diameter) may be injected into and propagated through a waveguide or other optical system. For example, a conventional "birdbath" type of optical system may be suitable for transferring the light of a lightfield input, or a freeform optics design, as described below, or any number of waveguide configurations. Figures 15A-15C illustrate the use of a wedge type waveguide (442) along with a plurality of light sources as another configuration useful in creating a lightfield. Referring to Figure 15A, light may be injected into the wedge-shaped waveguide (442) from two different locations/displays (444, 446), and will emerge according to the total internal reflection properties of the wedge-shaped waveguide at different angles (448) based upon the points of injection into the waveguide.

[00388] Referring to Figure 15B, if one creates a linear array (450) of displays (such as scanning fiber displays) projecting into the end of the waveguide as shown, then a large angular diversity of beams (452) will be exiting the waveguide in one dimension, as shown in Figure 15C. Indeed, if one contemplates adding yet another linear array of displays injecting into the end of the waveguide but at a slightly different angle, then an angular diversity of beams may be created that exits similarly to the fanned out exit pattern shown in Figure 15C, but at an orthogonal axis; together these may be utilized to create a two-dimensional fan of rays exiting each location of the waveguide. Thus another configuration is presented for creating angular diversity to form a lightfield display using one or more scanning fiber display arrays (or alternatively using other displays which will meet the space requirements, such as miniaturized DLP projection configurations).

[00389] Alternatively, as an input to the wedge-shaped waveguides shown herein, a stack of SLM devices may be utilized, in which case rather than the direct view of SLM output as described above, the lightfield output from the SLM configuration may be used as an input to a configuration such as that shown in Figure 15C. One of the key concepts here is that while a conventional waveguide is best suited to relay beams of collimated light successfully, with a lightfield of small-diameter collimated beams, conventional waveguide technology may be utilized to further manipulate the output of such a lightfield system as injected into the side of a waveguide, such as a wedge-shaped waveguide, due to the beam size / collimation.

[00390] In another related embodiment, rather than projecting with multiple separate displays, a multicore fiber may be used to generate a lightfield and inject it into the waveguide. Further, a time-varying lightfield may be utilized as an input, such that rather than creating a static distribution of beamlets coming out of a lightfield, one may have some dynamic elements that are methodically changing the path of the set of beams. They may be done using components such as waveguides with embedded DOEs (e.g., such as those described above in reference to Figures 8B-8N, or liquid crystal layers, as described in reference to Figure 7B), wherein two optical paths are created (one smaller total internal reflection path wherein a liquid crystal layer is placed in a first voltage state to have a refractive index mismatch with the other substrate material that causes total internal reflection down just the other substrate material's waveguide; one larger total internal reflection optical path wherein the liquid crystal layer is placed in a second voltage state to have a matching refractive index with the other substrate material, so that the light totally internally reflects through the composite waveguide which includes both the liquid crystal portion and the other substrate portion). Similarly a wedge- shaped waveguide may be configured to have a bi-modal total internal reflection paradigm (for example, in one variation, wedge-shaped elements may be configured such that when a liquid crystal portion is activated, not only is the spacing changed, but also the angle at which the beams are reflected).

[00391] One embodiment of a scanning light display may be characterized simply as a scanning fiber display with a lens at the end of the scanned fiber. Many lens varieties are suitable, such as a GRIN lens, which may be used to collimate the light or to focus the light down to a spot smaller than the fiber's mode field diameter providing the advantage of producing a numerical aperture (or "NA") increase and circumventing the optical invariant, which is correlated inversely with spot size. Smaller spot size generally facilitates a higher resolution opportunity from a display perspective, which generally is preferred. In one embodiment, a GRIN lens may be long enough relative to the fiber that it may comprise the vibrating element (i.e., rather than the usual distal fiber tip vibration with a scanned fiber display) - a configuration which may be deemed a "scanned GRIN lens display".

[00392] In another embodiment, a diffractive lens may be utilized at the exit end of a scanning fiber display (i.e., patterned onto the fiber). In another embodiment, a curved mirror may be positioned on the end of the fiber that operates in a reflecting configuration. Essentially any of the configurations known to collimate and focus a beam may be used at the end of a scanning fiber to produce a suitable scanned light display.

[00393] Two significant utilities to having a lens coupled to or comprising the end of a scanned fiber (i.e., as compared to configurations wherein an uncoupled lens may be utilized to direct light after it exits a fiber) are a) the light exiting may be collimated to obviate the need to use other external optics to do so; b) the NA, or the angle of the cone at which light sprays out the end of the single-mode fiber core, may be increased, thereby decreasing the associated spot size for the fiber and increasing the available resolution for the display.

[00394] As described above, a lens such as a GRIN lens may be fused to or otherwise coupled to the end of an optical fiber or formed from a portion of the end of the fiber using techniques such as polishing. In one embodiment, a typical optical fiber with an NA of about 0.13 or 0.14 may have a spot size (also known as the "mode field diameter" for the optical fiber given the NA) of about 3 microns. This provides for relatively high resolution display possibilities given the industry standard display resolution paradigms (for example, a typical microdisplay technology such as LCD or organic light emitting diode, or "OLED" has a spot size of about 5 microns). Thus the aforementioned scanning light display may have 3/5 of the smallest pixel pitch available with a conventional display; further, using a lens at the end of the fiber, the aforementioned configuration may produce a spot size in the range of 1 -2 microns.

[00395] In another embodiment, rather than using a scanned cylindrical fiber, a cantilevered portion of a waveguide (such as a waveguide created using microfabrication processes such as masking and etching, rather than drawn microfiber techniques) may be placed into scanning oscillatory motion, and may be fitted with lensing at the exit ends.

[00396] In another embodiment, an increased numerical aperture for a fiber to be scanned may be created using a diffuser (i.e., one configured to scatter light and create a larger NA) covering the exit end of the fiber. In one variation, the diffuser may be created by etching the end of the fiber to create small bits of terrain that scatter light; in another variation a bead or sandblasting technique, or direct sanding/scuffing technique may be utilized to create scattering terrain. In another variation, an engineered diffuser, similar to a diffractive element, may be created to maintain a clean spot size with desirable NA, which ties into the notion of using a diffractive lens, as noted above.

[00397] Referring to Figure 16A, an array of optical fibers (454) is shown coupled in to a coupler (456) configured to hold them in parallel together so that their ends may be ground and polished to have an output edge at a critical angle (458; 42 degrees for most glass, for example) to the longitudinal axes of the input fibers, such that the light exiting the angled faces will exit as though it had been passing through a prism, and will bend and become nearly parallel to the surfaces of the polished faces. The beams exiting the fibers (454) in the bundle will become superimposed, but will be out of phase longitudinally due to the different path lengths (referring to Figure 16B, for example, the difference in path lengths from angled exit face to focusing lens for the different cores is visible). [00398] What was an X axis type of separation in the bundle before exit from the angled faces, will become a Z axis separation, a fact that is helpful in creating a multifocal light source from such a configuration. In another embodiment, rather than using a bundled/coupled plurality of single mode fibers, a multicore fiber, such as those available from Mitsubishi Cable Industries, Ltd. of Japan, may be angle polished.

[00399] In one embodiment, if a 45 degree angle is polished into a fiber and then covered with a reflective element, such as a mirror coating, the exiting light may be reflected from the polished surface and emerge from the side of the fiber (in one embodiment at a location wherein a flat-polished exit window has been created in the side of the fiber) such that as the fiber is scanned in what would normally be an X-Y Cartesian coordinate system axis, that fiber would now be functionally performing the equivalent of an X-Z scan, with the distance changing during the course of the scan. Such a configuration may be beneficially utilized to change the focus of the display as well.

[00400] Multicore fibers may be configured to play a role in display resolution enhancement (i.e., higher resolution). For example, in one embodiment, if separate pixel data is sent down a tight bundle of 19 cores in a multicore fiber, and that cluster is scanned around in a sparse spiral pattern with the pitch of the spiral being approximately equal to the diameter of the multicore, then sweeping around will effectively create a display resolution that is approximately 19x the resolution of a single core fiber being similarly scanned around. Indeed, it may be more practical to have the fibers more sparsely positioned relative to each other, as in the configuration of Figure 16C, which has 7 clusters (464; 7 is used for illustrative purposes because it is an efficient tiling/hex pattern; other patterns or numbers may be utilized; for example, a cluster of 19; the configuration is scalable up or down) of 3 fibers each housed within a conduit (462).

[00401] With a sparse configuration as shown in Figure 16C, scanning of the multicore scans each of the cores through its own local region, as opposed to a configuration wherein the cores are all packed tightly together and scanned (wherein cores end up overlapping with scanning; if the cores are too close to each other, the NA of the core is not large enough and the very closely packed cores end up blurring together somewhat and not creating as discriminable a spot for display). Thus, for resolution increases, it is preferable to have sparse tiling rather than highly dense tiling, although both will work.

[00402] The notion that densely packed scanned cores can create blurring at the display may be utilized as an advantage in one embodiment wherein a plurality (say a triad or cores to carry red, green, and blue light) of cores may be intentionally packed together densely so that each triad forms a triad of overlapped spots featuring red, green, and blue light. With such a configuration, one is able to have an RGB display without having to combine red, green, and blue into a single-mode core, which is an advantage, because conventional mechanisms for combining a plurality (such as three) wavelets of light into a single core are subject to significant losses in optical energy. Referring to Figure 16C, in one embodiment each tight cluster of 3 fiber cores contains one core that relays red light, one core that relays green light, and one core that relays blue light, with the 3 fiber cores close enough together that their positional differences are not resolvable by the subsequent relay optics, forming an effectively

superimposed RGB pixel; thus, the sparse tiling of 7 clusters produces resolution enhancement while the tight packing of 3 cores within the clusters facilitates seamless color blending without the need to utilize glossy RGB fiber combiners (e.g., those using wavelength division multiplexing or evanescent coupling techniques).

[00403] Referring to Figure 16D, in another more simple variation, one may have just one cluster (464) housed in a conduit (468) for, say, red/green/blue (and in another embodiment, another core may be added for infrared for uses such as eye tracking). In another embodiment, additional cores may be placed in the tight cluster to carrying additional wavelengths of light to comprise a multi-primary display for increased color gamut. Referring to Figure 16E, in another embodiment, a sparse array of single cores (470); in one variation with red, green, and blue combined down each of them) within a conduit (466) may be utilized; such a configuration is workable albeit somewhat less efficient for resolution increase, but not optimum for

red/green/blue combining.

[00404] Multicore fibers also may be utilized for creating lightfield displays. Indeed, rather than keeping the cores separated enough from each other so that the cores do not scan on each other's local area at the display panel, as described above in the context of creating a scanning light display, with a lightfield display, it is desirable to scan around a densely packed plurality of fibers because each of the beams produced represents a specific part of the lightfield. The light exiting from the bundled fiber tips can be relatively narrow if the fibers have a small NA; lightfield configurations may take advantage of this and have an arrangement in which at the anatomic pupil, a plurality of slightly different beams are being received from the array. Thus there are optical configurations with scanning a multicore that are functionally equivalent to an array of single scanning fiber modules, and thus a lightfield may be created by scanning a multicore rather than scanning a group of single mode fibers.

[00405] In one embodiment, a multi-core phased array approach may be used to create a large exit pupil variable wavefront configuration to facilitate three-dimensional perception. A single laser configuration with phase modulators is described above. In a multicore embodiment, phase delays may be induced into different channels of a multicore fiber, such that a single laser's light is injected into all of the cores of the multicore configuration so that there is mutual coherence.

[00406] In one embodiment, a multi-core fiber may be combined with a lens, such as a GRIN lens. Such lens may be, for example, a refractive lens, diffractive lens, or a polished edge functioning as a lens. The lens may be a single optical surface, or may comprise multiple optical surfaces stacked up. Indeed, in addition to having a single lens that extends the diameter of the multicore, a smaller lenslet array may be desirable at the exit point of light from the cores of the multicore, for example. Figure 16F shows an embodiment wherein a multicore fiber (470) is emitting multiple beams into a lens (472), such as a GRIN lens. The lens collects the beams down to a focal point (474) in space in front of the lens. In many conventional configurations, the beams would exit the multicore fiber as diverging. The GRIN or other lens is configured to function to direct them down to a single point and collimate them, such that the collimated result may be scanned around for a lightfield display, for instance.

[00407] Referring to Figure 16G, smaller lenses (478) may be placed in front of each of the cores of a multicore (476) configuration, and these lenses may be utilized to collimate; then a shared lens (480) may be configured to focus the collimated beams down to a diffraction limited spot (482) that is aligned for all of the three spots. The net result of such a configuration: by combining three collimated, narrow beams with narrow NA together as shown, one effectively combines all three into a much larger angle of emission which translates to a smaller spot size in, for example, a head mounted optical display system which may be next in the chain of light delivery to the user.

[00408] Referring to Figure 16H, one embodiment features a multicore fiber (476) with a lenslet (478) array feeding the light to a small prism array (484) that deflects the beams generated by the individual cores to a common point. Alternatively one may have the small lenslet array shifted relative to the cores such that the light is being deflected and focused down to a single point. Such a configuration may be utilized to increase the numerical aperture.

[00409] Referring to Figure 161, a two-step configuration is shown with a small lenslet (478) array capturing light from the multicore fiber (476), followed sequentially by a shared lens (486) to focus the beams to a single point (488). Such a configuration may be utilized to increase the numerical aperture. As discussed above, a larger NA corresponds to a smaller pixel size and higher possible display resolution. [00410] Referring to Figure 16J, a beveled fiber array which may be held together with a coupler (456), such as those described above, may be scanned with a reflecting device (494; such as a DMD module of a DLP system). With multiple single fibers (454) coupled into the array, or a multicore instead, the superimposed light can be directed through one or more focusing lenses (490, 492) to create a multifocal beam; with the superimposing and angulation of the array, the different sources are different distances from the focusing lens, which creates different focus levels in the beams as they emerge from the lens (492) and are directed toward the retina (54) of the eye (58) of the user. For example, the farthest optical route/beam may be set up to be a collimated beam representative of optical infinity focal positions. Closer routes/beams may be associated with diverging spherical wavefronts of closer focal locations.

[00411] The multifocal beam may be passed into a scanning mirror which may be configured to create a raster scan (or, for example, a Lissajous curve scan pattern or a spiral scan pattern) of the multifocal beam which may be passed through a series of focusing lenses and then to the cornea and crystalline lens of the eye. The various beams emerging from the lenses are creating different pixels or voxels of varying focal distances that are superimposed.

[00412] In one embodiment, one may write different data to each of the light modulation channels at the front end, thereby creating an image that is projected to the eye with one or more focus elements. By changing the focal distance of the crystalline lens (i.e., by accommodating), the user can bring different incoming pixels into and out of focus, as shown in Figures 16K and 16L wherein the crystalline lens is in different Z axis positions. In another embodiment, the fiber array may be actuated/moved around by a piezoelectric actuator. In another embodiment, a relatively thin ribbon array may be resonated in cantilevered form along the axis perpendicular to the arrangement of the array fibers (i.e., in the thin direction of the ribbon) when a piezoelectric actuator is activated. In one variation, a separate piezoelectric actuator may be utilized to create a vibratory scan in the orthogonal long axis. In another embodiment, a single mirror axis scan may be employed for a slow scan along the long axis while the fiber ribbon is vibrated resonantly.

[00413] Referring to Figure 16M, an array (496) of scanning fiber displays (498) may be beneficially bundled/tiled for an effective resolution increase, the notion being that with such as configuration, each scanning fiber of the bundle is configured to write to a different portion of the image plane (500), as shown, for example, in Figure 16N, wherein each portion of the image plane is addressed by the emissions from a least one bundle. In other embodiments, optical configurations may be utilized that allow for slight magnification of the beams as they exit the optical fiber so that there is some overlap in the hexagonal, or other lattice pattern, that hits the display plane, so there is a better fill factor while also maintaining an adequately small spot size in the image plane and understanding that there is a subtle magnification in that image plane.

[00414] Rather than having individual lenses at the end of each scanned fiber enclosure housing, in one embodiment a monolithic lenslet array may be utilized, so that the lenses can be as closely packed as possible, which allows for even smaller spot sizes in the image plane because one may use a lower amount of magnification in the optical system. Thus arrays of fiber scan displays may be used to increase the resolution of the display, or in other words, they may be used to increase the field of view of the display, because each engine is being used to scan a different portion of the field of view.

[00415] For a lightfield configuration, the emissions may be more desirably overlapped at the image plane. In one embodiment, a lightfield display may be created using a plurality of small diameter fibers scanned around in space. For example, instead of having all of the fibers address a different part of an image plane as described above, have more overlapping, more fibers angled inward, etc., or change the focal power of the lenses so that the small spot sizes are not conjugate with a tiled image plane configuration. Such a configuration may be used to create a lightfield display to scan lots of smaller diameter rays around that become intercepted in the same physical space.

[00416] Referring back to Figure 12B, it was discussed that one way of creating a lightfield display involves making the output of the elements on the left collimated with narrow beams, and then making the projecting array conjugate with the eye pupil on the right.

[00417] Referring to Figure 160, with a common substrate block (502), a single actuator may be utilized to actuate a plurality of fibers (506) in unison together. A similar configuration is discussed above in reference to Figures 13-C-1 and 13-C-2. It may be practically difficult to have all of the fibers retain the same resonant frequency, vibrate in a desirable phase relationship to each other, or have the same dimensions of cantilevering from the substrate block. To address this challenge, the tips of the fibers may be mechanically coupled with a lattice or sheet (504), such as a graphene sheet that is very thin, rigid, and light in weight. With such a coupling, the entire array may vibrate similarly and have the same phase relationship. In another embodiment a matrix of carbon nanotubes may be utilized to couple the fibers, or a piece of very thin planar glass (such as the kind used in creating liquid crystal display panels) may be coupled to the fiber ends. Further, a laser or other precision cutting device may be utilized to cut all associated fibers to the same cantilevered length. [00418] Referring to Figure 17, in one embodiment it may be desirable to have a contact lens directly interfaced with the cornea, and configured to facilitate the eye focusing on a display that is quite close (such as the typical distance between a cornea and an eyeglasses lens). Rather than placing an optical lens as a contact lens, in one variation the lens may comprise a selective filter. Figure 17 depicts a plot (508) what may be deemed a "notch filter", due to its design to block only certain wavelength bands, such as 450nm (peak blue), 530nm (green), and 650nm, and generally pass or transmit other wavelengths. In one embodiment several layers of dielectric coatings may be aggregated to provide the notch filtering functionality.

[00419] Such a filtering configuration may be coupled with a scanning fiber display that is producing a very narrow band illumination for red, green, and blue, and the contact lens with the notch filtering will block out all of the light coming from the display (such as a minidisplay, such as an OLED display, mounted in a position normally occupied by an eyeglasses lens) except for the transmissive wavelengths. A narrow pinhole may be created in the middle of the contact lens filtering layers/film such that the small aperture (i.e., less than about 1.5mm diameter) does allow passage of the otherwise blocked wavelengths. Thus a pinhole lens configuration is created that functions in a pinhole manner for red, green, and blue only to intake images from the minidisplay, while light from the real world, which generally is broadband illumination, will pass through the contact lens relatively unimpeded. Thus a large depth of focus virtual display configuration may be assembled and operated. In another embodiment, a collimated image exiting from a waveguide would be visible at the retina because of the pinhole large-depth-of-focus configuration.

[00420] It may be useful to create a display that can vary its depth of focus over time. For example, in one embodiment, a display may be configured to have different display modes that may be selected (preferably rapidly toggling between the two at the command of the operator) by an operator, such as a first mode combining a very large depth of focus with a small exit pupil diameter (i.e., so that everything is in focus all of the time), and a second mode featuring a larger exit pupil and a more narrow depth of focus. In operation, if a user is to play a three- dimensional video game with objects to be perceived at many depths of field, the operator may select the first mode; alternatively, if a user is to type in a long essay (i.e., for a relatively long period of time) using a two-dimensional word processing display configuration, it may be more desirable to switch to the second mode to have the convenience of a larger exit pupil, and a sharper image. [00421 ] In another embodiment, it may be desirable to have a multi-depth of focus display configuration wherein some subimages are presented with a large depth of focus while other subimages are presented with small depth of focus. For example, one configuration may have red wavelength and blue wavelength channels presented with a very small exit pupil so that they are always in focus. Then, a green channel only may be presented with a large exit pupil configuration with multiple depth planes (i.e., because the human accommodation system tends to preferentially target green wavelengths for optimizing focus level). Thus, in order to cut costs associated with having too many elements to represent with full depth planes in red, green, and blue, the green wavelength may be prioritized and represented with various different wavefront levels. Red and blue may be relegated to being represented with a more Maxwellian approach (and, as described above in reference to Maxwellian displays, software may be utilized to induce Gaussian levels of blur). Such a display would simultaneously present multiple depths of focus.

[00422] As described above, there are portions of the retina which have a higher density of light sensors. The fovea portion, for example, generally is populated with approximately 120 cones per visual degree. Display systems have been created in the past that use eye or gaze tracking as an input, and to save computation resources by only creating really high resolution rendering for where the person is gazing at the time, while lower resolution rendering is presented to the rest of the retina; the locations of the high versus low resolution portions may be dynamically slaved to the tracked gaze location in such a configuration, which may be termed a "foveated display".

[00423] An improvement on such configurations may comprise a scanning fiber display with pattern spacing that may be dynamically slaved to tracked eye gaze. For example, with a typical scanning fiber display operating in a spiral pattern, as shown in Figure 18 (the leftmost portion 510 of the image in Figure 18 illustrates a spiral motion pattern of a scanned multicore fiber 514; the rightmost portion 512 of the image in Figure 18 illustrates a spiral motion pattern of a scanned single fiber 516 for comparison), a constant pattern pitch provides for a uniform display resolution.

[00424] In a foveated display configuration, a non-uniform scanning pitch may be utilized, with smaller/tighter pitch (and therefore higher resolution) dynamically slaved to the detected gaze location. For example, if the user's gaze was detected as moving toward the edge of the display screen, the spirals may be clustered more densely in such location, which would create a toroid-type scanning pattern for the high-resolution portions, and the rest of the display being in a lower-resolution mode. In a configuration wherein gaps may be created in the portions of the display in a lower-resolution mode, blur could be intentionally dynamically created to smooth out the transitions between scans, as well as between transitions from high-resolution to lower-resolution scan pitch.

[00425] The term lightfield may be used to describe a volumetric 3-D representation of light traveling from an object to a viewer's eye. However, an optical see-through display can only reflect light to the eye, not the absence of light, and ambient light from the real world will add to any light representing a virtual object. That is, if a virtual object presented to the eye contains a black or very dark portion, the ambient light from the real world may pass through that dark portion and obscure that it was intended to be dark.

[00426] It is nonetheless desirable to be able to present a dark virtual object over a bright real background, and for that dark virtual object to appear to occupy a volume at a desired viewing distance; i.e., it is useful to create a "darkfield" representation of that dark virtual object, in which the absence of light is perceived to be located at a particular point in space. With regard to occlusion elements and the presentation of information to the eye of the user so that he or she can perceive darkfield aspects of virtual objects, even in well lighted actual environments, certain aspects of the aforementioned spatial light modulator, or "SLM", configurations are pertinent. As described above, with a light-sensing system such as the eye, one way to get selective perception of dark field to selectively attenuate light from such portions of the display, because the subject display systems are about manipulation and presentation of light; in other words, darkfield cannot be specifically projected - it's the lack of illumination that may be perceived as darkfield, and thus, configurations for selective attenuation of illumination have been developed.

[00427] Referring back to the discussion of SLM configurations, one way to selectively attenuate for a darkfield perception is to block all of the light coming from one angle, while allowing light from other angles to be transmitted. This may be accomplished with a plurality of SLM planes comprising elements such as liquid crystal (which may not be the most optimal due to its relatively low transparency when in the transmitting state), DMD elements of DLP systems (which have relative high transmission/reflection ratios when in such mode), and MEMS arrays or shutters that are configured to controllably shutter or pass light radiation, as described above.

[00428] With regard to suitable liquid crystal display ("LCD") configurations, a cholesteric LCD array may be utilized for a controlled occlusion/blocking array. As opposed to the conventional LCD paradigm wherein a polarization state is changed as a function of voltage, with a cholesteric LCD configuration, a pigment is being bound to the liquid crystal molecule, and then the molecule is physically tilted in response to an applied voltage. Such a

configuration may be designed to achieve greater transparency when in a transmissive mode than conventional LCD, and a stack of polarizing films is not needed as it is with conventional LCD.

[00429] In another embodiment, a plurality of layers of controllably interrupted patterns may be utilized to controllably block selected presentation of light using moire effects. For example, in one configuration, two arrays of attenuation patterns, each of which may comprise, for example, fine-pitched sine waves printed or painted upon a transparent planar material such as a glass substrate, may be presented to the eye of a user at a distance close enough that when the viewer looks through either of the patterns alone, the view is essentially transparent, but if the viewer looks through both patterns lined up in sequence, the viewer will see a spatial beat frequency moire attenuation pattern, even when the two attenuation patterns are placed in sequence relatively close to the eye of the user.

[00430] The beat frequency is dependent upon the pitch of the patterns on the two attenuation planes, so in one embodiment, an attenuation pattern for selectively blocking certain light transmission for darkfield perception may be created using two sequential patterns, each of which otherwise would be transparent to the user, but which together in series create a spatial beat frequency moire attenuation pattern selected to attenuate in accordance with the darkfield perception desired in the augmented reality system.

[00431] In another embodiment a controlled occlusion paradigm for darkfield effect may be created using a multi-view display style occluder. For example, one configuration may comprise one pin-holed layer that fully occludes with the exception of small apertures or pinholes, along with a selective attenuation layer in series, which may comprise an LCD, DLP system, or other selective attenuation layer configuration, such as those described above. In one scenario, with the pinhole array placed at a typical eyeglasses lens distance from the cornea (about 30mm), and with a selective attenuation panel located opposite the pinhole array from the eye, a perception of a sharp mechanical edge out in space may be created. In essence, if the configuration will allow certain angles of light to pass, and others to be blocked or occluded, than a perception of a very sharp pattern, such as a sharp edge projection, may be created. In another related embodiment, the pinhole array layer may be replaced with a second dynamic attenuation layer to provide a somewhat similar configuration, but with more controls than the static pinhole array layer (the static pinhole layer could be simulated, but need not be).

[00432] In another related embodiment, the pinholes may be replaced with cylindrical lenses. The same pattern of occlusion as in the pinhole array layer configuration may be achieved, but with cylindrical lenses, the array is not restricted to the very tiny pinhole geometries. To prevent the eye from being presented with distortions due to the lenses when viewing through to the real world, a second lens array may be added on the side of the aperture or lens array opposite of the side nearest the eye to compensate and provide the view-through illumination with basically a zero power telescope configuration.

[00433] In another embodiment, rather than physically blocking light for occlusion and creation of darkfield perception, the light may be bent or bounced, or a polarization of the light may be changed if a liquid crystal layer is utilized. For example, in one variation, each liquid crystal layer may act as a polarization rotator such that if a patterned polarizing material is incorporated on one face of a panel, then the polarization of individual rays coming from the real world may be selectively manipulated so they catch a portion of the patterned polarizer. There are polarizers known in the art that have checkerboard patterns wherein half of the "checker boxes" have vertical polarization and the other half have horizontal polarization. In addition, if a material such as liquid crystal is used in which polarization may be selectively manipulated, light may be selectively attenuated with this.

[00434] As described above, selective reflectors may provide greater transmission efficiency than LCD. In one embodiment, if a lens system is placed such that it takes light coming in from the real world and focuses a plane from the real world onto an image plane, and if a DMD (i.e., DLP technology) is placed at that image plane to reflect light when in an "on" state towards another set of lenses that pass the light to the eye, and those lenses also have the DMD at their focal length, the one may create an attenuation pattern that is in focus for the eye. In other words, DMDs may be used in a selective reflector plane in a zero magnification telescope configuration, such as is shown in Figure 19A, to controllably occlude and facilitate creating darkfield perception.

[00435] As shown in Figure 19A, a lens (518) is taking light from the real world (144) and focusing it down to an image plane (520); if a DMD (or other spatial attenuation device) (522) is placed at the focal length of the lens (i.e., at the image plane 520), the lens (518) is going to take whatever light is coming from optical infinity and focus that onto the image plane (520). Then the spatial attenuator (522) may be utilized to selectively block out things that are to be attenuated. Figure 19A shows the attenuator DMDs in the transmissive mode wherein they pass the beams shown crossing the device. The image is then placed at the focal length of the second lens (524). Preferably the two lenses (518, 524) have the same focal power so they end up being a zero-power telescope, or a "relay", that does not magnify views to the real world (144). Such a configuration may be used to present unmagnified views of the world while also allowing selective blocking/attenuation of certain pixels.

[00436] In another embodiment, as shown in Figures 19B and 19C, additional DMDs may be added such that light reflects from each of four DMDs (526, 528, 530, 532) before passing to the eye. Figure 19B shows an embodiment with two lenses preferably with the same focal power (focal length "F") placed at a 2F relationship from one another (the focal length of the first being conjugate to the focal length of the second) to have the zero-power telescope effect; Figure 19C shows an embodiment without lenses. The angles of orientation of the four reflective panels (526, 528, 530, 532) in the depicted embodiments of Figures 19B and 19C are shown to be around 45 degrees for simple illustration purposes, but specific relative orientation is required (for example, a typical DMD reflect at about a 12 degree angle).

[00437] In another embodiment, the panels may also be ferroelectric, or may be any other kind of reflective or selective attenuator panel or array. In one embodiment similar to those depicted in Figures 19B and 19C, one of the three reflector arrays may be a simple mirror, such that the other 3 are selective attenuators, thus still providing three independent planes to controllably occlude portions of the incoming illumination in furtherance of darkfield perception. By having multiple dynamic reflective attenuators in series, masks at different optical distances relative to the real world may be created.

[00438] Alternatively, referring back to Figure 19C, one may create a configuration wherein one or more DMDs are placed in a reflective periscope configuration without any lenses. Such a configuration may be driven in lightfield algorithms to selectively attenuate certain rays while others are passed.

[00439] In another embodiment, a DMD or similar matrix of controllably movable devices may be created upon a transparent substrate as opposed to a generally opaque substrate, for use in a transmissive configuration such as virtual reality.

[00440] In another embodiment, two LCD panels may be utilized as lightfield occluders. In one variation, they may be thought of as attenuators due to their attenuating capability as described above; alternatively they may be considered polarization rotators with a shared polarizer stack. Suitable LCDs may comprise components such as blue phase liquid crystal, cholesteric liquid crystal, ferroelectric liquid crystal, and/or twisted nematic liquid crystal.

[00441] One embodiment may comprise an array of directionally-selective occlusion elements, such as a MEMS device featuring a set of louvers that can change rotation such that they pass the majority of light that is coming from a particular angle, but are presenting more of a broad face to light that is coming from a different angle (somewhat akin to the manner in which plantation shutters may be utilized with a typical human scale window). The

MEMS/louvers configuration may be placed upon an optically transparent substrate, with the louvers substantially opaque. Ideally such a configuration would have a louver pitch fine enough to selectably occlude light on a pixel-by-pixel basis. In another embodiment, two or more layers or stacks of louvers may be combined to provide yet further controls. In another embodiment, rather than selectively blocking light, the louvers may be polarizers configured to change the polarization state of light on a controllably variable basis.

[00442] As described above, another embodiment for selective occlusion may comprise an array of sliding panels in a MEMS device such that the sliding panels may be controllably opened (i.e., by sliding in a planar fashion from a first position to a second position; or by rotating from a first orientation to a second orientation; or, for example, combined rotational reorientation and displacement) to transmit light through a small frame or aperture, and controllably closed to occlude the frame or aperture and prevent transmission. The array may be configured to open or occlude the various frames or apertures such that they maximally attenuate the rays that are to be attenuated, and only minimally attenuate the rays to be transmitted.

[00443] In an embodiment wherein a fixed number of sliding panels can either occupy a first position occluding a first aperture and opening a second aperture, or a second position occluding the second aperture and opening the first aperture, there will always be the same amount of light transmitted overall (because 50% of the apertures are occluded, and the other 50% are open, with such a configuration), but the local position changes of the shutters or doors may create targeted moire or other effects for darkfield perception with the dynamic positioning of the various sliding panels. In one embodiment, the sliding panels may comprise sliding polarizers, and if placed in a stacked configuration with other polarizing elements that are either static or dynamic, may be utilized to selectively attenuate.

[00444] Referring to Figure 19D, another configuration providing an opportunity for selective reflection, such as via a DMD style reflector array (534), is shown, such that a stacked set of two waveguides (536, 538) along with a pair of focus elements (540, 542) and a reflector (534; such as a DMD) may be used to capture a portion of incoming light with an entrance reflector (544). The reflected light may be totally internally reflected down the length of the first waveguide (536), into a focusing element (540) to bring the light into focus on a reflector (534) such as a DMD array, after which the DMD may selectively attenuate and reflect a portion of the light back through a focusing lens (542; the lens configured to facilitate injection of the light back into the second waveguide) and into the second waveguide (538) for total internal reflection down to an exit reflector (546) configured to exit the light out of the waveguide and toward the eye (58).

[00445] Such a configuration may have a relatively thin shape factor, and is designed to allow light from the real world (144) to be selectively attenuated. As waveguides work most cleanly with collimated light, such a configuration may be well suited for virtual reality configurations wherein focal lengths are in the range of optical infinity. For closer focal lengths, a lightfield display may be used as a layer on top of the silhouette created by the

aforementioned selective attenuation / darkfield configuration to provide other cues to the eye of the user that light is coming from another focal distance. An occlusion mask may be out of focus, even nondesirably so, and then in one embodiment, a lightfield on top of the masking layer may be used to hide the fact that the darkfield may be at the wrong focal distance.

[00446] Referring to Figure 19E, an embodiment is shown featuring two waveguides (552, 554) each having two angled reflectors (558, 544; 556, 546) for illustrative purposes shown at approximately 45 degrees; in actual configurations the angle may differ depending upon the reflective surface, reflective/refractive properties of the waveguides, etc.) directing a portion of light incoming from the real world down each side of a first waveguide (or down two separate waveguides if the top layer is not monolithic) such that it hits a reflector (548, 550) at each end, such as a DMD which may be used for selective attenuation, after which the reflected light may be injected back into the second waveguide (or into two separate waveguides if the bottom layer is not monolithic) and back toward two angled reflectors (again, they need not be at 45 degrees as shown) for exit out toward the eye (58).

[00447] Focusing lenses may also be placed between the reflectors at each end and the waveguides. In another embodiment the reflectors (548, 550) at each end may comprise standard mirrors (such as alumized mirrors). Further, the reflectors may be wavelength selective reflectors, such as dichroic mirrors or film interference filters. Further, the reflectors may be diffractive elements configured to reflect incoming light.

[00448] Figure 19F illustrates a configuration wherein four reflective surfaces in a pyramid type configuration are utilized to direct light through two waveguides (560, 562), in which incoming light from the real world may be divided up and reflected to four difference axes. The pyramid-shaped reflector (564) may have more than four facets, and may be resident within the substrate prism, as with the reflectors of the configuration of Figure 19E. The configuration of Figure 19F is an extension of that of Figure 19E. [00449] Referring to Figure 19G, a single waveguide (566) may be utilized to capture light from the world (144) with one or more reflective surfaces (574, 576, 578, 580, 582), relay it (570) to a selective attenuator (568; such as a DMD array), and recouple it back into the same waveguide so that it propagates (572) and encounters one or more other reflective surfaces (584, 586, 588, 590, 592) that cause it to at least partially exit (594) the waveguide on a path toward the eye (58) of the user. Preferably the waveguide comprises selective reflectors such that one group (574, 576, 578, 580, 582) may be switched on to capture incoming light and direct it down to the selective attenuator, while separate another group (584, 586, 588, 590, 592) may be switched on to exit light returning from the selective attenuator out toward the eye (58).

[00450] For simplicity the selective attenuator is shown oriented substantially perpendicularly to the waveguide; in other embodiments, various optics components, such as refractive or reflective optics, may be utilized to have the selective attenuator at a different and more compact orientation relative to the waveguide.

[00451] Referring to Figure 19H, a variation on the configuration described in reference to Figure 19D is illustrated. This configuration is somewhat analogous to that discussed above in reference to Figure 5B, wherein a switchable array of reflectors may be embedded within each of a pair of waveguides (602, 604). Referring to Figure 19H, a controller may be configured to turn the reflectors (598, 600) on and off in sequence, such that multiple reflectors may be operated on a frame sequential basis; then the DMD or other selective attenuator (594) may also be sequentially driven in sync with the different mirrors being turned on and off.

[00452] Referring to Figure 191, a pair of wedge-shaped waveguides similar to those described above (for example, in reference to Figures 15A-15C) are shown in side or sectional view to illustrate that the two long surfaces of each wedge-shaped waveguide (610, 612) are not co-planar. A "turning film" (606, 608; such as that available from 3M corporation under the trade name, "TRAF", which in essence comprises a microprism array), may be utilized on one or more surfaces of the wedge-shaped waveguides to either turn incoming rays at an angle so that they will be captured by total internal reflection, or to turn outgoing rays as they are exiting the waveguide toward an eye or other target. Incoming rays are directed down the first wedge and toward the selective attenuator (614) such as a DMD, LCD (such as a ferroelectric LCD), or an LCD stack to act as a mask).

[00453] After the selective attenuator (614), reflected light is coupled back into the second wedge-shaped waveguide which then relays the light by total internal reflection along the wedge. The properties of the wedge-shaped waveguide are intentionally such that each bounce of light causes an angle change; the point at which the angle has changed enough to be the critical angle to escape total internal reflection becomes the exit point from the wedge- shaped waveguide. Typically the exit will be at an oblique angle, so another layer of turning film may be used to "turn" the exiting light toward a targeted object such as the eye (58).

[00454] Referring to Figure 19J, several arcuate lenslet arrays (616, 620, 622) are positioned relative to an eye and configured such that a spatial attenuator array (618) is positioned at a focal/image plane so that it may be in focus with the eye (58). The first (616) and second (620) arrays are configured such that in the aggregate, light passing from the real world to the eye is essentially passed through a zero power telescope. The embodiment of Figure 19J shows a third array (622) of lenslets which may be utilized for improved optical compensation, but the general case does not require such a third layer. As discussed above, having telescopic lenses that are the diameter of the viewing optic may create an undesirably large form factor (somewhat akin to having a bunch of small sets of binoculars in front of the eyes).

[00455] One way to optimize the overall geometry is to reduce the diameter of the lenses by splitting them out into smaller lenslets, as shown in Figure 19J (i.e., an array of lenses rather than one single large lens). The lenslet arrays (616, 620, 622) are shown wrapped radially or arcuately around the eye (58) to ensure that beams incoming to the pupil are aligned through the appropriate lenslets (else the system may suffer from optical problems such as dispersion, aliasing, and/or lack of focus). Thus all of the lenslets are oriented "toed in" and pointed at the pupil of the eye (58), and the system facilitates avoidance of scenarios wherein rays are propagated through unintended sets of lenses en route to the pupil.

[00456] Referring to Figures 19K-19N, various software approaches may be utilized to assist in the presentation of darkfield in a virtual or augmented reality displace scenario. Referring to Figure 19K, a typical challenging scenario for augmented reality is depicted (632), with a textured carpet (624) and non-uniform background architectural features (626), both of which are lightly-colored. The black box (628) depicted indicates the region of the display in which one or more augmented reality features are to be presented to the user for three-dimensional perception, and in the black box a robot creature (630) is being presented that may, for example, be part of an augmented reality game in which the user is engaged. In the depicted example, the robot character (630) is darkly-colored, which makes for a challenging

presentation in three-dimensional perception, particularly with the background selected for this example scenario. [00457] As discussed briefly above, one of the main challenges for a presenting darkfield augmented reality object is that the system generally cannot add or paint in "darkness";

generally the display is configured to add light. Thus, referring to Figure 19L, without any specialized software treatments to enhance darkfield perception, presentation of the robot character in the augmented reality view results in a scene wherein portions of the robot character that are to be essentially flat black in presentation are not visible, and portions of the robot character that are to have some lighting (such as the lightly-pigmented cover of the shoulder gun of the robot character) are only barely visible (634) - they appear almost like a light grayscale disruption to the otherwise normal background image.

[00458] Referring to Figure 19M, using a software-based global attenuation treatment (akin to digitally putting on a pair of sunglasses) provides enhanced visibility to the robot character because the brightness of the nearly black robot character is effectively increased relative to the rest of the space, which now appears more dark (640). Also shown in Figure 19M is a digitally-added light halo (636) which may be added to enhance and distinguish the now-more- visible robot character shapes (638) from the background. With the halo treatment, even the portions of the robot character that are to be presented as flat black become visible with the contrast to the white halo, or "aura" presented around the robot character.

[00459] Preferably the halo may be presented to the user with a perceived focal distance that is behind the focal distance of the robot character in three-dimensional space. In a configuration wherein single panel occlusion techniques such as those described above is being utilized to present darkfield, the light halo may be presented with an intensity gradient to match the dark halo that may accompany the occlusion, minimizing the visibility of either darkfield effect. Further, the halo may be presented with blurring to the background behind the presented halo illumination for further distinguishing effect. A more subtle aura or halo effect may be created by matching, at least in part, the color and/or brightness of a relatively light- colored background.

[00460] Referring to Figure 19N, some or all of the black intonations of the robot character may be changed to dark, cool blue colors to provide a further distinguishing effect relative to the background, and relatively good visualization of the robot (642).

[00461] Wedge-shaped waveguides have been described above, such as in reference to Figures 15A-15D and Figure 191. With a wedge-shaped waveguide, every time a ray bounces off of one of the non-coplanar surfaces, it gets an angle change, which ultimately results in the ray exiting total internal reflection when its approach angle to one of the surfaces goes past the critical angle. Turning films may be used to redirect exiting light so that exiting beams leave with a trajectory that is more or less perpendicular to the exit surface, depending upon the geometric and ergonomic issues at play.

[00462] With a series or array of displays injecting image information into a wedge-shaped waveguide, as shown in Figure 15C, for example, the wedge-shaped waveguide may be configured to create a fine-pitched array of angle-biased rays emerging from the wedge.

Somewhat similarly, it has been discussed above that a lightfield display, or a variable wavefront creating waveguide, both may produce a multiplicity of beamlets or beams to represent a single pixel in space such that wherever the eye is positioned, the eye is hit by a plurality of different beamlets or beams that are unique to that particular eye position in front of the display panel.

[00463] As was further discussed above in the context of lightfield displays, a plurality of viewing zones may be created within a given pupil, and each may be used for a different focal distance, with the aggregate producing a perception similar to that of a variable wavefront creating waveguide, or similar to the actual optical physics of reality of the objects viewed were real. Thus a wedge-shaped waveguide with multiple displays may be utilized to generate a lightfield. In an embodiment similar to that of Figure 15C with a linear array of displays injecting image information, a fan of exiting rays is created for each pixel. This concept may be extended in an embodiment wherein multiple linear arrays are stacked to all inject image information into the wedge-shaped waveguide (in one variation, one array may inject at one angle relative to the wedge-shaped waveguide face, while the second array may inject at a second angle relative to the wedge-shaped waveguide face), in which case exit beams fan out at two different axes from the wedge.

[00464] Thus such a configuration may be utilized to produce pluralities of beams spraying out at lots of different angles, and each beam may be driven separately due to the fact that under such configuration, each beam is driven using a separate display. In another embodiment, one or more arrays or displays may be configured to inject image information into wedge-shaped waveguide through sides or faces of the wedge-shaped waveguide other than that shown in Figure 15C, such as by using a diffractive optic to bend injected image information into total an internal reflection configuration relative to the wedge-shaped waveguide.

[00465] Various reflectors or reflecting surfaces may also be utilized in concert with such a wedge-shaped waveguide embodiment to outcouple and manage light from the wedge-shaped waveguide. In one embodiment, an entrance aperture to a wedge-shaped waveguide, or injection of image information through a different face other than shown in Figure 15C, may be utilized to facilitate staggering (geometric and/or temporal) of different displays and arrays such that a Z-axis delta may also be developed as a means for injecting three-dimensional information into the wedge-shaped waveguide. For a greater than three-dimensions array configuration, various displays may be configured to enter a wedge-shaped waveguide at multiple edges in multiple stacks with staggering to get higher dimensional configurations.

[00466] Referring to Figure 20A, a configuration similar to that depicted in Figure 8H is shown wherein a waveguide (646) has a diffractive optical element (648; or "DOE", as noted above) sandwiched in the middle (alternatively, as described above, the diffractive optical element may reside on the front or back face of the depicted waveguide). A ray may enter the waveguide (646) from the projector or display (644). Once in the waveguide (646), each time the ray intersects the DOE (648), part of it is exited out of the waveguide (646). As described above, the DOE may be designed such that the exit illuminance across the length of the waveguide (646) is somewhat uniform (for example, the first such DOE intersection may be configured to exit about 10% of the light; then the second DOE intersection may be configured to exit about 10% of the remaining light so that 81 % is passed on, and so on; in another embodied a DOE may be designed to have a variable diffraction efficiency, such as linearly- decreasing diffraction efficiency, along its length to map out a more uniform exit illuminance across the length of the waveguide).

[00467] To further distribute remaining light that reaches an end (and in one embodiment to allow for selection of a relatively low diffraction efficiency DOE which would be favorable from a view-to-the-world transparency perspective), a reflective element (650) at one or both ends may be included. Further, referring to the embodiment of Figure 20B, additional distribution and preservation may be achieved by including an elongate reflector (652) across the length of the waveguide as shown (comprising, for example, a thin film dichroic coating that is wavelength- selective); preferably such reflector would be blocking light that accidentally is reflected upward (back toward the real world 144 for exit in a way that it would not be utilized by the viewer). In some embodiments, such an elongate reflector may contribute to a "ghosting" effect perception by the user.

[00468] In one embodiment, this ghosting effect may be eliminated by having a dual- waveguide (646, 654) circulating reflection configuration, such as that shown in Figure 20C, which is designed to keep the light moving around until it has been exited toward the eye (58) in a preferably substantially equally distributed manner across the length of the waveguide assembly. Referring to Figure 20C, light may be injected with a projector or display (644), and as it travels across the DOE (656) of the first waveguide (654), it ejects a preferably substantially uniform pattern of light out toward the eye (58); light that remains in the first waveguide is reflected by a first reflector assembly (660) into the second waveguide (646). In one embodiment, the second waveguide (646) may be configured to not have a DOE, such that it merely transports or recycles the remaining light back to the first waveguide, using the second reflector assembly.

[00469] In another embodiment (as shown in Figure 20C) the second waveguide (646) may also have a DOE (648) configured to uniformly eject fractions of travelling light to provide a second plane of focus for three-dimensional perception. Unlike the configurations of Figures 20A and 20B, the configuration of Figure 20C is designed for light to travel the waveguide in one direction, which avoids the aforementioned ghosting problem that is related to passing light backwards through a waveguide with a DOE. Referring to Figure 20D, rather than having a mirror or box style reflector assembly (660) at the ends of a waveguide for recycling the light, an array of smaller retroreflectors (662), or a retroreflective material, may be utilized.

[00470] Referring to Figure 20E, an embodiment is shown that utilizes some of the light recycling configurations of the embodiment of Figure 20C to "snake" the light down through a waveguide (646) having a sandwiched DOE (648) after it has been injected with a display or projector (644) so that it crosses the waveguide (646) many times back and forth before reaching the bottom, at which point it may be recycled back up to the top level for further recycling. Such a configuration not only recycles the light and facilitates use of relatively low diffraction efficiency DOE elements for exiting light toward the eye (58), but also distributes the light, to provide for a large exit pupil configuration akin to that described in reference to Figure 8K.

[00471] Referring to Figure 20F, an illustrative configuration similar to that of Figure 5A is shown, with incoming light injected along a conventional prism or beamsplitter substrate (104) to a reflector (102) without total internal reflection (i.e., without the prism being considered a waveguide) because the input projection (106), scanning or otherwise, is kept within the bounds of the prism - which means that the geometry of such prism becomes a significant constraint. In another embodiment, a waveguide may be utilized in place of the simple prism of Figure 20F, which facilitates the use of total internal reflection to provide more geometric flexibility.

[00472] Other configurations describe above are configured to profit from the inclusion of waveguides for similar manipulations and light. For example, referring back to Figure 7A, the general concept illustrated therein is that a collimated image injected into a waveguide may be refocused before transfer out toward an eye, in a configuration also designed to facilitate viewing light from the real world. In place of the refractive lens shown in Figure 7A, a diffractive optical element may be used as a variable focus element.

[00473] Referring back to Figure 7B, another waveguide configuration is illustrated in the context of having multiple layers stacked upon each other with controllable access toggling between a smaller path (total internal reflection through a waveguide) and a larger path (total internal reflection through a hybrid waveguide comprising the original waveguide and a liquid crystal isolated region with the liquid crystal switched to a mode wherein the refractive indices are substantially matched between the main waveguide and the auxiliary waveguide), so that the controller can tune on a frame-by-frame basis which path is being taken. High-speed switching electro-active materials, such as lithium niobate, facilitate path changes with such a configuration at gigahertz rates, which allows one to change the path of light on a pixel-by-pixel basis.

[00474] Referring back to Figure 8A, a stack of waveguides paired with weak lenses is illustrated to demonstrate a multifocal configuration wherein the lens and waveguide elements may be static. Each pair of waveguide and lens may be functionally replaced with waveguide having an embedded DOE element (which may be static, in a closer analogy to the

configuration of Figure 8A, or dynamic), such as that described in reference to Figure 81.

[00475] Referring to Figure 20G, if a transparent prism or block (104; i.e., not a waveguide) is utilized to hold a mirror or reflector (102) in a periscope type of configuration to receive light from other components, such as a lens (662) and projector or display (644), the field of view is limited by the size of that reflector (102; the bigger the reflector, the wider the field of view). Thus to have a larger field of view with such configuration, a thicker substrate may be needed to hold a larger reflector; otherwise, the functionality of an aggregated plurality of reflectors may be utilized to increase the functional field of view, as described in reference to Figures 80, 8P, and 8Q. Referring to Figure 20H, a stack (664) of planar waveguides (666), each fed with a display or projector (644; or in another embodiment a multiplexing of a single display) and having an exit reflector (668), may be utilized to aggregate toward the function of a larger single reflector. The exit reflectors may be at the same angle in some cases, or not the same angle in other cases, depending upon the positioning of the eye (58) relative to the assembly.

[00476] Figure 20I illustrates a related configuration, wherein the reflectors (680, 682, 684, 686, 688) in each of the planar waveguides (670, 672, 674, 676, 678) have been offset from each other, and wherein each takes in light from a projector or display (644) which may be sent through a lens (690) to ultimately contribute exiting light to the pupil (45) of the eye (58) by virtue of the reflectors (680, 682, 684, 686, 688) in each of the planar waveguides (670, 672, 674, 676, 678). If one can create a total range of all of the angles that would be expected to be seen in the scene (i.e., preferably without blind spots in the key field of view), then a useful field of view has been achieved. As described above, the eye (58) functions based at least on what angle light rays enter the eye, and this can be simulated. The rays need not pass through the exact same point in space at the pupil - rather the light rays just need to get through the pupil and be sensed by the retina. Figure 20K illustrates a variation wherein the shaded portion of the optical assembly may be utilized as a compensating lens to functionally pass light from the real world (144) through the assembly as though it has been passed through a zero power telescope.

[00477] Referring to Figure 20J, each of the aforementioned rays may also be a relative wide beam that is being reflected through the pertinent waveguide (670, 672) by total internal reflection. The reflector (680, 682) facet size will determine what the exiting beam width can be.

[00478] Referring to Figure 20L, a further discretization of the reflector is shown, wherein a plurality of small straight angular reflectors may form a roughly parabolic reflecting surface (694) in the aggregate through a waveguide or stack thereof (696). Light coming in from the displays (644; or single MUXed display, for example), such as through a lens (690), is all directed toward the same shared focal point at the pupil (45) of the eye (58).

[00479] Referring back to Figure 13M, a linear array of displays (378) injects light into a shared waveguide (376). In another embodiment a single display may be multiplexed to a series of entry lenses to provide similar functionality as the embodiment of Figure 13M, with the entry lenses creating parallel paths of rays running through the waveguide.

[00480] In a conventional waveguide approach wherein total internal reflection is relied upon for light propagation, the field of view is restricted because there is only a certain angular range of rays propagating through the waveguide (others may escape out). In one embodiment, if a red/green/blue (or "RGB") laserline reflector is placed at one or both ends of the planar surfaces, akin to a thin film interference filter that is highly reflective for only certain

wavelengths and poorly reflective for other wavelengths, than one can functionally increase the range of angles of light propagation. Windows (without the coating) may be provided for allowing light to exit in predetermined locations. Further, the coating may be selected to have a directional selectivity (somewhat like reflective elements that are only highly reflective for certain angles of incidence). Such a coating may be most relevant for the larger planes/sides of a waveguide. [00481] Referring back to Figure 13E, a variation on a scanning fiber display was discussed, which may be deemed a scanning thin waveguide configuration, such that a plurality of very thin planar waveguides (358) may be oscillated or vibrated such that if a variety of injected beams is coming through with total internal reflection, the configuration functionally would provide a linear array of beams escaping out of the edges of the vibrating elements (358). The depicted configuration has approximately five externally-projecting planar waveguide portions (358) in a host medium or substrate (356) that is transparent, but which preferably has a different refractive index so that the light will stay in total internal reflection within each of the substrate-bound smaller waveguides that ultimately feed (in the depicted embodiment there is a 90 degree turn in each path at which point a planar, curved, or other reflector may be utilized to bounce the light outward) the externally-projecting planar waveguide portions (358).

[00482] The externally-projecting planar waveguide portions (358) may be vibrated individually, or as a group along with oscillatory motion of the substrate (356). Such scanning motion may provide horizontal scanning, and for vertical scanning, the input (360) aspect of the assembly (i.e., such as one or more scanning fiber displays scanning in the vertical axis) may be utilized. Thus a variation of the scanning fiber display is presented.

[00483] Referring back to Figure 13H, a waveguide (370) may be utilized to create a lightfield. With waveguides working best with collimated beams that may be associated with optical infinity from a perception perspective, all beams staying in focus may cause perception discomfort (i.e., the eye will not make a discernible difference in dioptric blur as a function of accommodation; in other words, the narrow diameter, such as 0.5mm or less, collimated beamlets may open loop the eye's accommodation/vergence system, causing discomfort).

[00484] In one embodiment, a single beam may be fed in with a number of cone beamlets coming out, but if the introduction vector of the entering beam is changed (i.e., laterally shift the beam injection location for the projector/display relative to the waveguide), one may control where the beam exits from the waveguide as it is directed toward the eye. Thus one may use a waveguide to create a lightfield by creating a bunch of narrow diameter collimated beams, and such a configuration is not reliant upon a true variation in a light wavefront to be associated with the desired perception at the eye.

[00485] If a set of angularly and laterally diverse beamlets is injected into a waveguide (for example, by using a multicore fiber and driving each core separately; another configuration may utilize a plurality of fiber scanners coming from different angles; another configuration may utilize a high-resolution panel display with a lenslet array on top of it), a number of exiting beamlets can be created at different exit angles and exit locations. Since the waveguide may scramble the lightfield, the decoding is preferably predetermined.

[00486] Referring to Figures 20M and 20N, a waveguide (646) assembly (696) is shown that comprises stacked waveguide components in the vertical or horizontal axis. Rather than having one monolithic planar waveguide, the notion with these embodiments is to stack a plurality of smaller waveguides (646) immediately adjacent each other such that light introduced into one waveguide, in addition to propagating down (i.e., propagating along a Z axis with total internal reflection in +X,-X) such waveguide by total internal reflection, also totally internally reflects in the perpendicular axis (+y, -Y) as well, such that it is not spilling into other areas. In other words, if total internal reflection is from left to right and back during Z axis propagation, the configuration will be set up to totally internally reflect any light that hits the top or bottom sides as well; each layer may be driven separately without interference from other layers. Each waveguide may have a DOE (648) embedded and configured to eject out light with a predetermined distribution along the length of the waveguide, as described above, with a predetermined focal length configuration (shown in Figure 20M as ranging from 0.5 meters to optical infinity).

[00487] In another variation, a very dense stack of waveguides with embedded DOEs may be produced such that it spans the size of the anatomical pupil of the eye (i.e., such that multiple layers 698 of the composite waveguide are required to cross the exit pupil, as illustrated in Figure 20N). With such a configuration, one may feed a collimated image for one wavelength, and then the portion located the next millimeter down producing a diverging wavefront that represents an object coming from a focal distance of, say, 15 meters away, and so on, with the notion being that an exit pupil is coming from a number of different waveguides as a result of the DOEs and total internal reflection through the waveguides and across the DOEs. Thus rather than creating one uniform exit pupil, such a configuration creates a plurality of stripes that, in the aggregate, facilitate the perception of different focal depths with the eye/brain.

[00488] Such a concept may be extended to configurations comprising a waveguide with a switchable/controllable embedded DOE (i.e. that is switchable to different focal distances), such as those described in relation to Figures 8B-8N, which allows more efficient light trapping in the axis across each waveguide. Multiple displays may be coupled into each of the layers, and each waveguide with DOE would emit rays along its own length. In another embodiment, rather than relying on total internal reflection, a laserline reflector may be used to increase angular range. In between layers of the composite waveguide, a completely reflective metallized coating may be utilized, such as aluminum, to ensure total reflection, or alternatively dichroic style or narrow band reflectors may be utilized.

[00489] Referring to Figure 20O, the whole composite waveguide assembly (696) maybe be curved concavely toward the eye (58) such that each of the individual waveguides is directed toward the pupil. In other words, the configuration may be designed to more efficiently direct the light toward the location where the pupil is likely to be present. Such a configuration also may be utilized to increase the field of view.

[00490] As was discussed above in relation to Figures 8L, 8M, and 8N, a changeable diffraction configuration allows for scanning in one axis, somewhat akin to a scanning light display. Figure 21A illustrates a waveguide (698) having an embedded (i.e., sandwiched within) DOE (700) with a linear grating term that may be changed to alter the exit angle of exiting light (702) from the waveguide, as shown. A high-frequency switching DOE material such as lithium niobate may be utilized. In one embodiment, such a scanning configuration may be used as the sole mechanism for scanning a beam in one axis; in another embodiment, the scanning configuration may be combined with other scanning axes, and may be used to create a larger field of view (i.e., if a normal field of view is 40 degrees, and by changing the linear diffraction pitch one can steer over another 40 degrees, the effective usable field of view for the system is 80 degrees).

[00491] Referring to Figure 21 B, in a conventional configuration, a waveguide (708) may be placed perpendicular to a panel display (704), such as an LCD or OLED panel, such that beams may be injected from the waveguide (708), through a lens (706), and into the panel (704) in a scanning configuration to provide a viewable display for television or other purposes. Thus the waveguide may be utilized in such configuration as a scanning image source, in contrast to the configurations described in reference to Figure 21 A, wherein a single beam of light may be manipulated by a scanning fiber or other element to sweep through different angular locations, and in addition, another direction may be scanned using the high-frequency diffractive optical element.

[00492] In another embodiment, a uniaxial scanning fiber display (say scanning the fast line scan, as the scanning fiber is relatively high frequency) may be used to inject the fast line scan into the waveguide, and then the relatively slow DOE switching (i.e., in the range of 100 Hz) may be used to scan lines in the other axis to form an image.

[00493] In another embodiment, a DOE with a grating of fixed pitch may be combined with an adjacent layer of electro-active material having a dynamic refractive index (such as liquid crystal), so that light may be redirected into the grating at different angles. This is an application of the basic multipath configuration described above in reference to Figure 7B, in which an electro-active layer comprising an electro-active material such as liquid crystal or lithium niobate may change its refractive index such that it changes the angle at which a ray emerges from the waveguide. A linear diffraction grating may be added to the configuration of Figure 7B (in one embodiment, sandwiched within the glass or other material comprising the larger lower waveguide) such that the diffraction grating may remain at a fixed pitch, but the light is biased before it hits the grating.

[00494] Figure 21 C shows another embodiment featuring two wedge-like waveguide elements (710, 712), wherein one or more of them may be electro-active so that the related refractive index may be changed. The elements may be configured such that when the wedges have matching refractive indices, the light totally internally reflects through the pair (which in the aggregate performs akin to a planar waveguide with both wedges matching) while the wedge interfaces have no effect. Then if one of the refractive indices is changed to create a mismatch, a beam deflection at the wedge interface (714) is caused, and there is total internal reflection from that surface back into the associated wedge. Then a controllable DOE (716) with a linear grating may be coupled along one of the long edges of the wedge to allow light to exit out and reach the eye at a desirable exit angle.

[00495] In another embodiment, a DOE such as a Bragg grating, may be configured to change pitch versus time, such as by a mechanical stretching of the grating (for example, if the grating resides on or comprises an elastic material), a moire beat pattern between two gratings on two different planes (the gratings may be the same or different pitches), Z-axis motion (i.e., closer to the eye, or farther away from the eye) of the grating, which functionally is similar in effect to stretching of the grating, or electro-active gratings that may be switched on or off, such as one created using a polymer dispersed liquid crystal approach wherein liquid crystal droplets may be controllably activated to change the refractive index to become an active grating, versus turning the voltage off and allowing a switch back to a refractive index that matches that of the host medium.

[00496] In another embodiment, a time-varying grating may be utilized for field of view expansion by creating a tiled display configuration. Further, a time-varying grating may be utilized to address chromatic aberration (failure to focus all colors/wavelengths at the same focal point). One property of diffraction gratings is that they will deflect a beam as a function of its angle of incidence and wavelength (i.e., a DOE will deflect different wavelengths by different angles: somewhat akin to the manner in which a simple prism will divide out a beam into its wavelength components).

[00497] One may use time-varying grating control to compensate for chromatic aberration in addition to field of view expansion. Thus, for example, in a waveguide with embedded DOE type of configuration as described above, the DOE may be configured to drive the red wavelength to a slightly different place than the green and blue to address unwanted chromatic aberration. The DOE may be time-varied by having a stack of elements that switch on and off (i.e. to get red, green, and blue to be diffracted outbound similarly).

[00498] In another embodiment, a time-varying grating may be utilized for exit pupil expansion. For example, referring to Figure 21 D, it is possible that a waveguide (718) with embedded DOE (720) may be positioned relative to a target pupil such that none of the beams exiting in a baseline mode actually enter the target pupil (45) - such that the pertinent pixel would be missed by the user. A time-varying configuration may be utilized to fill in the gaps in the outbound exit pattern by shifting the exit pattern laterally (shown in dashed/dotted lines) to effectively scan each of the 5 exiting beams to better ensure that one of them hits the pupil of the eye. In other words, the functional exit pupil of the display system is expanded.

[00499] In another embodiment, a time-varying grating may be utilized with a waveguide for one, two, or three axis light scanning. In a manner akin to that described in reference to Figure 21 A, one may use a term in a grating that is scanning a beam in the vertical axis, as well as a grating that is scanning in the horizontal axis. Further, if radial elements of a grating are incorporated, as is discussed above in relation to Figures 8B-8N, one may have scanning of the beam in the Z axis (i.e., toward/away from the eye), all of which may be time sequential scanning.

[00500] Notwithstanding the discussions herein regarding specialized treatments and uses of DOEs generally in connection with waveguides, many of these uses of DOE are usable whether or not the DOE is embedded in a waveguide. For example, the output of a waveguide may be separately manipulated using a DOE; or a beam may be manipulated by a DOE before it is injected into a waveguide; further, one or more DOEs, such as a time-varying DOE, may be utilized as an input for freeform optics configurations, as discussed below.

[00501] As discussed above in reference to Figures 8B-8N, an element of a DOE may have a circularly-symmetric term, which may be summed with a linear term to create a controlled exit pattern (i.e., as described above, the same DOE that outcouples light may also focus it). In another embodiment, the circular term of the DOE diffraction grating may be varied such that the focus of the beams representing those pertinent pixels is modulated. In addition, one configuration may have a second/separate circular DOE, obviating the need to have a linear term in the DOE.

[00502] Referring to Figure 21 E, one may have a waveguide (722) outputting collimated light with no DOE element embedded, and a second waveguide that has a circularly-symmetric DOE that can be switched between multiple configurations - in one embodiment by having a stack (724) of such DOE elements (Figure 21 F shows another configuration wherein a functional stack 728 of DOE elements may comprise a stack of polymer dispersed liquid crystal elements 726, as described above, wherein without a voltage applied, a host medium refraction index matches that of a dispersed molecules of liquid crystal; in another embodiment, molecules of lithium niobate may be dispersed for faster response times; with voltage applied, such as through transparent indium tin oxide layers on either side of the host medium, the dispersed molecules change index of refraction and functionally form a diffraction pattern within the host medium) that can be switched on/off.

[00503] In another embodiment, a circular DOE may be layered in front of a waveguide for focus modulation. Referring to Figure 21 G, the waveguide (722) is outputting collimated light, which will be perceived as associated with a focal depth of optical infinity unless otherwise modified. The collimated light from the waveguide may be input into a diffractive optical element (730) which may be used for dynamic focus modulation (i.e., one may switch on and off different circular DOE patterns to impart various different focuses to the exiting light). In a related embodiment, a static DOE may be used to focus collimated light exiting from a waveguide to a single depth of focus that may be useful for a particular user application.

[00504] In another embodiment, multiple stacked circular DOEs may be used for additive power and many focus levels - from a relatively small number of switchable DOE layers. In other words, three different DOE layers may be switched on in various combinations relative to each other; the optical powers of the DOEs that are switched on may be added. In one embodiment wherein a range of up to 4 diopters is desired, for example, a first DOE may be configured to provide half of the total diopter range desired (in this example, 2 diopters of change in focus); a second DOE may be configured to induce a 1 diopter change in focus; then a third DOE may be configured to induce a 1/2 diopter change in focus. These three DOEs may be mixed and matched to provide ½, 1 , 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3, and 3.5 diopters of change in focus. Thus a super large number of DOEs would not be required to get a relatively broad range of control. [00505] In one embodiment, a matrix of switchable DOE elements may be utilized for scanning, field of view expansion, and/or exit pupil expansion. Generally in the above discussions of DOEs, it has been assume that a typical DOE is either all on or all off. In one variation, a DOE (732) may be subdivided into a plurality of functional subsections (such as the one labeled as element 734 in Figure 21 H), each of which preferably is uniquely controllable to be on or off (for example, referring to Figure 21 H, each subsection may be operated by its own set of indium tin oxide, or other control lead material, voltage application leads 736 back to a central controller). Given this level of control over a DOE paradigm, additional configurations are facilitated.

[00506] Referring to Figure 211, a waveguide (738) with embedded DOE (740) is viewed from the top down, with the user's eye positioned in front of the waveguide. A given pixel may be represented as a beam coming into the waveguide and totally internally reflecting along until it may be exited by a diffraction pattern to come out of the waveguide as a set of beams.

Depending upon the diffraction configuration, the beams may come out parallel/collimated (as shown in Figure 211 for convenience), or in a diverging fan configuration if representing a focal distance closer than optical infinity.

[00507] The depicted set of parallel exiting beams may represent, for example, the farthest left pixel of what the user is seeing in the real world as viewed through the waveguide, and light off to the rightmost extreme will be a different group of parallel exiting beams. Indeed, with modular control of the DOE subsections as described above, one may spend more computing resource or time creating and manipulating the small subset of beams that is likely to be actively addressing the user's pupil (i.e., because the other beams never reach the user's eye and are effectively wasted). Thus, referring to Figure 21 J, a waveguide (738) configuration is shown wherein only the two subsections (740, 742) of the DOE (744) are deemed to be likely to address the user's pupil (45) are activated. Preferably one subsection may be configured to direct light in one direction simultaneously as another subsection is directing light in a different direction.

[00508] Figure 21 K shows an orthogonal view of two independently controlled subsections (734, 746) of a DOE (732). Referring to the top view of Figure 21 L, such independent control may be used for scanning or focusing light. In the configuration depicted in Figure 21 K, an assembly (748) of three independently controlled DOE/waveguide subsections (750, 752, 754) may be used to scan, increase the field of view, and/or increase the exit pupil region. Such functionality may arise from a single waveguide with such independently controllable DOE subsections, or a vertical stack of these for additional complexity. [00509] In one embodiment, if a circular DOE may be controllably stretched radially- symmetrically, the diffraction pitch may be modulated, and the DOE may be utilized as a tunable lens with an analog type of control. In another embodiment, a single axis of stretch (for example, to adjust an angle of a linear DOE term) may be utilized for DOE control. Further, in another embodiment a membrane, akin to a drum head, may be vibrated, with oscillatory motion in the Z-axis (i.e., toward/away from the eye) providing Z-axis control and focus change over time.

[00510] Referring to Figure 21 M, a stack of several DOEs (756) is shown receiving collimated light from a waveguide (722) and refocusing it based upon the additive powers of the activated DOEs. Linear and/or radial terms of DOEs may be modulated over time, such as on a frame sequential basis, to produce a variety of treatments (such as tiled display

configurations or expanded field of view) for the light coming from the waveguide and exiting, preferably toward the user's eye. In configurations wherein the DOE or DOEs are embedded within the waveguide, a low diffraction efficiency is desired to maximize transparency for light passed from the real world; in configurations wherein the DOE or DOEs are not embedded, a high diffraction efficiency may be desired, as described above. In one embodiment, both linear and radial DOE terms may be combined outside of the waveguide, in which case high diffraction efficiency would be desired.

[00511] Referring to Figure 21 N, a segmented or parabolic reflector, such as those discussed above in Figure 8Q, is shown. Rather than executing a segmented reflector by combining a plurality of smaller reflectors, in one embodiment the same functionality may result from a single waveguide with a DOE having different phase profiles for each section of it, such that it is controllable by subsection. In other words, while the entire segmented reflector functionality may be turned on or off together, generally the DOE may be configured to direct light toward the same region in space (i.e., the pupil of the user).

[00512] Referring to Figures 22A-22Z, optical configurations known as "freeform optics" may be utilized certain of the aforementioned challenges. The term "freeform" generally is used in reference to arbitrarily curved surfaces that may be utilized in situations wherein a spherical, parabolic, or cylindrical lens does not meet a design complexity such as a geometric constraint. For example, referring to Figure 22A, one of the common challenges with display (762) configurations when a user is looking through a mirror (and also sometimes a lens 760) is that the field of view is limited by the area subtended by the final lens (760) of the system.

[00513] Referring to Figure 22B, in more simple terms, if one has a display (762), which may include some lens elements, there is a straightforward geometric relationship such that the field of view cannot be larger than the angle subtended by the display (762). Referring to Figure 22C, this challenge is exacerbated if the user is trying to have an augmented reality experience wherein light from the real world is also be to passed through the optical system, because in such case, there often is a reflector (764) that leads to a lens (760); by interposing a reflector, the overall path length to get to the lens from the eye is increased, which tightens the angle and reduces the field of view.

[00514] Given this, if one wants to increase the field of view, he must increase the size of the lens, but that might mean pushing a physical lens toward the forehead of the user from an ergonomic perspective. Further, the reflector may not catch all of the light from the larger lens. Thus, there is a practical limitation imposed by human head geometry, and it generally is a challenge to get more than a 40-degree field of view using conventional see-through displays and lenses.

[00515] With freeform lenses, rather than having a standard planar reflector as described above, one has a combined reflector and lens with power (i.e., a curved reflector 766), which means that the curved lens geometry determines the field of view. Referring to Figure 22D, without the circuitous path length of a conventional paradigm as described above in reference to Figure 22C, it is possible for a freeform arrangement to realize a significantly larger field of view for a given set of optical requirements.

[00516] Referring to Figure 22E, a typical freeform optic has three active surfaces. Referring to Figure 22E, in one typical freeform optic (770) configuration, light may be directed toward the freeform optic from an image plane, such as a flat panel display (768), into the first active surface (772), which typically is a primarily transmissive freeform surface that refracts transmitted light and imparts a focal change (such as an added stigmatism, because the final bounce from the third surface will add a matching/opposite stigmatism and these are desirably canceled). The incoming light may be directed from the first surface to a second surface (774), wherein it may strike with an angle shallow enough to cause the light to be reflected under total internal reflection toward the third surface (776).

[00517] The third surface may comprise a half-silvered, arbitrarily-curved surface configured to bounce the light out through the second surface toward the eye, as shown in Figure 22E. Thus in the depicted typical freeform configuration, the light enters through the first surface, bounces from the second surface, bounces from the third surface, and is directed out of the second surface. Due to the optimization of the second surface to have the requisite reflective properties on the first pass, as well as refractive properties on the second pass as the light is exited toward the eye, a variety of curved surfaces with higher-order shapes than a simple sphere or parabola are formed into the freeform optic.

[00518] Referring to Figure 22F, a compensating lens (780) may be added to the freeform optic (770) such that the total thickness of the optic assembly is substantially uniform in thickness, and preferably without magnification, to light incoming from the real world (144) in an augmented reality configuration.

[00519] Referring to Figure 22G, a freeform optic (770) may be combined with a waveguide (778) configured to facilitate total internal reflection of captured light within certain constraints. For example, as shown in Figure 22G, light may be directed into the freeform/waveguide assembly from an image plane, such as a flat panel display, and totally internally reflected within the waveguide until it hits the curved freeform surface and escapes toward the eye of the user. Thus the light bounces several times in total internal reflection until it reaches the freeform wedge portion.

[00520] One of the main objectives with such an assembly is to try to lengthen the optic assembly while retaining as uniform a thickness as possible (to facilitate transport by total internal reflection, and also viewing of the world through the assembly without further compensation) for a larger field of view. Figure 22H depicts a configuration similar to that of Figure 22G, with the exception that the configuration of Figure 22H also features a

compensating lens portion to further extend the thickness uniformity and assist with viewing the world through the assembly without further compensation.

[00521] Referring to Figure 22I, in another embodiment, a freeform optic (782) is shown with a small flat surface, or fourth face (784), at the lower left corner that is configured to facilitate injection of image information at a different location than is typically used with freeform optics. The input device (786) may comprise, for example, a scanning fiber display, which may be designed to have a very small output geometry. The fourth face may comprise various geometries itself and have its own refractive power, such as by use planar or freeform surface geometries.

[00522] Referring to Figure 22J, in practice, such a configuration may also feature a reflective coating (788) along the first surface such that it directs light back to the second surface, which then bounces the light to the third surface, which directs the light out across the second surface and to the eye (58). The addition of the fourth small surface for injection of the image information facilitates a more compact configuration. In an embodiment wherein a classical freeform input configuration and a scanning fiber display (790) are utilized, some lenses (792, 794) may be required in order to appropriately form an image plane (796) using the output from the scanning fiber display; these hardware components add extra bulk that may not be desired.

[00523] Referring to Figure 22K, an embodiment is shown wherein light from a scanning fiber display (790) is passed through an input optics assembly (792, 794) to an image plane (796), and then directed across the first surface of the freeform optic (770) to a total internal reflection bounce off of the second surface, then another total internal reflection bounce from the third surface results in the light exiting across the second surface and being directed toward the eye (58).

[00524] An all-total-internal-reflection freeform waveguide may be created such that there are no reflective coatings (i.e., such that total-internal-reflection is being relied upon for propagation of light until a critical angle of incidence with a surface is met, at which point the light exits in a manner akin to the wedge-shaped optics described above). In other words, rather than having two planar surfaces, one may have a surface comprising one or more subsurfaces from a set of conical curves, such as parabolas, spheres, ellipses, etc.).

[00525] Such a configuration still may produce a shallow-enough angles for total internal reflection within the optic; thus an approach that is somewhat a hybrid between a conventional freeform optic and a wedge-shaped waveguide is presented. One motivation to have such a configuration is to get away from the use of reflective coatings, which do help product reflection, but also are known to prevent transmission of a relatively large portion (such as 50%) of the light transmitting through from the real world (144). Further, such coatings also may block an equivalent amount of the light coming into the freeform optic from the input device. Thus there are reasons to develop designs that do not have reflective coatings.

[00526] As described above, one of the surfaces of a conventional freeform optic may comprise a half-silvered reflective surface. Generally such a reflective surface will be of "neutral density", meaning that it will generally reflect all wavelengths similarly. In another embodiment, such as one wherein a scanning fiber display is utilized as an input, the conventional reflector paradigm may be replaced with a narrow band reflector that is wavelength sensitive, such as a thin film laserline reflector. Thus in one embodiment, a configuration may reflect particular red/green/blue wavelength ranges and remain passive to other wavelengths, which generally will increase transparency of the optic and therefore be preferred for augmented reality configurations wherein transmission of image information from the real world (144) across the optic also is valued. [00527] Referring to Figure 22L, an embodiment is depicted wherein multiple freeform optics (770) may be stacked in the Z axis (i.e., along an axis substantially aligned with the optical axis of the eye). In one variation, each of the three depicted freeform optics may have a

wavelength-selective coating (for example, one highly selective for blue, the next for green, the next for red) so that images may be injected into each to have blue reflected from one surface, green from another, and red from a third surface. Such a configuration may be utilized, for example, to address chromatic aberration issues, to create a lightfield, or to increase the functional exit pupil size.

[00528] Referring to Figure 22M, an embodiment is shown wherein a single freeform optic (798) has multiple reflective surfaces (800, 802, 804), each of which may be wavelength or polarization selective so that their reflective properties may be individually controlled.

[00529] Referring to Figure 22N, in one embodiment, multiple microdisplays, such as scanning light displays, (786) may be injected into a single freeform optic to tile images (thereby providing an increased field of view), increase the functional pupil size, or address challenges such as chromatic aberration (i.e., by reflecting one wavelength per display). Each of the depicted displays would inject light that would take a different path through the freeform optic due to the different positioning of the displays relative to the freeform optic, which would provide a larger functional exit pupil output.

[00530] In one embodiment, a packet or bundle of scanning fiber displays may be utilized as an input to overcome one of the challenges in operatively coupling a scanning fiber display to a freeform optic. One such challenge with a scanning fiber display configuration is that the output of an individual fiber is emitted with a certain numerical aperture, or "NA", which is like the projectional angle of light from the fiber; ultimately this angle determines the diameter of the beam that passes through various optics, and ultimately determines the exit functional exit pupil size; thus in order to maximize exit pupil size with a freeform optic configuration, one may either increase the NA of the fiber using optimized refractive relationships, such as between core and cladding, or one may place a lens (i.e., a refractive lens, such as a gradient refractive index lens, or "GRIN" lens) at the end of the fiber or build one into the end of the fiber as described above, or create an array of fibers that is feeding into the freeform optic, in which case all of those NAs in the bundle remain small, and at the exit pupil an array of small exit pupils is produced that in the aggregate forms the functional equivalent of a large exit pupil.

[00531] Alternatively, in another embodiment a more sparse array (i.e., not bundled tightly as a packet) of scanning fiber displays or other displays may be utilized to functionally increase the field of view of the virtual image through the freeform optic. Referring to Figure 220, in another embodiment, a plurality of displays or displays (786) may be injected through the top of a freeform optic (770), as well as another plurality (786) through the lower corner; the display arrays may be two or three dimensional arrays. Referring to Figure 22P, in another related embodiment, image information also may be injected in from the side (806) of the freeform optic (770) as well.

[00532] In an embodiment wherein a plurality of smaller exit pupils is to be aggregated into a functionally larger exit pupil, one may elect to have each of the scanning fibers monochromatic, such that within a given bundle or plurality of projectors or displays, one may have a subgroup of solely red fibers, a subgroup of solely blue fibers, and a subgroup of solely green fibers. Such a configuration facilitates more efficiency in output coupling for bringing light into the optical fibers; for instance, there would be no need in such an embodiment to superimpose red, green, and blue into the same band.

[00533] Referring to Figures 22Q-22V, various freeform optic tiling configurations are depicted. Referring to Figure 22Q, an embodiment is depicted wherein two freeform optics are tiled side-by-side and a microdisplay, such as a scanning light display, (786) on each side is configured to inject image information from each side, such that one freeform optic wedge represents each half of the field of view.

[00534] Referring to Figure 22R, a compensator lens (808) may be included to facilitate views of the real world through the optics assembly. Figure 22S illustrates a configuration wherein freeform optics wedges are tiled side by side to increase the functional field of view while keeping the thickness of such optical assembly relatively uniform.

[00535] Referring to Figure 22T, a star-shaped assembly comprises a plurality of freeform optics wedges (also shown with a plurality of displays for inputting image information) in a configuration that may provide a larger field of view expansion while also maintaining a relatively thin overall optics assembly thickness.

[00536] With a tiled freeform optics assembly, the optics elements may be aggregated to produce a larger field of view; the tiling configurations described above have addressed this notion. For example, in a configuration wherein two freeform waveguides are aimed at the eye such as that depicted in Figure 22R, there are several ways to increase the field of view. One option is to "toe in" the freeform waveguides such that their outputs share, or are superimposed in, the space of the pupil (for example, the user may see the left half of the visual field through the left freeform waveguide, and the right half of the visual field through the right freeform waveguide). [00537] With such a configuration, the field of view has been increased with the tiled freeform waveguides, but the exit pupil has not grown in size. Alternatively, the freeform waveguides may be oriented such that they do not toe in as much - so they create exit pupils that are side-by-side at the eye's anatomical pupil. In one example, the anatomical pupil may be 8mm wide, and each of the side-by-side exit pupils may be 8mm, such that the functional exit pupil is expanded by about two times. Thus such a configuration provides an enlarged exit pupil, but if the eye is moved around in the "eyebox" defined by that exit pupil, that eye may lose parts of the visual field (i.e., lose either a portion of the left or right incoming light because of the side-by-side nature of such configuration).

[00538] In one embodiment using such an approach for tiling freeform optics, especially in the Z-axis relative to the eye of the user, red wavelengths may be driven through one freeform optic, green through another, and blue through another, such red/green/blue chromatic aberration may be addressed. Multiple freeform optics also may be provided to such a configuration that are stacked up, each of which is configured to address a particular wavelength.

[00539] Referring to Figure 22U, two oppositely-oriented freeform optics are shown stacked in the Z-axis (i.e., they are upside down relative to each other). With such a configuration, a compensating lens may not be required to facilitate accurate views of the world through the assembly; in other words, rather than having a compensating lens such as in the embodiment of Figure 22F or Figure 22R, an additional freeform optic may be utilized, which may further assist in routing light to the eye. Figure 22V shows another similar configuration wherein the assembly of two freeform optics is presented as a vertical stack.

[00540] To ensure that one surface is not interfering with another surface in the freeform optics, one may use wavelength or polarization selective reflector surfaces. For example, referring to Figure 22V, red, green, and blue wavelengths in the form of 650nm, 530nm, and 450nm may be injected, as well as red, green, and blue wavelengths in the form of 620nm, 550nm, and 470nm; different selective reflectors may be utilized in each of the freeform optics so that they do not interfere with each other. In a configuration wherein polarization filtering is used for a similar purpose, the reflection/transmission selectivity for light that is polarized in a particular axis may be varied (i.e., the images may be pre-polarized before they are sent to each freeform waveguide, to work with reflector selectivity).

[00541] Referring to Figures 22W and 22X, configurations are illustrated wherein a plurality of freeform waveguides may be utilized together in series. Referring to Figure 22W, light may enter from the real world and be directed sequentially through a first freeform optic (770), through an optional lens (812) which may be configured to relay light to a reflector (810) such as a DMD from a DLP system, which may be configured to reflect the light that has been filtered on a pixel by pixel basis (i.e., an occlusion mask may be utilized to block out certain elements of the real world, such as for darkfield perception, as described above; suitable spatial light modulators may be used which comprise DMDs, LCDs, ferroelectric LCOSs, MEMS shutter arrays, and the like, as described above) to another freeform optic (770) that is relaying light to the eye (28) of the user. Such a configuration may be more compact than one using conventional lenses for spatial light modulation.

[00542] Referring to Figure 22X, in a scenario wherein it is very important to keep overall thickness minimized, a configuration may be utilized that has one surface that is highly- reflective so that it may bounce light straight into another compactly positioned freeform optic. In one embodiment a selective attenuator (814) may be interposed between the two freeform optics (770).

[00543] Referring to Figure 22Y, an embodiment is depicted wherein a freeform optic (770) may comprise one aspect of a contact lens system. A miniaturized freeform optic is shown engaged against the cornea of a user's eye (58) with a miniaturized compensator lens portion (780), akin to that described in reference to Figure 22F. Signals may be injected into the miniaturized freeform assembly using a tethered scanning fiber display which may, for example, be coupled between the freeform optic and a tear duct area of the user, or between the freeform optic and another head-mounted display configuration.

[00544] Various example embodiments of the invention are described herein. Reference is made to these examples in a non-limiting sense. They are provided to illustrate more broadly applicable aspects of the invention. Various changes may be made to the invention described and equivalents may be substituted without departing from the true spirit and scope of the invention. In addition, many modifications may be made to adapt a particular situation, material, composition of matter, process, process act(s) or step(s) to the objective(s), spirit or scope of the present invention. Further, as will be appreciated by those with skill in the art that each of the individual variations described and illustrated herein has discrete components and features which may be readily separated from or combined with the features of any of the other several embodiments without departing from the scope or spirit of the present inventions. All such modifications are intended to be within the scope of claims associated with this disclosure.

[00545] The invention includes methods that may be performed using the subject devices. The methods may comprise the act of providing such a suitable device. Such provision may be performed by the end user. In other words, the "providing" act merely requires the end user obtain, access, approach, position, set-up, activate, power-up or otherwise act to provide the requisite device in the subject method. Methods recited herein may be carried out in any order of the recited events which is logically possible, as well as in the recited order of events.

[00546] Example aspects of the invention, together with details regarding material selection and manufacture have been set forth above. As for other details of the present invention, these may be appreciated in connection with the above-referenced patents and publications as well as generally known or appreciated by those with skill in the art. The same may hold true with respect to method-based aspects of the invention in terms of additional acts as commonly or logically employed.

[00547] In addition, though the invention has been described in reference to several examples optionally incorporating various features, the invention is not to be limited to that which is described or indicated as contemplated with respect to each variation of the invention. Various changes may be made to the invention described and equivalents (whether recited herein or not included for the sake of some brevity) may be substituted without departing from the true spirit and scope of the invention. In addition, where a range of values is provided, it is understood that every intervening value, between the upper and lower limit of that range and any other stated or intervening value in that stated range, is encompassed within the invention.

[00548] Also, it is contemplated that any optional feature of the inventive variations described may be set forth and claimed independently, or in combination with any one or more of the features described herein. Reference to a singular item, includes the possibility that there are plural of the same items present. More specifically, as used herein and in claims associated hereto, the singular forms "a," "an," "said," and "the" include plural referents unless the specifically stated otherwise. In other words, use of the articles allow for "at least one" of the subject item in the description above as well as claims associated with this disclosure. It is further noted that such claims may be drafted to exclude any optional element. As such, this statement is intended to serve as antecedent basis for use of such exclusive terminology as "solely," "only" and the like in connection with the recitation of claim elements, or use of a "negative" limitation.

[00549] Without the use of such exclusive terminology, the term "comprising" in claims associated with this disclosure shall allow for the inclusion of any additional element- irrespective of whether a given number of elements are enumerated in such claims, or the addition of a feature could be regarded as transforming the nature of an element set forth in such claims. Except as specifically defined herein, all technical and scientific terms used herein are to be given as broad a commonly understood meaning as possible while maintaining claim validity.

[00550] The breadth of the present invention is not to be limited to the examples provided and/or the subject specification, but rather only by the scope of claim language associated with this disclosure.